Bill Text: NC S500 | 2011-2012 | Regular Session | Amended


Bill Title: Governor's Budget

Spectrum: Partisan Bill (Republican 3-0)

Status: (Introduced - Dead) 2011-04-05 - Ref To Com On Appropriations/Base Budget [S500 Detail]

Download: North_Carolina-2011-S500-Amended.html

GENERAL ASSEMBLY OF NORTH CAROLINA

SESSION 2011

S                                                                                                                                                     1

SENATE BILL 500*

 

 

Short Title:        Governor's Budget.

(Public)

Sponsors:

Senators Brunstetter, Hunt, and Stevens.

Referred to:

Appropriations/Base Budget.

April 5, 2011

A BILL TO BE ENTITLED

AN ACT TO MAKE BASE BUDGET APPROPRIATIONS FOR CURRENT OPERATIONS OF STATE DEPARTMENTS, INSTITUTIONS, AND AGENCIES, AND FOR OTHER PURPOSES.

 

The General Assembly of North Carolina enacts:

 

PART I. INTRODUCTION AND TITLE OF ACT

 

INTRODUCTION

SECTION 1.1.  The appropriations made in this act are for maximum amounts necessary to provide the services and accomplish the purposes described in the budget.  Savings shall be effected where the total amounts appropriated are not required to perform these services and accomplish these purposes and, except as allowed by the State Budget Act, or this act, the savings shall revert to the appropriate fund at the end of each fiscal year.

 

TITLE OF ACT

SECTION 1.2.  This act shall be known as "The Current Operations and Capital Improvements Appropriations Act of 2011."

 

PART II. Current Operations and Expansion/General Fund

 

CURRENT OPERATIONS AND EXPANSION/GENERAL FUND

SECTION 2.1.  Appropriations from the General Fund of the State for the maintenance of the State's departments, institutions, and agencies and for other purposes as enumerated are made for the biennium ending June 30, 2013, according to the following schedule:

 

State Agency or Division                                                         FY 2011‑2012          FY 2012‑2013

 

HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES

Central Administration                                                              $    69,184,819         $    65,987,717

Aging                                                                                             36,859,667               36,859,667

Child Development                                                                       236,503,341             236,503,341

Public Health                                                                                147,901,363             147,901,363

Social Services                                                                             188,616,402             188,351,712

Medical Assistance                                                                    3,180,907,603          3,399,767,507

NC Health Choice                                                                          79,452,317               85,947,512

Services for the Blind                                                                        8,198,149                 8,181,925

Mental Health/DD/SAS                                                                714,335,617             714,335,617

Health Service Regulation                                                               16,133,031               16,133,031

Vocational Rehabilitation                                                                 37,125,788               37,528,128

Total Health and Human Services                                      $ 4,715,218,097       $ 4,937,497,520

 

NATURAL AND ECONOMIC RESOURCES

Agriculture & Consumer Services                                            $     44,179,728        $     43,843,840

Commerce                                                                                     52,484,135               32,525,214

Commerce – State Aid to Non‑State Entities                                  66,320,803               66,320,803

Environment and Natural Resources                                              179,139,906             178,312,648

Clean Water Management Trust Fund                                             50,000,000               50,000,000

Labor                                                                                             15,021,945               14,911,032

Total Natural and Economic Resources                                $ 407,146,517          $ 385,913,537

 

JUSTICE AND PUBLIC SAFETY

Correction                                                                              $ 1,366,710,846       $ 1,373,058,448

Crime Control & Public Safety                                                        32,327,610               32,178,336

Judicial       461,053,029                                                              458,309,107

Judicial – Indigent Defense                                                            122,610,185             122,371,148

Justice                                                                                            83,907,465               83,046,671

Juvenile Justice                                                                             140,316,196             139,736,263

Total Justice and Public Safety                                           $ 2,206,925,331       $ 2,208,699,973

 

GENERAL GOVERNMENT

Administration                                                                            $  64,889,461           $  64,660,496

State Auditor                                                                                  12,223,324               12,138,927

Cultural Resources                                                                          65,699,482               65,444,723

Cultural Resources – Roanoke Island                                                2,166,308                 2,166,308

General Assembly                                                                           52,232,589               52,021,352

Governor's Office                                                                             5,733,189                 5,698,802

Insurance                                                                                        27,742,189               27,561,310

Insurance – Worker's Compensation Fund                                        4,500,000                 4,500,000

Lieutenant Governor                                                                            916,193                    910,094

Office of Administrative Hearings                                                      4,010,594                 3,987,879

Revenue                                                                                         86,577,664               83,140,490

NC Housing Finance                                                                      11,796,296               11,796,296

Secretary of State                                                                           10,535,221               10,472,870

State Board of Elections                                                                   6,170,404                 6,142,617

State Budget and Management (OSBM)                                           6,441,031                 6,400,664

      OSBM – Special Appropriations                                              13,934,311               21,434,311

Office of State Controller                                                                30,500,768               30,403,273

State Treasurer                                                                                 6,662,835                 6,627,554

State Treasurer – Retirement/Benefits                                              17,812,114               17,812,114

Total General Government                                                $     430,543,973      $     433,320,080

 

EDUCATION

Public Schools                                                                       $  7,572,712,912      $  7,598,568,534

Community Colleges                                                                  1,016,629,522          1,022,312,530

University of North Carolina

      Appalachian State University                                                   143,375,481             142,441,181

      East Carolina University                                                                                                              

            Academic Affairs                                                              244,474,547             242,766,341

            Health Affairs                                                                     64,962,961               64,614,282

      Elizabeth City State University                                                   38,234,494               38,167,339

      Fayetteville State University                                                      56,712,349               56,330,556

      North Carolina Agricultural and

            Technical State University                                                 104,855,408             104,461,051

      North Carolina Central University                                             93,833,335               93,203,178

      North Carolina State University                                                                                                   

            Academic Affairs                                                              426,919,760             424,098,695

            Agricultural Extension                                                         58,997,068               58,635,077

            Agricultural Research                                                          43,331,680               43,021,156

      University of North Carolina at Asheville                                   41,436,789               41,165,653

      University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill                                                                                  

            Academic Affairs                                                              303,131,658             304,081,302

            Health Affairs                                                                   218,646,107             220,424,150

            Area Health Education Centers                                           49,592,674               49,360,931

      University of North Carolina at Charlotte                                 212,974,195             212,574,456

      University of North Carolina at Greensboro                             172,567,412             171,327,135

      University of North Carolina at Pembroke                                 60,608,173               60,983,655

      University of North Carolina at Wilmington                              103,761,740             104,141,841

      University of North Carolina School of the Arts                         27,522,571               27,340,970

      Western Carolina University                                                      89,173,604               89,094,627

      Winston‑Salem State University                                                74,887,743               74,418,599

      General Administration                                                              39,525,152               39,373,634

            University Institutional Programs                                      (207,390,096)           (186,417,963)

      Related Educational Programs (Financial Aid)                           44,993,219               44,231,141

      Aid to Private Colleges                                                             98,974,947               98,974,947

      North Carolina School of Science and Mathematics                  18,723,953               18,632,539

      UNC Hospitals at Chapel Hill                                                   33,008,911               33,008,911

Total University of North Carolina                                              2,657,835,835          2,670,455,384

Total Education                                                                  $ 11,247,178,269     $ 11,291,336,448

 

Total Budget                                                                      $ 19,007,012,187     $ 19,256,767,558

 

DEBT SERVICE

General Debt Service                                                               $   696,337,188         $  782,758,881

Federal Reimbursement                                                                    1,616,380                 1,616,380

Total Debt Service                                                                $   697,953,568         $  784,375,261

 

RESERVES & ADJUSTMENTS

Contingency and Emergency Reserve                                           $   5,000,000             $  5,000,000

Severance Reserve                                                                         30,000,000                               0

Job Development Investment Grants                                               20,400,000               27,400,000

Mgmt. Flexibility Reserve for Moving ESC to Commerce                    (251,400)                  (377,100)

Mgmt. Flexibility Reserve for Dept. of Mgmt. & Admin.                   (1,087,300)               (1,598,600)

Mgmt. Flexibility Reserve for Dept. of Public Safety                         (2,705,100)               (4,057,600)

Centralized Grant System                                                                                0                   (700,000)

Procurement Reform                                                                                       0              (30,000,000)

Health Plan Reserve (Benefit Changes/Keep Plan Solvent)              28,000,000             113,000,000

IT Initiative 4,458,142                                                                      6,158,142

Retirement Rate Adjustment Reserve                                            115,000,000             230,000,000

Reserve for Dept. of Public Safety to Reflect Efficiencies                  (3,000,000)               (3,000,000)

Reserve for Centralized Human Resources Functions                       (2,767,000)               (4,150,400)

Total Reserves & Adjustments                                            $  193,047,342         $  337,674,442

 

CAPITAL

Capital Improvements                                                                $     4,535,000          $                   0

Total Capital                                                                            $    4,535,000           $                  0

 

Total General Fund Budget                                              $  19,902,548,097    $  20,378,817,261

 

GENERAL FUND AVAILABILITY STATEMENT

SECTION 2.2.  The General Fund availability used in developing the 2011‑2013 biennial budget is shown below:

                                                                                                  FY 2011‑2012          FY 2012‑2013

Beginning Availability

      Unappropriated Balance from Prior Fiscal Year                  $  111,000,000            $                 0

      Credit Balance FY 2008‑2009

            (Reversions & Over‑collections)                                       562,318,097                               0

      Credit to Savings Reserve Account                                        (150,000,000)                              0

      Credit to Repairs and Renovations Reserve Account                (75,000,000)                              0

      Rebuild Mental Health Trust Fund                                            (75,000,000)                              0

      Establish Consolidation and Efficiency Incentive Fund               (25,000,000)                              0

      Invest in Community Colleges Equipment for Worker

            Training Efforts                                                                  (25,000,000)                              0

Beginning Unreserved Credit Balance                                $   323,318,097            $                 0

 

Revenues

      Tax:

            Individual Income Tax                                                $  9,920,500,000    $  10,561,000,000

            Corporate Income Tax                                                     987,700,000          1,045,500,000

            Sales and Use                                                                5,270,100,000          5,510,400,000

            Other Tax                                                                      1,951,500,000          2,065,000,000

      Total Tax                                                                           18,129,800,000        19,181,900,000

      Nontax/Transfers                                                                    692,830,000             702,180,000

Total Revenue                                                                  $  18,822,630,000    $  19,884,080,000

 

Revenue Changes

      Continue 0.75% Sales Tax

            (reduces current rate by 0.25%)                                    $  826,600,000         $  863,800,000

      Small Business Tax Relief (effective 1‑1‑11)                            (65,000,000)                              0

      Reduce Corporate Income Tax to 4.9%

            (effective 1‑1‑12)                                                            (115,000,000)           (303,000,000)

      Raise Cap on Qualified Business Venture Credit                        (2,000,000)               (2,000,000)

      Energy Efficiency Tax Credit                                                                     0                (3,300,000)

      Repeal Corporate Tax Transfer Permanently                             72,000,000               75,000,000

      Department of Revenue –

            Accounts Receivable Program                                            25,000,000               25,000,000

      Disproportionate Share Receipts                                               15,000,000               15,000,000

Subtotal Revenue Changes                                                   $  756,600,000         $  670,500,000

 

Total Availability                                                              $  19,902,548,097    $  20,554,580,000

 

Less:   Total General Fund Appropriations                     $  19,902,548,097    $  20,378,817,261

 

Unappropriated Balance Remaining                               $                         0     $      175,762,739

 

PART III. Current Operations/Highway Fund

 

CURRENT OPERATIONS/HIGHWAY FUND

SECTION 3.1.  Appropriations from the Highway Fund of the State for the maintenance and operation of the Department of Transportation, and for other purposes as enumerated, are made for the biennium ending June 30, 2013, according to the following schedule:

 

Current Operations – Highway Fund                                      FY 2011‑2012          FY 2012‑2013

Department of Transportation

      General Administration                                                      $      89,163,247        $     89,200,408

      Division of Highways

            Administration                                                                    34,772,064               34,823,123

            State Match for Federal Aid‑Planning and Research              4,055,402                 4,055,402

      Construction Program

            State Secondary System                                              $     89,373,921        $     90,187,224

            Division Small Urban Construction                                        6,619,460                 6,619,460

            Discretionary Funds                                                            11,347,646               11,347,646

            Spot Safety Improvements                                                    9,100,000                 9,100,000

            Access and Public Services Roads                                        1,758,885                 1,758,885

      Total Construction Program                                               $   118,199,912         $  119,013,215

      Maintenance Program

            Primary System                                                           $   221,152,559        $   225,430,157

            Secondary System                                                            314,050,163             318,327,761

            System Preservation                                                           95,282,473               99,560,071

            Contract Resurfacing                                                        291,219,065             295,496,663

            General Maintenance Reserve                                             54,493,713               58,771,311

      Total Maintenance Program                                                $  976,197,973         $  997,585,963

      Ferry Operations                                                                $    41,566,268         $    69,616,268

      State Aid to Municipalities                                                        89,373,921               90,187,224

      State Aid to Railroads                                                               20,101,153               24,101,153

      State Aid for Public Transportation                                           92,719,929               92,719,929

      Airports                                                                                    20,454,763               24,364,381

      OSHA                                                                                          372,792                    372,792

      Governor's Highway Safety Program                                              278,135                    278,605

      Division of Motor Vehicles                                                        97,468,510               97,577,075

Total Department of Transportation                                  $ 1,584,724,069      $  1,643,895,538

 

Appropriations to Other State Agencies

      Agriculture                                                                        $        5,118,694      $         5,118,694

      Revenue                                                                                     6,381,663                 6,381,663

      State Treasurer                                                                         20,235,353               24,080,070

      Office of State Controller‑BEST Shared Services                           461,041                    461,041

      Public Instruction – Civil Penalties                                             22,000,000               22,000,000

      Public Instruction – Driver Education                                         31,888,496               32,216,379

      CCPS – Highway Patrol                                                         206,437,159             206,437,159

      DENR – LUST Trust Fund                                                         3,001,898                 3,201,898

      DHHS – Chemical Test                                                                 577,341                    577,341

Total – Other State Agencies                                               $   296,101,645        $   300,474,245

 

Reserves and Transfers

      Minority Contractor Development                                          $      150,000            $      150,000

      State Fire Protection Grant                                                            150,000                    150,000

      Storm Water Management                                                             500,000                    500,000

      Reserve for Visitor's Centers                                                          400,000                    400,000

      Global TransPark                                                                       1,280,000                 1,280,000

      Reserve for Administrative Reduction                                         (2,479,149)               (2,479,149)

      Reserve for Program Consolidations/Eliminations                       (1,071,606)               (1,071,606)

      Reserve for Retirement Incentive Program                                  (2,977,459)               (7,424,028)

      Reserve for Health Insurance Adjustment                                    1,300,000                 5,300,000

      Employer's Contribution to Retirement                                        5,662,500               11,325,000

Total Reserves and Transfers                                                $    2,914,286           $    8,130,217

 

Total Current Operations                                                    $ 1,883,740,000       $ 1,952,500,000

 

Capital Improvements                                                         $      15,000,000       $      15,000,000

 

Total Highway Fund Appropriation                                     $ 1,898,740,000       $ 1,967,500,000

 

HIGHWAY FUND AVAILABILITY STATEMENT

SECTION 3.2.  The Highway Fund availability used in developing the 2011‑2013 biennial budget is shown below:

 

Highway Fund Availability Statement                                    FY 2011‑2012          FY 2012‑2013

 

Beginning Credit Balance                                                      $                        0     $                        0

Estimated Revenue                                                                    1,898,740,000          1,967,500,000

Estimated Reversions                                                                                      0                               0

 

Total Highway Fund Availability                                        $  1,898,740,000      $  1,967,500,000

 

PART IV. Highway Trust Fund Appropriations

 

HIGHWAY TRUST FUND APPROPRIATIONS

SECTION 4.1.  Appropriations from the Highway Trust Fund are made for the biennium ending June 30, 2013, according to the following schedule:

 

Highway Trust Fund                                                                FY 2011‑2012          FY 2012‑2013

 

Department of Transportation:                                                                                                           

      Maximum Allowance for Administration                           $       47,820,480      $       49,408,320

Construction Allocation:                                                                                                                    

      Intrastate System                                                                    435,942,824             454,712,566

      Urban Loop System                                                               146,599,440             152,352,807

      Secondary Roads                                                                     67,562,782               70,185,956

State Aid to Municipalities                                                              48,605,470               50,602,947

Bonds:       

      Bond Redemption                                                                     56,568,732               61,646,984

      Bond Interest                                                                            22,662,996               19,834,559

NC Turnpike Authority                                                                   99,000,000               99,000,000

NC Mobility Fund                                                                          31,000,000               45,000,000

Transfer to the General Fund                                                           41,497,276               27,595,861

 

Total Highway Trust Fund Appropriations                         $    997,260,000       $ 1,030,340,000

 

HIGHWAY TRUST FUND AVAILABILITY STATEMENT

SECTION 4.2.  The Highway Trust Fund availability used in developing the 2011‑2013 biennial budget is shown below:

 

Highway Trust Fund Availability Statement                          FY 2011‑2012          FY 2012‑2013

 

Beginning Credit Balance                                                                                 ‑                                ‑

Estimated Revenue                                                                    $ 997,260,000       $ 1,030,340,000

Estimated Reversions                                                                                      ‑                                ‑

 

Total Highway Trust Fund Availability                                  $ 997,260,000       $ 1,030,340,000

 

PART V. OTHER AVAILABILITY AND APPROPRIATIONS

 

EDUCATION LOTTERY

SECTION 5.1.(a)  Pursuant to G.S. 18C‑164, the revenue used to support appropriations made in this act is transferred from the State Lottery Fund in the amount of four hundred twenty‑four million nine hundred seventy‑three thousand six hundred thirty dollars ($424,973,630) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year.

SECTION 5.1.(b)  Notwithstanding G.S. 18C‑164 and G.S. 18C‑162(c)(2), the appropriations made from the Education Lottery Fund pursuant to G.S. 18C‑164(d) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year are as follows:

(1)        Class Size Reduction                                                                    $ 220,643,188

(2)        Prekindergarten Program                                                                   79,635,709

(3)        Public School Building Capital Fund                                                   55,238,170

(4)        Scholarships for Needy Students                                                        69,456,563

            Total                                                                                            $ 424,973,630

SECTION 5.1.(c)  Notwithstanding G.S. 18C‑164, the North Carolina State Lottery Commission shall not transfer funds to the Education Lottery Reserve Fund for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year or the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.

SECTION 5.1.(d)  Notwithstanding G.S. 18C‑164(c), G.S. 115C‑546.2(d), or any other provision of law, funds appropriated in this section to the Public School Building Capital Fund for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be allocated to counties on the basis of average daily membership (ADM). Counties may authorize local school administrative units to use funds received from the Public School Building Capital Fund pursuant to subsection (f) of this section for one or more of the following purposes only: (i) for school construction projects in accordance with G.S. 115C‑546.2(d), (ii) to retire indebtedness incurred on or after January 1, 2003, in accordance with G.S. 115C‑546.2(d), for school construction projects, and (iii) for classroom teachers. A county may authorize the use of these funds for classroom teachers only upon the request of the local board of education. Funds used for classroom teachers shall supplement and not supplant existing local current expense funding for the public schools. These funds shall not be included in the computation of "average per pupil allocation for average daily membership" or "per pupil local current expense appropriation" under G.S. 115C‑238.29H.

SECTION 5.1.(e)  Notwithstanding G.S. 18C‑164(c), Article 35A of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes, or any other provision of law, of the funds appropriated in this section for Scholarships for Needy Students, the sum of thirty‑four million eight hundred fifty‑six thousand five hundred sixty‑three dollars ($34,856,563) shall be administered in accordance with the policy adopted by the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina.

SECTION 5.1.(f)  Notwithstanding G.S. 18C‑164(f), if the actual net lottery revenues for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year exceed the amounts appropriated in subsection (b) of this section, the excess net revenues shall be allocated for school capital on the basis of average daily membership.

 

OTHER RECEIPTS FROM PENDING GRANT AWARDS

SECTION 5.2.  Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4, State agencies may, with approval of the Director of the Budget, spend funds received from grants awarded subsequent to the enactment of this act. The Office of State Budget and Management shall work with the recipient State agencies to budget grant awards according to the annual program needs and within the parameters of the respective granting entities. Depending on the nature of the award, additional State personnel may be employed on a temporary or permanent time‑limited basis or on a permanent full‑time basis if the grant is intended to be recurring. The Office of State Budget and Management shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior to expending any funds received from grant awards. Funds received from such grants are hereby appropriated and shall be incorporated into the authorized budget of the recipient State agency.

 

AMERICAN RECOVERY AND REINVESTMENT ACT FUNDS APPROPRIATED

SECTION 5.3.(a)  Funds received from American Recovery and Reinvestment Act (ARRA) grants and receipts not specified in this act are hereby appropriated in the amounts provided in the notification of award from the federal government or any entity acting on behalf of the federal government to administer federal ARRA funds. OSBM and affected State agencies shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on ARRA grants received that are not expressly delineated in this act.

SECTION 5.3.(b)  The Office of State Budget and Management shall work with the recipient State agencies to budget federal receipts awarded according to the annual program needs and within the parameters of the respective granting entities and to incorporate federal funds into the authorized budgets of the recipient State agency. State agencies shall not use federal ARRA funds for recurring purposes unless provided for in this act. However, depending on the nature of the award, additional State personnel may be employed on a temporary or time‑limited basis. Nothing in this subsection shall be construed to prohibit the use of federal ARRA funds to employ teachers and other school personnel for the 2011‑2012 school year.

 

ESTABLISH SEVERANCE EXPENDITURE RESERVE

SECTION 5.4.(a)  There is established in the Office of State Budget and Management a General Fund reserve budget code for the purpose of funding severance‑related obligations to State employees subject to the State Personnel Act and employees exempt from the State Personnel Act who are separated from service due to a reduction‑in‑force action. Severance‑related expenditures from this reserve shall include obligations to fund (i) a State employee's severance salary continuation with an age adjustment factor as authorized by G.S. 126‑8.5, including employer‑related contributions for social security and (ii) noncontributory health premiums for up to 12 months as authorized by G.S. 135‑45.2(a)(8) for employees of employing units as defined by G.S. 135‑45.1(12).

SECTION 5.4.(b)  The Director of the Budget shall allocate funds appropriated in Section 2.1 of this act to the Severance Expenditure Reserve to public agencies to fund severance‑related obligations incurred by the agencies as a result of reduction‑in‑force actions that cause State‑supported public employees to be terminated from public employment. Funds appropriated to the Severance Expenditure Reserve shall be expended in their entirety before funds appropriated to a public agency for State‑supported personal services expenditures may be used to fund any severance‑related obligations. For the purposes of this subsection, the term 'public employee' means an employee of a State agency, department, or institution; The University of North Carolina; the North Carolina Community College System Office; or a local school administrative unit.

 

MANAGEMENT FLEXIBILITY RESERVES

SECTION 5.5.  The position eliminations associated with the management flexibility reductions included in the Governor's Recommended Budget are estimates based in part on historical turnover rates and current vacancies and are not targeted at specific job classifications or position numbers. To provide the heads of the departments with the leeway necessary to ensure that mission critical activities are not crippled, the department heads may achieve the savings from position eliminations by reducing a lesser number of positions than described in the Governor's Recommended Budget for the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium.

 

CIVIL FORFEITURE FUNDS

SECTION 5.6.  Appropriations. – Appropriations are made from the Civil Penalty and Forfeiture Fund for the fiscal biennium ending June 30, 2013, as follows:

 

                                                                                                 FY 2011‑2012           FY 2012‑2013

School Technology Fund                                                           $   18,000,000          $   18,000,000

State Public School Fund                                                              120,362,790             120,362,790

Total Appropriation                                                               $  138,362,790          $ 138,362,790

 

STATEWIDE GRANTS OVERSIGHT

SECTION 5.7.  G.S. 143C‑6‑23 is amended by adding a  new subsection to read:

"(j)       Withholding From Certain Grants to Cover Statewide Oversight Cost. – The Office of State Budget and Management may direct any agency to withhold up to one‑fourth of one percent (0.25%) of the amount of any grant awarded to a non‑State entity each fiscal year to cover statewide grant oversight costs pursuant to this section. The funds shall be transferred to the Office of State Budget and Management at the time the grant funds are disbursed. For purposes of this provision, "grant" is defined by this section.

Funds shall not be withheld for the purpose of covering oversight costs if the grant is a pass‑through of funds granted by an agency of the United States and the terms of the federal grant prohibit the withholding of funds described by this provision."

 

GRANT COORDINATION

SECTION 5.8.  The Office of State Budget and Management shall use resources made available from G.S. 143C‑6‑23(j) for two positions to coordinate and advance State efforts to obtain financial assistance from federal and private sources.

 

PART VI. General Provisions

 

APPROPRIATION OF CASH BALANCES AND RECEIPTS

SECTION 6.1.  Expenditures of cash balances, federal funds, departmental receipts, grants, and gifts from the various General Fund, Special Revenue Fund, Enterprise Fund, Internal Service Fund, and Trust and Agency Fund budget codes are appropriated and authorized for the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium as follows:

(1)        For all budget codes listed in "The State of North Carolina, Governor's Recommended Budget, 2011‑2013," cash balances and receipts are appropriated up to the amounts specified in the recommended budget, as adjusted by the General Assembly, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the 2012‑2013 fiscal year. Funds may be expended only for the programs, purposes, objects, and line items specified in the recommended budget or otherwise authorized by the General Assembly.

(2)        For all budget codes that are not listed in "The State of North Carolina, Governor's Recommended Budget, 2011‑2013," cash balances and receipts are appropriated for each year of the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium up to the level of actual expenditures for the 2010‑2011 fiscal year, unless otherwise provided by law. Funds may be expended only for the programs, purposes, objects, and line items authorized for the 2010‑2011 fiscal year.

(3)        Notwithstanding subdivisions (1) and (2) of this subsection, any receipts that are required to be used to pay debt service requirements for various outstanding bond issues and certificates of participation are appropriated up to the actual amounts received for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the 2012‑2013 fiscal year and shall be used only to pay debt service requirements.

(4)        Notwithstanding subdivisions (1) and (2) of this subsection, cash balances and receipts of funds that meet the definition issued by the Governmental Accounting Standards Board of a trust or agency fund are appropriated for and in the amounts required to meet the legal requirements of the trust agreement for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.

All these cash balances, federal funds, departmental receipts, grants, and gifts shall be expended and reported in accordance with the provisions of the State Budget Act, except as otherwise provided by law and this section.

 

EXPENDITURES OF FUNDS IN RESERVES LIMITED

SECTION 6.2.  All funds appropriated by this act into reserves may be expended only for the purposes for which the reserves were established.

 

BUDGET CODE CONSOLIDATIONS

SECTION 6.3.  Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4, the Office of State Budget and Management may adjust the enacted budget by making transfers among purposes or programs for the purpose of consolidating budget and fund codes or eliminating inactive budget and fund codes. The Office of State Budget and Management shall change the authorized budget to reflect these adjustments.

 

BUDGET REALIGNMENT

SECTION 6.4.  Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4(b), the Office of State Budget and Management may adjust the enacted budget by making transfers among purposes or programs for the sole purpose of correctly aligning authorized positions and associated operating costs with the appropriate purposes or programs as defined in G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(23).  The Office of State Budget and Management shall change the authorized budget to reflect these adjustments only after reporting the proposed adjustments to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Fiscal Research Division.  Under no circumstances shall total General Fund expenditures for a State department exceed the amount appropriated to that department from the General Fund for the fiscal year.

 

LOCAL GOVERNMENT UNIT POSITIONS

SECTION 6.6.  G.S. 105‑501(b) reads as rewritten:

"(b)      Deductions. – The costs incurred by the State to provide the functions listed in this subsection that support local governments are deductible from the collections to be allocated each month for distribution.

(1)        The Department's cost of the following for the preceding month must be deducted and credited to the Department:

a.         Performing the duties imposed by Article 15 of this Chapter.

b.         The Property Tax Commission.

c.         Additional positions that comprise the Local Government Unit within the Department besides those performing the duties imposed by Article 15 of this Chapter.

(2)        One‑twelfth of the costs of the following for the preceding fiscal year must be deducted and credited to the General Fund:

a.         The School of Government at the University of North Carolina at Chapel Hill in operating a training program in property tax appraisal and assessment.

b.         The personnel and operations provided by the Department of State Treasurer for the Local Government Commission.

c.         Seventy percent (70%) of the expenses of the Department of Revenue in performing the duties imposed by Article 2D of this Chapter."

 

TAX INFORMATION MANAGEMENT

SECTION 6.7.  Section 6.20(a) of S.L. 2009‑451, as rewritten by Section 6.13 of S.L. 2010‑31 and Section 2.3 of S.L. 2010‑123, reads as rewritten:

"SECTION 6.20.(a)  To speed the implementation of the Tax Information Management System (TIMS) and the additional components of the Planning and Design Project (PDP) through June 30, 2015, the Secretary of the Department of Revenue may enter into public‑private arrangements where (i) the funding of projects under the arrangement comes from revenue generated by the project and (ii) the project is related to the implementation of TIMS and additional components of the PDP. As used in this section, the "additional components of the PDP" are Enterprise Data Warehouse, Management Reporting and Decision Analytics, Customer Relationship Management, Enterprise Case Management, and E‑Services. All such arrangements shall terminate June 30, 2015.

Work under a public‑private arrangement may be contracted by requests for proposals, modifications to existing contracts, and purchases using existing contract vehicles.

The Secretary of Revenue shall establish a measurement process to determine the increased revenue attributable to the public‑private arrangements. To accomplish this, the Secretary shall consult subject matter experts outside the Department of Revenue, both within State government and from private industry. The measurement process shall include:

(1)        Calculation of a revenue baseline against which the increased revenue attributable to the project is measured;

(2)        Periodic evaluation to determine if the baseline needs to be modified based on significant measurable changes in the economic environment; and

(3)        Monthly calculation of increased revenue attributable to contracts executed under this program.

Of funds generated from collections above the baseline established by subdivision (1) of this subsection, in both the General andGeneral Fund, Highway Funds, and State portion of the Unauthorized Substance Tax collections of the Special Revenue Fund, up to forty‑one million dollars ($41,000,000)forty‑four million dollars ($44,000,000) may be authorized by the Office of State Budget and Management in fiscal year 2011‑2012 (i) for the purchases related to the implementation of TIMS and the additional components of the PDP, including payment for services from non‑State entities. Any internal costs must be appropriated by the General Assembly. The total of any funds expended during the 2009‑2011 biennium2011‑2012 fiscal year for implementation of TIMS and the additional PDP components shall not exceed the sum of forty‑one million dollars ($41,000,000). forty‑four million dollars ($44,000,000). The total of any funds expended during the 2012‑2013 fiscal year implementation of TIMS and the additional PDP components shall not exceed the sum of forty‑one million dollars ($41,000,000).

If the Department of Revenue finds that it cannot generate additional benefits totaling forty‑one million dollars ($41,000,000) through June 30, 2015, forty‑four million dollars ($44,000,000) in fiscal year 2011‑2012 and forty‑one million dollars ($41,000,000) in fiscal year 2012‑2013, or that total costs exceed the total available appropriations and earned benefits, then the Department shall do all of the following: (i) immediately notify the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Appropriations Committees and Fiscal Research Division, (ii) identify any obligations to vendors, (iii) identify options for meeting obligations to vendors, and (iv) provide costs associated with each option. The Department shall ensure that this notification is made in sufficient time to allow the General Assembly to properly evaluate the options presented."

 

PART VI‑A. INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY

 

INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY FUND APPROPRIATION

SECTION 6A.1.  Appropriations are made from the Information Technology Fund for the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium as follows:

 

                                                                                                     2011‑2012                2012‑2013

Office of Information Technology Services

Information Technology Operations

      Center for Geographic Information                                         $      643,800             $     643,800

      Enterprise Security and Risk Management                                      936,102                    936,102

      Enterprise Project Management Office                                        1,525,750                 1,525,750

      Architecture & Engineering                                                            550,800                    550,800

      Subtotal Information Technology Operations                               3,656,452                 3,656,452

Information Technology Projects

      Statewide IT Procurement                                                             550,000                    550,000

      State Portal                                                                                   500,000                               0

      IT Consolidation                                                                            779,157                    779,157

      SAS Enterprise License Agreement                                                200,000                 2,400,000

      Subtotal Information Technology Projects                                   2,029,157                 3,729,157

Total                                                                                          $   5,685,609             $  7,385,609

 

PART VII. PUBLIC SCHOOLS

 

CHILDREN WITH DISABILITIES

SECTION 7.1.  The State Board of Education shall allocate funds for children with disabilities on the basis of three thousand five hundred ninety‑eight dollars and fifty‑five cents ($3,598.55) per child for a maximum of 167,595 children for the 2011‑2012 school year. Each local school administrative unit shall receive funds for the lesser of (i) all children who are identified as children with disabilities or (ii) twelve and five‑tenths percent (12.5%) of the 2011‑2012 allocated average daily membership in the local school administrative unit. The dollar amounts allocated under this section for children with disabilities shall also adjust in accordance with legislative salary increments, retirement rate adjustments, and health benefit adjustments for personnel who serve children with disabilities.

 

FUNDS FOR ACADEMICALLY GIFTED CHILDREN

SECTION 7.2.  The State Board of Education shall allocate funds for academically or intellectually gifted children on the basis of one thousand one hundred ninety‑two dollars and ninety cents ($1,192.90) per child. A local school administrative unit shall receive funds for a maximum of four percent (4%) of its 2011‑2012 allocated average daily membership, regardless of the number of children identified as academically or intellectually gifted in the unit. The State Board shall allocate funds for no more than 59,240 children for the 2011‑2012 school year.

The dollar amounts allocated under this section for academically or intellectually gifted children shall also adjust in accordance with legislative salary increments, retirement rate adjustments, and health benefit adjustments for personnel who serve academically or intellectually gifted children.

 

USE OF SUPPLEMENTAL FUNDING IN LOW‑WEALTH COUNTIES

SECTION 7.3.(a)  Use of Funds for Supplemental Funding. – All funds received pursuant to this section shall be used only (i) to provide instructional positions, instructional support positions, teacher assistant positions, clerical positions, school computer technicians, instructional supplies and equipment, staff development, and textbooks and (ii) for salary supplements for instructional personnel and instructional support personnel. Local boards of education are encouraged to use at least twenty‑five percent (25%) of the funds received pursuant to this section to improve the academic performance of children who are performing at Level I or II on either reading or mathematics end‑of‑grade tests in grades 3‑8 and children who are performing at Level I or II in grades 4 and 7.

SECTION 7.3.(b)  Definitions. – As used in this section the following definitions apply:

(1)        "Anticipated county property tax revenue availability" means the county‑adjusted property tax base multiplied by the effective State average tax rate.

(2)        "Anticipated total county revenue availability" means the sum of the following:

a.         Anticipated county property tax revenue availability.

b.         Local sales and use taxes received by the county that are levied under Chapter 1096 of the 1967 Session Laws or under Subchapter VIII of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes.

c.         Sales tax hold harmless reimbursement received by the county under G.S. 105‑521.

d.         Fines and forfeitures deposited in the county school fund for the most recent year for which data are available.

(3)        "Anticipated total county revenue availability per student" means the anticipated total county revenue availability for the county divided by the average daily membership of the county.

(4)        "Anticipated State average revenue availability per student" means the sum of all anticipated total county revenue availability divided by the average daily membership for the State.

(5)        "Average daily membership" means average daily membership as defined in the North Carolina Public Schools Allotment Policy Manual, adopted by the State Board of Education. If a county contains only part of a local school administrative unit, the average daily membership of that county includes all students who reside within the county and attend that local school administrative unit.

(6)        "County‑adjusted property tax base" shall be computed as follows:

a.         Subtract the present‑use value of agricultural land, horticultural land, and forestland in the county, as defined in G.S. 105‑277.2, from the total assessed real property valuation of the county.

b.         Adjust the resulting amount by multiplying by a weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies.

c.         Add to the resulting amount the following:

1.         Present‑use value of agricultural land, horticultural land, and forestland, as defined in G.S. 105‑277.2.

2.         Value of property of public service companies, determined in accordance with Article 23 of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes.

3.         Personal property value for the county.

(7)        "County‑adjusted property tax base per square mile" means the county‑adjusted property tax base divided by the number of square miles of land area in the county.

(8)        "County wealth as a percentage of State average wealth" shall be computed as follows:

a.         Compute the percentage that the county per capita income is of the State per capita income and weight the resulting percentage by a factor of five‑tenths.

b.         Compute the percentage that the anticipated total county revenue availability per student is of the anticipated State average revenue availability per student and weight the resulting percentage by a factor of four‑tenths.

c.         Compute the percentage that the county‑adjusted property tax base per square mile is of the State‑adjusted property tax base per square mile and weight the resulting percentage by a factor of one‑tenth.

d.         Add the three weighted percentages to derive the county wealth as a percentage of the State average wealth.

(9)        "Effective county tax rate" means the actual county tax rate multiplied by a weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies.

(10)      "Effective State average tax rate" means the average of effective county tax rates for all counties.

(11)      "Local current expense funds" means the most recent county current expense appropriations to public schools, as reported by local boards of education in the audit report filed with the Secretary of the Local Government Commission pursuant to G.S. 115C‑447.

(12)      "Per capita income" means the average for the most recent three years for which data are available of the per capita income according to the most recent report of the United States Department of Commerce, Bureau of Economic Analysis, including any reported modifications for prior years as outlined in the most recent report.

(13)      "Sales assessment ratio studies" means sales assessment ratio studies performed by the Department of Revenue under G.S. 105‑289(h).

(14)      "State average current expense appropriations per student" means the most recent State total of county current expense appropriations to public schools, as reported by local boards of education in the audit report filed with the Secretary of the Local Government Commission pursuant to G.S. 115C‑447.

(15)      "State average adjusted property tax base per square mile" means the sum of the county‑adjusted property tax bases for all counties divided by the number of square miles of land area in the State.

(16)      "Supplant" means to decrease local per student current expense appropriations from one fiscal year to the next fiscal year.

(17)      "Weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies" means the weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies in the most recent years for which county current expense appropriations and adjusted property tax valuations are available. If real property in a county has been revalued one year prior to the most recent sales assessment ratio study, a weighted average of the two most recent sales assessment ratios shall be used. If property has been revalued the year of the most recent sales assessment ratio study, the sales assessment ratio for the year of revaluation shall be used.

SECTION 7.3.(c)  Eligibility for Funds. – Except as provided in subsection (g) of this section, the State Board of Education shall allocate these funds to local school administrative units located in whole or in part in counties in which the county wealth as a percentage of the State average wealth is less than one hundred percent (100%).

SECTION 7.3.(d)  Allocation of Funds. – Except as provided in subsection (f) of this section, the amount received per average daily membership for a county shall be the difference between the State average current expense appropriations per student and the current expense appropriations per student that the county could provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools. (To derive the current expense appropriations per student that the county could be able to provide given the county's wealth and an average effort to fund public schools, multiply the county's wealth as a percentage of State average wealth by the State average current expense appropriations per student.) The funds for the local school administrative units located in whole or in part in the county shall be allocated to each local school administrative unit located in whole or in part in the county based on the average daily membership of the county's students in the school units. If the funds appropriated for supplemental funding are not adequate to fund the formula fully, each local school administrative unit shall receive a pro rata share of the funds appropriated for supplemental funding.

SECTION 7.3.(e)  Formula for Distribution of Supplemental Funding Pursuant to This Section Only. – The formula in this section is solely a basis for distribution of supplemental funding for low‑wealth counties and is not intended to reflect any measure of the adequacy of the educational program or funding for public schools. The formula is also not intended to reflect any commitment by the General Assembly to appropriate any additional supplemental funds for low‑wealth counties.

SECTION 7.3.(f)  Minimum Effort Required. – Counties that had effective tax rates in the 1996‑1997 fiscal year that were above the State average effective tax rate but that had effective rates below the State average in the 1997‑1998 fiscal year or thereafter shall receive reduced funding under this section. This reduction in funding shall be determined by subtracting the amount that the county would have received pursuant to Section 17.1(g) of Chapter 507 of the 1995 Session Laws from the amount that the county would have received if qualified for full funding and multiplying the difference by ten percent (10%). This method of calculating reduced funding shall apply one time only. This method of calculating reduced funding shall not apply in cases in which the effective tax rate fell below the statewide average effective tax rate as a result of a reduction in the actual property tax rate. In these cases, the minimum effort required shall be calculated in accordance with Section 17.1(g) of Chapter 507 of the 1995 Session Laws. If the county documents that it has increased the per student appropriation to the school current expense fund in the current fiscal year, the State Board of Education shall include this additional per pupil appropriation when calculating minimum effort pursuant to Section 17.1(g) of Chapter 507 of the 1995 Session Laws.

SECTION 7.3.(g)  Nonsupplant Requirement. – A county in which a local school administrative unit receives funds under this section shall use the funds to supplement local current expense funds and shall not supplant local current expense funds. For the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium, the State Board of Education shall not allocate funds under this section to a county found to have used these funds to supplant local per student current expense funds. The State Board of Education shall make a finding that a county has used these funds to supplant local current expense funds in the prior year, or the year for which the most recent data are available, if the following apply:

(1)        The current expense appropriation per student of the county for the current year is less than ninety‑five percent (95%) of the average of the local current expense appropriations per student for the three prior fiscal years; and

(2)        The county cannot show (i) that it has remedied the deficiency in funding or (ii) that extraordinary circumstances caused the county to supplant local current expense funds with funds allocated under this section. The State Board of Education shall adopt rules to implement this section.

SECTION 7.3.(h)  Reports. – The State Board of Education shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee prior to May 1, 2012, if it determines that counties have supplanted funds.

SECTION 7.3.(i)  Department of Revenue Reports. – The Department of Revenue shall provide to the Department of Public Instruction a preliminary report for the current fiscal year of the assessed value of the property tax base for each county prior to March 1 of each year and a final report prior to May 1 of each year. The reports shall include for each county the annual sales assessment ratio and the taxable values of (i) total real property, (ii) the portion of total real property represented by the present‑use value of agricultural land, horticultural land, and forestland, as defined in G.S. 105‑277.2, (iii) property of public service companies determined in accordance with Article 23 of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes, and (iv) personal property.

 

SMALL SCHOOL SYSTEM SUPPLEMENTAL FUNDING

SECTION 7.4.(a)  Funds for Small School Systems. – Except as provided in subsection (b) of this section, the State Board of Education shall allocate funds appropriated for small school system supplemental funding (i) to each county school administrative unit with an average daily membership of fewer than 3,175 students and (ii) to each county school administrative unit with an average daily membership from 3,175 to 4,000 students if the county in which the local school administrative unit is located has a county‑adjusted property tax base per student that is below the State‑adjusted property tax base per student and if the total average daily membership of all local school administrative units located within the county is from 3,175 to 4,000 students. The allocation formula shall do all of the following:

(1)        Round all fractions of positions to the next whole position.

(2)        Provide five and one‑half additional regular classroom teachers in counties in which the average daily membership per square mile is greater than four and seven additional regular classroom teachers in counties in which the average daily membership per square mile is four or fewer.

(3)        Provide additional program enhancement teachers adequate to offer the standard course of study.

(4)        Change the duty‑free period allocation to one teacher assistant per 400 average daily membership.

(5)        Provide a base for the consolidated funds allotment of at least seven hundred seventeen thousand three hundred sixty dollars ($717,360), excluding textbooks, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and a base of seven hundred seventeen thousand three hundred sixty dollars ($717,360) for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.

(6)        Allot vocational education funds for grade 6 as well as for grades 7‑12. If funds appropriated for each fiscal year for small school system supplemental funding are not adequate to fully fund the program, the State Board of Education shall reduce the amount allocated to each county school administrative unit on a pro rata basis. This formula is solely a basis for distribution of supplemental funding for certain county school administrative units and is not intended to reflect any measure of the adequacy of the educational program or funding for public schools. The formula also is not intended to reflect any commitment by the General Assembly to appropriate any additional supplemental funds for such county administrative units.

SECTION 7.4.(b)  Nonsupplant Requirement. – A county in which a local school administrative unit receives funds under this section shall use the funds to supplement local current expense funds and shall not supplant local current expense funds. For the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium, the State Board of Education shall not allocate funds under this section to a county found to have used these funds to supplant local per student current expense funds. The State Board of Education shall make a finding that a county has used these funds to supplant local current expense funds in the prior year, or the year for which the most recent data are available, if the following apply:

(1)        The current expense appropriation per student of the county for the current year is less than ninety‑five percent (95%) of the average of the local current expense appropriations per student for the three prior fiscal years; and

(2)        The county cannot show (i) that it has remedied the deficiency in funding or (ii) that extraordinary circumstances caused the county to supplant local current expense funds with funds allocated under this section. The State Board of Education shall adopt rules to implement this section.

SECTION 7.4.(c)  Phase‑Out Provisions. – If a local school administrative unit becomes ineligible for funding under this formula because of (i) an increase in the population of the county in which the local school administrative unit is located or (ii) an increase in the county‑adjusted property tax base per student of the county in which the local school administrative unit is located, funding for that unit shall be continued for seven years after the unit becomes ineligible.

SECTION 7.4.(d)  Definitions. – As used in this section, the following definitions apply:

(1)        "Average daily membership" means within two percent (2%) of the average daily membership as defined in the North Carolina Public Schools Allotment Policy Manual adopted by the State Board of Education.

(2)        "County‑adjusted property tax base per student" means the total assessed property valuation for each county, adjusted using a weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies, divided by the total number of students in average daily membership who reside within the county.

(3)        "Local current expense funds" means the most recent county current expense appropriations to public schools, as reported by local boards of education in the audit report filed with the Secretary of the Local Government Commission pursuant to G.S. 115C‑447.

(4)        "Sales assessment ratio studies" means sales assessment ratio studies performed by the Department of Revenue under G.S. 105‑289(h).

(5)        "State‑adjusted property tax base per student" means the sum of all county‑adjusted property tax bases divided by the total number of students in average daily membership who reside within the State.

(6)        "Supplant" means to decrease local per student current expense appropriations from one fiscal year to the next fiscal year.

(7)        "Weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies" means the weighted average of the three most recent annual sales assessment ratio studies in the most recent years for which county current expense appropriations and adjusted property tax valuations are available. If real property in a county has been revalued one year prior to the most recent sales assessment ratio study, a weighted average of the two most recent sales assessment ratios shall be used. If property has been revalued during the year of the most recent sales assessment ratio study, the sales assessment ratio for the year of revaluation shall be used.

SECTION 7.4.(e)  Reports. – The State Board of Education shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee prior to May 1, 2012, if it determines that counties have supplanted funds.

SECTION 7.4.(f)  Use of Funds. – Local boards of education are encouraged to use at least twenty percent (20%) of the funds they receive pursuant to this section to improve the academic performance of children who are performing at Level I or II on either reading or mathematics end‑of‑grade tests in grades 3‑8.

 

DISCREPANCIES BETWEEN ANTICIPATED AND ACTUAL ADM

SECTION 7.5.(a)  If the State Board of Education does not have sufficient resources in the ADM Contingency Reserve line item to make allotment adjustments in accordance with the Allotment Adjustments for ADM Growth provisions of the North Carolina Public Schools Allotment Policy Manual, the State Board of Education may use funds appropriated to State Aid for Public Schools for this purpose.

SECTION 7.5.(b)  If the higher of the first or second month average daily membership in a local school administrative unit is at least two percent (2%) or 100 students lower than the anticipated average daily membership used for allotments for the unit, the State Board of Education shall reduce allotments for the unit. The reduced allotments shall be based on the higher of the first or second month average daily membership plus one‑half of the number of students overestimated in the anticipated average daily membership.

The allotments reduced pursuant to this subsection shall include only those allotments that may be increased pursuant to the Allotment Adjustments for ADM Growth provisions of the North Carolina Public Schools Allotment Policy Manual.

 

LITIGATION RESERVE FUNDS

SECTION 7.6.  The State Board of Education may expend up to five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000) each year for the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years from unexpended funds for certified employees' salaries to pay expenses related to litigation.

 

ABCS OF PUBLIC EDUCATION

SECTION 7.7.  Notwithstanding G.S. 115C‑105.36, the State Board of Education shall place a moratorium on financial awards paid to school personnel in the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years based on 2010‑2011 student academic performance.

 

MORE AT FOUR PROGRAM

SECTION 7.8.(a)  The Department of Public Instruction shall continue the implementation of the "More at Four" prekindergarten program for four‑year‑olds who are at risk for school failure in all counties. The State prekindergarten program shall serve children who reach the age of four on or before August 31 of that school year and who meet eligibility criteria that indicate a child's risk for school failure.  Prekindergarten classrooms shall be operated in public schools, Head Start programs, and licensed child care facilities that choose to participate under procedures defined by the Office of Early Learning within the Department of Public Instruction. All such classrooms shall be subject to the supervision of the Office of Early Learning and shall be operated in accordance with standards adopted by the State Board of Education.

SECTION 7.8.(b)  The Office of Early Learning shall specify program standards and requirements addressing the following:

(1)        Early learning standards and curricula.

(2)        Teacher education and specialized training.

(3)        Teacher in‑service training and professional development.

(4)        Maximum class size.

(5)        Staff‑child ratio.

(6)        Screenings, referrals, and support services.

(7)        Meals.

(8)        Monitoring of sites to demonstrate adherence to State programs standards.

SECTION 7.8.(c)  The State Board of Education shall submit an annual report no later than March 15 of each year to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Education, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Education,  the Office of State Budget and Management, and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall include the following:

(1)        The number of children participating in State prekindergarten.

(2)        The number of children participating in State prekindergarten who have never been served in other early education programs, such as child care, public or private preschool, Head Start, Early Head Start, or early intervention programs.

(3)        The expected State prekindergarten expenditures for the programs and the source of the local contributions.

(4)        The results of an annual evaluation of the program.

SECTION 7.8.(d)  The Office of Early Learning shall establish income eligibility requirements for the program not to exceed seventy‑five percent (75%) of the State median income. Up to twenty percent (20%) of children enrolled may have family incomes in excess of seventy‑five percent (75%) of median income if they have other designated risk factors. Furthermore, any age‑eligible child of (i) an active duty member of the Armed Forces of the United States, including the North Carolina National Guard, State military forces, or a reserve component of the Armed Forces, who is ordered to active duty by the proper authority within the last 18 months or expected to be ordered within the next 18 months or (ii) a member of the Armed Forces of the United States, including the North Carolina National Guard, State military forces, or a reserve component of the Armed Forces, who was injured or killed while serving on active duty, shall be eligible for the program.

SECTION 7.8.(e)  The "More at Four" program funding shall not supplant any funding for classrooms serving four‑year‑olds as of the 2005‑2006 fiscal year. Support of existing four‑year‑old classrooms with "More at Four" program funding shall be permitted when current funding is eliminated, reduced, or redirected as required to meet other specified federal or State  mandates.

 

UNIFORM EDUCATION REPORTING SYSTEM (UERS) FUNDS

SECTION 7.9.(a)  Funds appropriated for the Uniform Education Reporting System shall not revert at the end of the 2010‑2011 fiscal year.

SECTION 7.9.(b)  This section becomes effective June 30, 2011.

 

FOCUSED EDUCATION REFORM PROGRAM FUNDS DO NOT REVERT

SECTION 7.10.(a)  Funds appropriated for the Focused Education Reform Pilot Program that are unexpended and unencumbered at the end of the 2010‑2011 fiscal year shall not revert but shall remain available for expenditure for that purpose through the 2011‑2012 fiscal year.

SECTION 7.10.(b)  This section becomes effective June 30, 2011.

 

PROTECTION OF THE CLASSROOM WHILE MAXIMIZING FLEXIBILITY

SECTION 7.11.(a)  For fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013, local school administrative units shall make every effort to reduce spending whenever and wherever such budget reductions are appropriate with the goal of protecting direct classroom services.

SECTION 7.11.(b)  The State Board of Education is authorized to adopt emergency rules in accordance with G.S. 150B‑21.1A to grant maximum flexibility to local school administrative units regarding the expenditure of State funds. These rules shall not be subject to the limitations on transfers of funds between funding allotment categories set out in G.S. 115C‑105.25. These rules shall not permit either of the following:

(1)        The transfer of classroom teacher or teacher assistant allotments to other allotments.

(2)        The transfer of funds from school‑based positions to the central office.

SECTION 7.11.(c)  Within 14 days of the date this act becomes law, the State Board of Education shall notify each local school administrative unit and charter school of the amount the unit must reduce from the State General Fund appropriations. The State Board shall determine the amount of the reduction for each unit on the basis of average daily membership.

SECTION 7.11.(d)  Nothing in this section shall be construed to prohibit any changes, reductions, or transfers made pursuant to Section 7.8 of S.L. 2009‑451 or Section 7.13 of S.L. 2010‑31.

 

NORTH CAROLINA VIRTUAL PUBLIC SCHOOLS

SECTION 7.12.(a)  The North Carolina Virtual Public School (NCVPS) program shall report to the State Board of Education and shall maintain an administrative office at the Department of Public Instruction.

SECTION 7.12.(b)  Subsequent to course consolidation, the Director shall prioritize e‑learning course offerings for students residing in rural and low‑wealth county local school administrative units in order to expand available instructional opportunities. First available e‑learning instructional opportunities should include courses required as part of the standard course of study for high school graduation and AP offerings not otherwise available.

SECTION 7.12.(c)  Section 7.4 of S.L. 2010‑31 is repealed.

SECTION 7.12.(d)  The State Board of Education shall implement an allotment formula for the North Carolina Virtual Public Schools (NCVPS) beginning in the 2011‑2012 school year.

SECTION 7.12.(e)  The funds provided through the North Carolina Virtual Public Schools Allotment Formula shall be the only source of State funds available to the State Board of Education for the purposes of funding NCVPS instructional costs.

SECTION 7.12.(f)  Beginning with the 2011‑2012 school year, the State Board of Education shall take the following steps to implement the North Carolina Virtual Public Schools Allotment Formula:

(1)        Project NCVPS student enrollment by semester and year‑long course types for each local school administrative unit and charter school.

(2)        Establish a per course teacher payment structure for the instructional costs of NCVPS. In establishing this payment structure, the Board shall consider the following:

a.         The payment structure is based on a total compensation analysis to ensure NCVPS teacher pay has parity with similar programs. The total compensation analysis shall take into account salaries, benefits, and work effort to ensure valid comparisons between occupations.

b.         The effects any change in NCVPS teacher payments may have on the attraction and retention of NCVPS teachers.

(3)        Based on the per course teacher pay structure, the Board shall develop a per student fee structure for in‑State students. The fee structure shall ensure that the projected cost for local school administrative units and charter schools equals the projected instructional cost for NCVPS courses. Projected enrollment by course type shall be multiplied by the per course fees to determine the total instructional cost for each local school administrative unit and charter school. The Board shall establish a separate per student fee structure for out‑of‑state students, which shall be adjusted upward from the in‑State student fee structure by an amount determined appropriate by the Board.

(4)        Transfer a dollar amount equal to seventy‑five percent (75%) of the unit's projected instructional cost from the classroom teacher allotment to NCVPS.

(5)        No later than February 21 of each year, calculate the actual instructional cost for each local school administrative unit based upon actual NCVPS enrollment as of that date. Subtract the amount transferred pursuant to subdivision (4) of this subsection from the actual instructional cost for each unit and transfer from the teacher allotment the remaining dollar amount owed, up to a maximum of one hundred percent (100%) of the projected cost. The State Board shall develop a policy regarding returning funds to local school administrative units and charter schools in cases where the amount transferred pursuant to subdivision (4) of this subsection exceeds the actual instructional costs.

NCVPS shall use the funds transferred to it to provide the NCVPS program at no cost to all students in North Carolina who are enrolled in North Carolina's public schools, Department of Defense schools, and schools operated by the Bureau of Indian Affairs.

(6)        In establishing the fee structure and payment structure for NCVPS, the Board shall consider recommendations from the eLearning Commission and the NCVPS Advisory Board. The Board shall oversee all revenue generation from the sale of NCVPS courses to out‑of‑state educational entities and the use of NCVPS courses by home‑schooled and private school students. The Board shall direct NCVPS to develop a revenue‑generating plan for the sale of courses to out‑of‑state educational entities. Revenue from these sales shall be used to offset instructional costs to local school administrative units and charter schools. NCVPS shall submit its plan to the Board by September 1, 2011.

SECTION 7.12.(g)  Beginning in calendar year 2011, the Director of NCVPS shall submit an annual report on NCVPS to the State Board of Education no later than December 1. The report shall use data from the previous fiscal year and shall include statistics on actual vs. projected costs to local administrative units and charter schools, student enrollment, virtual teacher salaries, and measures of academic achievement.

The Director of NCVPS shall continue to ensure the following:

(1)        Course quality standards are established and met.

(2)        All e‑learning opportunities offered by State‑funded entities to public school students are consolidated under the NCVPS program, eliminating course duplication.

(3)        All courses offered through NCVPS are aligned to the North Carolina Standard Course of Study.

SECTION 7.12.(h)  NCVPS is authorized to charge an access fee based upon the percentage of ADM for each local school administrative unit or charter school with ADM in any grade from six to twelve.  The total fee shall generate eight hundred thirty‑six thousand dollars ($836,000) and shall be used for NCVPS operating costs.  The total fee shall be adjusted annually based upon the percentage growth in NCVPS enrollment, ensuring the expansion of services due to increased virtual student enrollment.

SECTION 7.12.(i)  Funds shall be appropriated from Learn and Earn Online and  transferred to an NCVPS reserve.  Two million thirty thousand nine hundred twenty‑three dollars ($2,030,923) shall be appropriated for NCVPS administrative salaries and benefits and the remainder shall provide an NCVPS enrollment reserve, ensuring that all North Carolina students have access to NCVPS courses. The State Board of Education shall set guidelines for the use of the enrollment reserve.

SECTION 7.12.(j)  The State Board of Education shall report to the Office of the Governor, Office of State Budget and Management, Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, and the Fiscal Research Division by December 15, 2011, on its implementation of this section.

 

SCHOOL BUS PURCHASES

SECTION 7.13.(a)  G.S. 115C‑249 reads as rewritten:

"§ 115C‑249.  Purchase and maintenance of school buses, materials and supplies.

(a)        To the extent that the funds shall be made available to it for such purpose, a local board of education is authorized to purchase from time to time such additional school buses and service vehicles or replacements for school buses and service vehicles, as may be deemed by such board to be necessary for the safe and efficient transportation of pupils enrolled in the schools within such local school administrative unit. Any school bus so purchased shall be constructed and equipped as prescribed by the provisions of this Article and by the regulations of the State Board of Education issued pursuant thereto. Any school bus so purchased that is capable of operating on diesel fuel shall be capable of operating on diesel fuel with a minimum biodiesel concentration of B‑20, as defined in G.S. 143‑58.4. At least two percent (2%) of the total volume of fuel purchased annually by local school districts statewide for use in school bus diesel engine motor vehicles shall be biodiesel fuel of a minimum blend of B‑20, to the extent that biodiesel blend is available and compatible with the technology of the vehicles or equipment used.

(b)        The tax‑levying authorities of any county are hereby authorized to make provision from time to time in the capital outlay budget of the county for the purchase of such school buses or service vehicles.

(c)        Any funds appropriated from time to time by the General Assembly for the purchase of school buses or service vehicles shall be allocated by the State Board of Education to the respective local boards of education in accordance with the requirements of such boards as determined by the State Board of Education, and thereupon shall be paid over to the respective local boards of education in accordance with such allocation.

(d)        The title to any additional or replacement school bus or service vehicle purchased pursuant to the provisions of this section, shall be taken in the name of the board of education of such local school administrative unit, and such bus shall in all respects be maintained and operated pursuant to the provisions of this Article in the same manner as any other public school bus.Article.

(e)        It shall be the duty of the county board of education to provide adequate buildings and equipment for the storage and maintenance of all school buses and service vehicles owned or operated by the board of education of any local school administrative unit in such county. It shall be the duty of the tax‑levying authorities of such county to provide in its capital outlay budget for the construction or acquisition of such buildings and equipment as may be required for this purpose.

(f)         In the event of the damage or destruction of any school bus or service vehicle by fire, collision, or otherwise, the board of education of the local school administrative unit which shall own or operate such bus or service vehicle may apply to the State Board of Education for funds with which to replace it. If the State Board of Education finds that such bus or service vehicle has been destroyed or damaged to the extent that it cannot be made suitable for further use, and if the State Board of Education finds that the replacement of such bus or service vehicle is necessary in order to enable such local school administrative unit to operate properly its school bus transportation system, the State Board of Education shall allot to the board of education of such local school administrative unit from the funds now held by the State Board of Education for the replacement of school buses or service vehicles, or from funds hereafter appropriated by the General Assembly for that purpose, a sum sufficient to purchase a new school bus or service vehicle to be used as a replacement for such damaged or destroyed bus or service vehicle and upon such allocation such sum shall be paid over to or for the account of the board of education of such local school administrative unit for such purpose.

(g)        Repealed by Session Laws 2003‑147, s. 3, effective for a local school administrative unit when the unit is certified as being E‑Procurement compliant, or April 1, 2004, whichever occurs first.

(h)        Appropriations by the General Assembly for the purchase of public school buses shall not revert to the General Fund. Any unexpended portion of those appropriations shall at the end of each fiscal year be transferred to a reserve account and be held, together with any other funds appropriated for the purpose, for the purchase of public school buses."

SECTION 7.13.(b)  G.S. 115C‑426(f) reads as rewritten:

"(f)       The capital outlay fund shall include appropriations for:

(1)        The acquisition of real property for school purposes, including but not limited to school sites, playgrounds, athletic fields, administrative headquarters, and garages.

(2)        The acquisition, construction, reconstruction, enlargement, renovation, or replacement of buildings and other structures, including but not limited to buildings for classrooms and laboratories, physical and vocational educational purposes, libraries, auditoriums, gymnasiums, administrative offices, storage, and vehicle maintenance.

(3)        The acquisition or replacement of furniture and furnishings, instructional apparatus, data‑processing equipment, business machines, and similar items of furnishings and equipment.

(4)        The acquisition of school buses as additions to the fleet.buses.

(5)        The acquisition of activity buses and other motor vehicles.

(6)        Such other objects of expenditure as may be assigned to the capital outlay fund by the uniform budget format.

The cost of acquiring or constructing a new building, or reconstructing, enlarging, or renovating an existing building, shall include the cost of all real property and interests in real property, and all plants, works, appurtenances, structures, facilities, furnishings, machinery, and equipment necessary or useful in connection therewith; financing charges; the cost of plans, specifications, studies, reports, and surveys; legal expenses; and all other costs necessary or incidental to the construction, reconstruction, enlargement, or renovation.

No contract for the purchase of a site shall be executed nor any funds expended therefor without the approval of the board of county commissioners as to the amount to be spent for the site; and in case of a disagreement between a board of education and a board of county commissioners as to the amount to be spent for the site, the procedure provided in G.S. 115C‑431 shall, insofar as the same may be applicable, be used to settle the disagreement.

Appropriations in the capital outlay fund shall be funded by revenues made available for capital outlay purposes by the State Board of Education and the board of county commissioners, supplemental taxes levied by or on behalf of the local school administrative unit pursuant to a local act or G.S. 115C‑501 to 115C‑511, the proceeds of the sale of capital assets, the proceeds of claims against fire and casualty insurance policies, and other sources."

 

COSTS OF WORKERS' COMPENSATION

SECTION 7.15.(a)  G.S. 115C‑337 reads as rewritten:

"§ 115C‑337.  Workers' compensation for school employees.

(a)        Workers' Compensation Act Applicable to School Employees. – The provisions of the Workers' Compensation Act shall be applicable to all school employees, and the State Board of Education shall make arrangements necessary to carry out the provisions of the Workers' Compensation Act applicable to these employees paid from State school funds. Liability of the State for compensation shall be confined to school employees paid by the State from State school funds for injuries or death caused by accident arising out of and in the course of their employment in connection with the state‑operated school term. The State shall be liable for this compensation on the basis of the average weekly wage of the employees as defined in the Workers' Compensation Act, to the extent of the proportionate part of each employee's salary that is paid from State funds. The State shall also be liable for workers' compensation for all school employees employed in connection with the teaching of vocational agriculture, home economics, trades and industries, and other vocational subjects, supported in part by State and federal funds, which liability shall cover the entire period of service of these employees, to the extent of the proportionate part of each employee's salary that is paid from State funds. apply to all employees of local school administrative units. The local school administrative units shall be liable for workers' compensation for school employees, including lunchroom employees, whose salaries or wages are paid by the local units from local or special funds. their employees. The local units may provide insurance to cover this compensation liability and to include the cost of this insurance in their annual budgets.

The provisions of this subsection shall not apply to any person, firm, or corporation making voluntary contributions to schools for any purpose, and the person, firm, or corporation shall not be liable for the payment of any sum of money under this Chapter.

(b)        Payment of Awards to School Bus Drivers Pursuant to the Workers' Compensation Act. – In the event that the Industrial Commission shall make an award pursuant to the Workers' Compensation Act against any local board of education on account of injuries to or the death of a school bus driver arising out of and in the course of his employment as such driver, the local board of education shall draw a requisition upon the State Board of Education for the amount required to pay such award. The State Board of Education shall honor such requisition to the extent that it shall have in its hands, or subject to its control, available funds which have been or shall thereafter be appropriated by the General Assembly for the support of the school term. It shall be the duty of the local board of education to apply all funds received by it from the State Board of Education pursuant to such requisition to the payment of such award. Neither the State nor the State Board of Education shall be deemed the employer of such school bus driver, nor shall the State or the State Board of Education be liable to any school bus driver or any other person for the payment of any claim, award, or judgment under the provisions of the Workers' Compensation Act or of any other law of this State for any injury or death arising out of or in the course of the operation by such driver of a public school bus. Neither the local board of education, the local school administrative unit, nor the tax levying authorities for the local school administrative unit shall be liable for the payment of any award made pursuant to the provisions of this subsection in excess of the amount paid upon such requisition by the State Board of Education, nor shall the local school board of education, the local school administrative unit, nor the said tax levying authorities be required to provide or carry workers' compensation insurance for such purpose."

SECTION 7.15.(b)  G.S. 115C‑256 reads as rewritten:

"§ 115C‑256.  School bus drivers under Workers' Compensation Act.

Awards to school bus drivers under the Workers' Compensation Act shall be made pursuant to the provisions of G.S. 115C‑337(b).G.S. 115C‑337."

 

CAREER AND COLLEGE PROMISE

SECTION 7.16.(a)  The State Board of Education and the North Carolina Community College System shall establish "Career and College Promise" to achieve the goal that every child shall graduate ready for a career, two‑ or four‑year college, or technical training.  The purpose of Career and College Promise is to offer structured opportunities for qualified high school students to dually enroll in community college courses that provide pathways consistent with subsection (b) of this section that lead to a certificate, diploma, or degree as well as provide entry‑level jobs skills. Academic credits earned through Career and College Promise shall enable students who continue into postsecondary education after graduating from high school to complete a postsecondary credential in less time than would normally be required.  All existing high school transition programs, including Huskins, Concurrent Enrollment, Cooperative and Innovative High Schools, Learn and Earn, and Learn and Earn Online, shall be consolidated and replaced by Career and College Promise.

SECTION 7.16.(b)  North Carolina community colleges, subject to approval by the State Board of Community Colleges, may offer the following Career and College pathways aligned with the K‑12 curriculum and career‑ and college‑ready standards adopted by the State Board of Education:

(1)        Career Technical Education Pathway (CTE), which leads to a certificate or diploma that is aligned with one or more high school Tech Prep Career Clusters.

(2)        College Transfer Pathway, which leads to a college transfer certificate that requires the successful completion of eight college transfer courses, including English and mathematics.

(3)        Cooperative Innovative High Schools Programs approved under Article 16, Part 9 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes.

SECTION 7.16.(c)  Program Accountability.The State Board of Education and the North Carolina Community College System shall jointly develop and implement a program accountability plan to evaluate short‑term and long‑term outcomes for Career and College Promise. Outcomes to be measured shall include the following:

(1)        The impact of dual enrollment on high school completion.

(2)        The academic achievement and performance of dually enrolled high school students.

(3)        The number of students who successfully complete college certificates while dually enrolled.

(4)        The impact of dual enrollment and certificate completion on enrollment in college.

(5)        The persistence and completion rates of students who continue into college programs after high school graduation.

(6)        The academic achievement and performance of students who continue into college programs after high school graduation.

SECTION 7.16.(d)  Community colleges shall generate budget FTE for instruction provided through Career and College Promise.

SECTION 7.16.(e)  G.S. 115D‑1.1 reads as rewritten:

"§ 115D‑1.1.  Discretion in admissions.

(a)        Notwithstanding G.S. 115D‑1, a student under the age of 16 may enroll in a community college if the following conditions are met:

(1)        The president of the community college or the president's designee finds, based on criteria established by the State Board of Community Colleges, that the student is intellectually gifted and that the student has the maturity to justify admission to the community college; and

(1)        The high school student is a junior or senior enrolled in a Career and College Promise pathway or a Cooperative Innovative High School Program as established in G.S. 115C‑238.50; and

(2)        One of the following persons approves the student's enrollment in a community college:

a.         The local board of education, or the board's designee, for the local school administrative unit in which the student is domiciled or is enrolled.

b.         The administrator, or the administrator's designee, of the nonpublic school in which the student is enrolled.

c.         The person who provides the academic instruction in the home school in which the student is enrolled.

d.         The designee of the board of directors of the charter school in which the student is enrolled.

e.         The administrator of the college or university where the student is enrolled.

(b)        The State Board of Community Colleges, in consultation with the Department of Public Instruction, shall adopt rules to implement this section."

SECTION 7.16.(f)  G.S. 115D‑1.2 is repealed.

SECTION 7.16.(g)  G.S. 115D‑20(4) reads as rewritten:

"(4)      To apply the standards and requirements for admission and graduation of students and other standards established by the State Board of Community Colleges. Provided, notwithstanding any law or administrative rule to the contrary, local administrative boards and local school boards may establish cooperative programs in the areas they serve to provide for college courses to be offered to qualified high school students with college credits to be awarded to those high school students upon the successful completion of the courses. local community colleges, subject to the approval of the State Board of Community Colleges, are permitted to collaborate with local school administrative units in the establishment of cooperative innovative high school programs, as provided by Part 9 of Article 16 of Chapter 115C of the General Statutes, as well as academic transition pathways for qualified high school students that lead to a career technical education credential or a college transfer certificate. The State Board of Education and the State Board of Community Colleges shall jointly determine the eligibility standards high school students must meet to qualify for these programs. College credits shall be awarded to those high school students upon the successful completion of the course(s). Provided, further, that during the summer quarter, persons less than 16 years old may be permitted to take noncredit courses on a self‑supporting basis, subject to rules of the State Board of Community Colleges. Provided, further, that high school students may be permitted to take noncredit courses in safe driving on a self‑supporting basis during the academic year or the summer."

SECTION 7.16.(h)  The North Carolina Community College System, The University of North Carolina General Administration, and the North Carolina Independent Colleges and Universities shall develop a plan for articulation of a college transfer certificate to all UNC institutions and participating independent colleges and universities.

 

TEACHING FELLOWS GRADUATE PLACEMENT

SECTION 7.17.  The Public School Forum will report on the placement of Teaching Fellows graduates in the public schools. The report, due November 15, 2011, to the Office of the Governor and the Office of State Budget and Management, will provide Teaching Fellows placement data disaggregated based upon ABCs and AYP school performance.

 

PART VIII. COMMUNITY COLLEGES

 

CARRYFORWARD OF COLLEGE INFORMATION SYSTEM FUNDS

SECTION 8.1.(a)  Funds appropriated in this act to the Community Colleges System Office for the College Information System shall not revert at the end of the 2010‑2011 fiscal year but shall remain available until expended.  These funds may be used only to purchase periodic system upgrades.

SECTION 8.1.(b)  Subsection (a) of this section becomes effective June 30, 2011.

 

ESTABLISH GED TESTING FEES

SECTION 8.2.(a)  The State Board of Community Colleges shall assess an initial fee of fifteen dollars ($15.00) to students taking the General Education Development (GED) test.  This subsection becomes effective August 15, 2011.

SECTION 8.2.(b)  Effective July 1, 2012, G.S. 115D‑5(s) reads as rewritten:

"(s)       The State Board of Community Colleges may establish, retain and budget fees charged to students taking the General Education Development (GED) test. Fees collected for this purpose shall be used only to (i) offset the costs of the GED test, including the cost of scoring the test, (ii) offset the costs of printing GED certificates, and (iii) meet federal and State reporting requirements related to the test."

SECTION 8.2.(c)  The State Board of Community Colleges shall adopt rules implementing subsection (b) of this section.  Such rules shall be in place before fees are increased by the Board.

 

USE OF CREDIT BALANCE FUNDS FOR EQUIPMENT

SECTION 8.3.(a)  Of the credit balance remaining to the State of North Carolina at the close of fiscal year 2010‑2011, twenty‑five million dollars ($25,000,000) shall be appropriated to the State Board of Community Colleges to be allocated to community colleges to assist in the purchasing of instructional equipment. This equipment shall be used to retrain displaced workers and spur economic development in such areas as health care, science, engineering, and technical education.

SECTION 8.3.(b)  This section becomes effective June 30, 2011.

 

USE OF OVERREALIZED RECEIPTS TO SUPPORT ENROLLMENT GROWTH RESERVE RATHER THAN EQUIPMENT RESERVE

SECTION 8.4.  G.S. 115D‑31(e) reads as rewritten:

"(e)       If receipts for community college tuition and fees exceed the amount certified in General Fund Codes at the end of a fiscal year, the State Board of Community Colleges shall shall, subject to cash availability, transfer the amount of receipts and fees above those budgeted to the Equipment Reserve Fund.Enrollment Growth Reserve. Funds in the Enrollment Growth Reserve shall not revert to the General Fund and shall remain available to the State Board until expended. The State Board may allocate funds in this reserve to colleges experiencing an enrollment increase greater than five percent (5%) of budgeted enrollment levels."

 

WORKERS' COMPENSATION TO BE PAID FROM LOCAL FUNDS

SECTION 8.5.  G.S. 115D‑32(a)(2)b.1. reads as rewritten:

"b.        Support services:

1.         Cost of insurance for buildings, contents, motor vehicles, workers' compensation, compensation for institutional employees paid from local funds, and other necessary insurance."

 

IMPLEMENT ALTERNATIVE FORMULA MODEL

SECTION 8.6.(a)  To reflect the different costs of academic programs, the State Board of Community Colleges shall allocate formula funds appropriated to support curriculum and continuing education (occupational extension only) through a formula that provides an instructional base allocation to all colleges and allocates remaining funds on a weighted FTE basis.

SECTION 8.6.(b)  In determining the appropriate weighting, the State Board of Community Colleges shall weigh curriculum courses in high cost areas such as health care, technical education, and lab‑based science courses more heavily than other curriculum courses. The State Board shall also weigh continuing education courses that lead to a third‑party credential or certification and courses providing an industry‑designed curriculum more heavily than other continuing education (occupational extension) courses.

SECTION 8.6.(c)  The State Board of Community Colleges shall consolidate the Health Sciences Programs and Technical Education allotments into the alternative formula model.

SECTION 8.6.(d)  This formula restructuring shall be completed and approved before the State Board of Community Colleges allocates funds to the community colleges for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year.

 

FUTURE NCCCS ENROLLMENT REQUESTS

SECTION 8.7.(a)  Beginning with any adjustments to the 2011‑2012 fiscal year budget, and annually thereafter, the State Board of Community Colleges' requests for funding enrollment growth shall provide a detailed description of the costs of educating community college students. This request shall be based on the current year's enrollment, listed by college and aggregated for the System as a whole.

SECTION 8.7.(b)  Enrollment requests shall include the following information for each community college:

(1)        The budgeted enrollment for the current year, divided between the categories of instruction: curriculum, continuing education, and Basic Skills.

(2)        The budgeted enrollment for the current year, divided between tiers of instruction, as set forth in Section 8.6 of this act.

(3)        The actual enrollment for the two years prior to the current year.

(4)        A 5‑year enrollment projection at each community college by category and tier of instruction.

(5)        The projected requirements and anticipated tuition receipts for the growth in regular‑term enrollment.

(6)        The costs per FTE in each category and tier of instruction, to include the following component parts:

a.         Instructional costs, including faculty salaries and other costs.

b.         Student support services and other college administrative costs.

 

MANAGEMENT FLEXIBILITY REDUCTION/COMMUNITY COLLEGES

SECTION 8.8.  The management flexibility reduction for the North Carolina Community College System shall be allocated by the State Board of Community Colleges in a manner that accounts for the unique needs of each college and provides for the equitable distribution of funds to the institutions consistent with G.S. 115D‑5(a). The State Board of Community Colleges may recommend adjustments to funding for basic skills, curriculum, and continuing education. Before taking reductions to instructional budgets, the community colleges shall consider reducing budgets for senior and middle management personnel and for programs that have both low enrollment and low postgraduate success. Colleges shall minimize the impact on student support services and on the retraining of dislocated workers. Colleges shall not reduce funding for financial aid, equipment, or the Small Business Centers. The community colleges shall also review their institutional funds to determine whether there are monies available in those funds that can be used to assist with operating costs before taking reductions in instructional budgets.

 

REORGANIZATION OF THE COMMUNITY COLLEGES SYSTEM OFFICE

SECTION 8.9.(a)  Notwithstanding any other provision of law, and consistent with the authority established in G.S. 115D‑3, the President of the North Carolina Community College System may reorganize the Community Colleges System Office in accordance with recommendations and plans submitted to and approved by the State Board of Community Colleges.

SECTION 8.9.(b)  This section expires June 30, 2012.

 

REPEAL UNUSED REPORTS

SECTION 8.10.(a)  G.S. 115D‑4.1(e) reads as rewritten:

"(e)       The State Board of Community Colleges shall develop appropriate criteria and standards to regulate the operation of college transfer programs. The criteria and standards shall require all college transfer programs to continue to meet the accreditation standards of the Southern Association of Colleges and Schools.

The State Board of Community Colleges shall report annually to the General Assembly on compliance of the community colleges with these criteria and standards."

SECTION 8.10.(b)  G.S. 115D‑5(j) reads as rewritten:

"(j)       The State Board of Community Colleges shall use its Board Reserve Fund for feasibility studies, pilot projects, start‑up of new programs, and innovative ideas. The State Board shall report to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee on expenditures from the State Board Reserve Fund on January 15 and June 15 each year."

 

EXTEND SMALL BUSINESS INCUBATOR SERVICES

SECTION 8.11.  G.S. 66‑58(3a) reads as rewritten:

"(3a)     The use of community college personnel or facilities, with the consent of the trustees of that college, in support of or by a private business enterprise located on a community college campus or in the service area of a community college for one or more of the following specific services in support of economic development:

a.         Small business incubators. – As used in this sub‑subdivision, the term "small business incubators" means sites for new business ventures in the service area of the community college that are in need of the support and assistance provided by the college; and, without which, the likelihood of success of the business would be greatly diminished. The services of the small business incubator shall not extend to any such new business venture for a period of more than 24 months.48 months, subject to the approval of a community college's local board of trustees.

b.         Product testing services.

c.         Videoconferencing services provided to the public for occasional use."

 

BASIC SKILLS PLUS

SECTION 8.12.(a)  Notwithstanding any other provision of law, the State Board may authorize a local community college to use up to twenty percent (20%) of the State Literacy Funds allocated to it to provide employability skills, job‑specific occupational and technical skills, and developmental education instruction to students concurrently enrolled in a community college course leading to a high school diploma or equivalent certificate.

SECTION 8.12.(b)  Notwithstanding any other provision of law, if a community college is authorized by the State Board to provide employability skills, job‑specific occupational or technical skills, or developmental education instruction to students concurrently enrolled in a community college course leading to a high school diploma or equivalent certificate, the college may waive the tuition and registration fees associated with this instruction.

 

CLARIFICATION REGARDING EQUIPMENT TITLED TO STATE BOARD

SECTION 8.13.  G.S. 115D‑15 reads as rewritten:

"§ 115D‑15.  Sale, exchange or lease of property; use of proceeds from donated property.

(a)        The board of trustees of any institution organized under this Chapter may, with the prior approval of the North Carolina Community Colleges System Office, convey a right‑of‑way or easement for highway construction or for utility installations or modifications. When in the opinion of the board of trustees the use of any other real property owned or held by the board of trustees is unnecessary or undesirable for the purposes of the institution, the board of trustees, subject to prior approval of the State Board of Community Colleges, may sell, exchange, or lease the property. The board of trustees may dispose of any personal property owned or held by the board of trustees without approval of the State Board of Community Colleges. Personal property titled to the State Board of Community Colleges consistent with G.S. 115D‑14 and G.S. 115D‑58.5 may be transferred to another community college at no cost and without the approval of the State Board of Community Colleges or the Department of Administration, Division of Surplus Property.

Article 12 of Chapter 160A of the General Statutes shall apply to the disposal or sale of any real or personal property under this subsection. Personal property also may be disposed of under procedures adopted by the North Carolina Department of Administration. The proceeds of any sale or lease shall be used for capital outlay purposes, except as provided in subsection (b) of this section.

…."

 

CARRYFORWARD FUNDS TO SUPPORT P‑20 DATA SYSTEM DEVELOPMENT

SECTION 8.14.(a)  Of the funds appropriated to support State Aid allocations to community colleges in FY 2010‑2011, the State Board of Community Colleges may carry forward up to three million dollars ($3,000,000) to be used to develop the P‑20 Data System to track the academic achievement and progression of students from prekindergarten programs through graduate school.  The North Carolina Community College System may use these funds to support software licensing, programming, and other capacity enhancements associated with the development of the P‑20 Data System.

SECTION 8.14.(b)  This section becomes effective June 30, 2011.

 

PART IX. UNIVERSITIES

 

USE OF ESCHEATS FUND FOR NEED‑BASED FINANCIAL AID PROGRAMS

SECTION 9.1.(a)  There is appropriated from the Escheat Fund income to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina the sum of one hundred twenty‑three million six hundred forty‑one thousand forty dollars ($123,641,040) for fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013, to the State Board of Community Colleges the sum of thirteen million nine hundred eighty‑one thousand two hundred two dollars ($13,981,202) for fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013, and to the Department of Administration, Division of Veterans Affairs, the sum of six million five hundred twenty thousand nine hundred sixty‑four dollars ($6,520,964) for fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013. These funds shall be allocated by the State Educational Assistance Authority for need‑based student financial aid in accordance with G.S. 116B‑7.

If the interest income generated from the Escheat Fund is less than the amounts referenced in this section, the difference may be taken from the Escheat Fund principal to reach the appropriations referenced in this section; however, under no circumstances shall the Escheat Fund principal be reduced below the sum of two hundred million dollars ($200,000,000).

SECTION 9.1.(b)  The North Carolina State Education Assistance Authority (SEAA) shall perform all of the administrative functions necessary to implement this program of financial aid. The SEAA shall conduct an evaluation of expenditures of the scholarship programs and implement efficiencies such as, but not limited to, a higher student self‑help component, a family income cap, standardized award amounts, adoption of College Board guidelines for assessment rates on available income, and consideration of campus‑based financial aid.  SEAA may make recommendations for redistribution of funds to The University of North Carolina, Department of Administration, and/or the President of the Community College System regarding their respective scholarship programs, who then may authorize redistribution of unutilized funds for a particular fiscal year, to the extent needed to meet minimal requirements of the respective programs. Program savings resulting from the implementation of efficiencies shall revert to the Escheat Fund.

SECTION 9.1.(c)  All obligations to students for uses of the funds set out in sections that were made prior to the effective date of Section 9.1(a) of this act shall be fulfilled as to students who remain eligible under the provisions of the respective programs.

 

MILLENnIUM TEACHER SCHOLARSHIP LOAN

SECTION 9.2.  The State Education Assistance Authority shall continue to administer the Millennium Teacher Scholarship Program, established by Session Law 2004‑124, s. 9.2(c). The program shall be funded in fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 from the existing trust fund balance.

 

UNC MANAGEMENT FLEXIBILITY REDUCTION

SECTION 9.3.  The management flexibility reduction for The University of North Carolina shall be allocated by the Board of Governors to the constituent institutions and affiliated entities in a manner that recognizes the importance of the academic mission and differences among The University of North Carolina entities. The Board of Governors and the campuses of the constituent institutions shall consider faculty workload adjustments, restructuring of research activities, implementation of span of control measures, reduction of the number of senior and middle management positions, elimination of low‑performing or redundant programs, use of alternative funding sources, and other efficiencies. When implementing personnel reductions, the Board of Governors and the campuses shall make every effort to abolish nonessential positions first. The Board of Governors and the campuses of the constituent institutions also shall review the institutional trust funds and the special funds held by or on behalf of The University of North Carolina and its constituent institutions to determine whether there are monies available in those funds that can be used to assist with operating costs before taking reductions in instructional budgets. In addition, the campuses of the constituent institutions also shall require their faculty to have a teaching workload at least equal to the national average in their Carnegie classification. Budget reductions shall not be considered in funding available for need‑based financial aid.

 

DOCUMENTATION AND ACCOUNTABILITY FOR ENROLLMENT GROWTH FUNDING MODEL

SECTION 9.4.(a)  In order to improve the accuracy and effectiveness of enrollment growth funding, the General Administration of The University of North Carolina shall modify the existing student credit hour enrollment (SCH) change funding model. Modifications shall include, but are not limited to, the following:

(1)        Simplification of the enrollment projection process through use of weighted cost factors applied to projected total growth in SCH by campus.

(2)        Justification and adjustment, if necessary, of funding factors for libraries and general institutional support.

(3)        A performance‑based funding component that will do the following:

a.         Incorporate key performance indicators including, but not limited to, retention and graduation rates.

b.         Establish minimum outcomes necessary to receive enrollment growth funding.

c.         Provide incentive funding for campuses that exceed target outcomes.

(4)        Methodology to account for prior years' projection errors and adjust funding accordingly.

SECTION 9.4.(b)  General Administration shall provide the revised enrollment projection process, revised cost factors, and resulting weighted cost per SCH to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, the Office of State Budget and Management, and the Fiscal Research Division by February 1, 2012.

SECTION 9.4.(c)  The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, with the assistance of General Administration, shall develop written policies for enrollment change funding decisions. The written policies shall address (i) procedures for developing campus enrollment projections, calculating tuition offset, and calculating funding formula elements and cost factors and (ii) criteria for granting hold harmless status. Policies and procedures shall be made available to constituent institutions, the Office of State Budget and Management, and the Fiscal Research Division by February 15, 2012.

SECTION 9.4.(d)  In order to demonstrate transparency and ensure accountability in the enrollment growth funding process, the Board of Governors shall report on the accuracy of enrollment growth projections and establish key performance indicators meaningful to enrollment growth planning. The Board of Governors shall publish this report on its Web site by March 15 each year and shall make printed copies available upon request. The report shall include the following:

(1)        Key performance indicators, including retention and graduation rates and other pertinent measures such as faculty productivity, student learning outcomes, or employee diversity.

(2)        Trends in student credit hours, number of students served, number of new faculty and staff positions by area of responsibility, and other relevant data.

(3)        Analysis of variance between actual fall SCH growth and anticipated SCH growth inputs to the enrollment growth planning model used to project enrollment growth requirements.

(4)        Analysis of variance, by category, between actual fall student full‑time equivalency (FTE) growth and anticipated student FTE growth used in the enrollment growth planning model to project changes in tuition receipts attributed to enrollment growth.

(5)        Analysis of variance between actual fall student FTE growth and anticipated student FTE growth used in the FTE funding formulas to project enrollment growth requirements and tuition receipts for specialized campuses and professional schools.

(6)        Planned follow‑up actions where variances of greater than five percent (5%) exist between actual and projected student credit hours or student FTE.

 

FISCAL ACCOUNTABILITY AND FLEXIBILITY

SECTION 9.5.  G.S. 116‑30.2(a) reads as rewritten:

"(a)       All General Fund appropriations made by the General Assembly for continuing operations of a special responsibility constituent institution of The University of North Carolina shall be made in the form of a single sum to each budget code of the institution for each year of the fiscal period for which the appropriations are being made. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4 and G.S.120‑76(8), each special responsibility constituent institution may expend monies from the overhead receipts special fund budget code and the General Fund monies so appropriated to it in the manner deemed by the Chancellor to be calculated to maintain and advance the programs and services of the institutions, consistent with the directives and policies of the Board of Governors. Special A special responsibility constituent institutions institution may transfer appropriations between budget codes. codes for the purpose of administering interinstitutional programs. These transfers shall be considered certified even if as a result of agreements between special responsibility constituent institutions. Special responsibility constituent institutions may not make intrainstitutional transfers between its General Fund budget codes, unless directed by the General Assembly. The preparation, presentation, and review of General Fund budget requests of special responsibility constituent institutions shall be conducted in the same manner as are requests of other constituent institutions. The quarterly allotment procedure established pursuant to G.S. 143C‑6‑3 shall apply to the General Fund appropriations made for the current operations of each special responsibility constituent institution. All General Fund monies so appropriated to each special responsibility constituent institution shall be recorded, reported, and audited in the same manner as are General Fund appropriations to other constituent institutions."

 

REPORTING ON UNIVERSITY CANCER RESEARCH FUND (UCRF)

SECTION 9.6.  By November 1 of each year, the UCRF of The University of North Carolina shall provide to the Joint Education Legislative Oversight Committee and to the Office of State Budget and Management an annual financial report of the State funds appropriated for the purpose of cancer research under UNC Hospitals, the Lineberger Comprehensive Cancer Center, or both. The report shall include the following components:

(1)        Accounting of expenditures of State funds related to strategic initiatives, development of infrastructure, and ongoing administrative functions.

(2)        Additional funding acquired from extramural sources.

(3)        Measures of impact to the State's economy in the creation of jobs, intellectual property, and start‑up companies.

(4)        Other performance measures directly related to the investment of State funds.

 

UNC BOARD OF GOVERNORS REVIEW OF FACULTY RECRUITMENT AND RETENTION

SECTION 9.7.  The Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina shall review its current policies regarding financial incentives to retain faculty. The review shall focus on the prioritization of Recruitment and Retention dollars and identification of key metrics to measure overall program effectiveness. The Board of Governors shall report its findings and recommendations for changes to the policies, if any, to the Joint Legislative Education Oversight Committee, the Office of State Budget and Management, and the Fiscal Research Division by April 1, 2012.

 

NORTH CAROLINA ADVISORY COMMISSION ON MILITARY AFFAIRS

SECTION 9.8.  G.S. 127C‑2(c) reads as rewritten:

"(c)       The following members, or their designee, shall serve ex officio:

(1)        The Lieutenant Governor.

(1a)      Secretary of Crime Control and Public Safety.

(2)        Secretary of Commerce.

(2a)      The Secretary of Transportation.

(2b)      The Secretary of the Department of Environment and Natural Resources.

(3)        Commanding General 18th Airborne Corps, Fort Bragg.

(4)        Commanding General Marine Corps Base, Camp Lejeune.

(5)        Commanding General Marine Corps Air Station, Cherry Point.

(6)        Commander 4th FW, Seymour Johnson Air Force Base.

(7)        Commander 43rd Airlift Wing, Pope Air Force Base.

(8)        Commander of the U.S. Coast Guard Support Center, Elizabeth City.

(9)        Adjutant General of the North Carolina National Guard.

(10)      The Executive Director of the North Carolina League of Municipalities.

(11)      The Executive Director of the North Carolina Association of County Commissioners.

(12)      The Assistant Secretary for Veterans Affairs, Department of Administration.

(13)      The President of The University of North Carolina.

(14)      The President of the Community College System."

 

PART X. Department of Health and Human Services

 

CHILD CARE SUBSIDY RATES

SECTION 10.1.(a)  The maximum gross annual income for initial eligibility, adjusted biennially, for subsidized child care services shall be seventy‑five percent (75%) of the State median income, adjusted for family size.

SECTION 10.1.(b)  Fees for families who are required to share in the cost of care shall be established based on a percent of gross family income and adjusted for family size. Fees shall be determined as follows:

FAMILY SIZE               PERCENT OF GROSS FAMILY INCOME

1‑3                                                          10%

4‑5                                                            9%

6 or more                                                 8%.

SECTION 10.1.(c)  Payments for the purchase of child care services for low‑income children shall be in accordance with the following requirements:

(1)        Religious‑sponsored child care facilities operating pursuant to G.S. 110‑106 and licensed child care centers and homes that meet the minimum licensing standards that are participating in the subsidized child care program shall be paid the one‑star county market rate or the rate they charge privately paying parents, whichever is lower.

(2)        Licensed child care centers and homes with two or more stars shall receive the market rate for that rated license level for that age group or the rate they charge privately paying parents, whichever is lower.

(3)        Nonlicensed homes shall receive fifty percent (50%) of the county market rate or the rate they charge privately paying parents, whichever is lower.

(4)        No payment shall be made for transportation services.

(5)        No payment shall be made for registration fees charged by child care facilities.

(6)        Payments for subsidized child care services for postsecondary education shall be limited to a maximum of 20 months of enrollment.

The Department of Health and Human Services shall implement necessary rule changes in order to restructure services, including, but not limited to, targeting benefits to employment opportunities.

SECTION 10.1.(d)  Provisions of payment rates for child care providers in counties that do not have at least 50 children in each age group for center‑based and home‑based care are as follows:

(1)        Except as applicable in subdivision (2) of this subsection, payment rates shall be set at the statewide or regional market rate for licensed child care centers and homes.

(2)        If it can be demonstrated that the application of the statewide or regional market rate to a county with fewer than 50 children in each age group is lower than the county market rate and would inhibit the ability of the county to purchase child care for low‑income children, then the county market rate may be applied.

SECTION 10.1.(e)  A market rate shall be calculated for child care centers and homes at each rated license level for each county and for each age group or age category of enrollees and shall be representative of fees charged to parents for each age group of enrollees within the county. The Division of Child Development shall also calculate a statewide rate and regional market rates for each rated license level for each age category.

SECTION 10.1.(f)  Facilities licensed pursuant to Article 7 of Chapter 110 of the General Statutes and facilities operated pursuant to G.S. 110‑106 may participate in the program that provides for the purchase of care in child care facilities for minor children of needy families. No separate licensing requirements shall be used to select facilities to participate. In addition, child care facilities shall be required to meet any additional applicable requirements of federal law or regulations. Child care arrangements exempt from State regulation pursuant to Article 7 of Chapter 110 of the General Statutes shall meet the requirements established by State law and by the Social Services Commission.

County departments of social services or other local contracting agencies shall not use a provider's failure to comply with requirements in addition to those specified in this subsection as a condition for reducing the provider's subsidized child care rate.

SECTION 10.1.(g)  Payment for subsidized child care services provided with Work First Block Grant funds shall comply with all regulations and policies issued by the Division of Child Development for the subsidized child care program.

SECTION 10.1.(h)  Noncitizen families who reside in this State legally shall be eligible for child care subsidies if all other conditions of eligibility are met. If all other conditions of eligibility are met, noncitizen families who reside in this State illegally shall be eligible for child care subsidies only if at least one of the following conditions is met:

(1)        The child for whom a child care subsidy is sought is receiving child protective services or foster care services.

(2)        The child for whom a child care subsidy is sought is developmentally delayed or at risk of being developmentally delayed.

(3)        The child for whom a child care subsidy is sought is a citizen of the United States.

 

CHILD CARE ALLOCATION FORMULA

SECTION 10.2.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall allocate child care subsidy voucher funds to pay the costs of necessary child care for minor children of needy families. The mandatory thirty percent (30%) Smart Start subsidy allocation under G.S. 143B‑168.15(g) shall constitute the base amount for each county's child care subsidy allocation. The Department of Health and Human Services shall use the following method when allocating federal and State child care funds, not including the aggregate mandatory thirty percent (30%) Smart Start subsidy allocation:

(1)        Funds shall be allocated to a county based upon the projected cost of serving children under age 11 in families with all parents working who earn less than seventy‑five percent (75%) of the State median income.

(2)        No county's allocation shall be less than ninety percent (90%) of its State fiscal year 2001‑2002 initial child care subsidy allocation.

SECTION 10.2.(b)  The Department of Health and Human Services may reallocate unused child care subsidy voucher funds in order to meet the child care needs of low‑income families. Any reallocation of funds shall be based upon the expenditures of all child care subsidy voucher funding, including Smart Start funds, within a county.

SECTION 10.2.(c)  Notwithstanding subsection (a) of this section, the Department of Health and Human Services shall allocate up to twenty million dollars ($20,000,000) in federal block grant funds and State funds appropriated for the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years for child care services. These funds shall be allocated to prevent termination of child care services. Funds appropriated for specific purposes, including targeted market rate adjustments given in the past, may also be allocated by the Department separately from the allocation formula described in subsection (a) of this section.

 

CHILD CARE FUNDS MATCHING REQUIREMENT

SECTION 10.3.  No local matching funds may be required by the Department of Health and Human Services as a condition of any locality's receiving its initial allocation of child care funds appropriated by this act unless federal law requires a match. If the Department reallocates additional funds above twenty‑five thousand dollars ($25,000) to local purchasing agencies beyond their initial allocation, local purchasing agencies must provide a twenty percent (20%) local match to receive the reallocated funds. Matching requirements shall not apply when funds are allocated because of a disaster as defined in G.S. 166A‑4(1).

 

CHILD CARE REVOLVING LOAN fund

SECTION 10.4.  Notwithstanding any law to the contrary, funds budgeted for the Child Care Revolving Loan Fund may be transferred to and invested by the financial institution contracted to operate the Fund. The principal and any income to the Fund may be used to make loans, reduce loan interest to borrowers, serve as collateral for borrowers, pay the contractor's cost of operating the Fund, or pay the Department's cost of administering the program.

 

EARLY CHILDHOOD EDUCATION AND DEVELOPMENT INITIATIVES ENHANCEMENTS

SECTION 10.5.(a)  Administrative costs shall be equivalent to, on an average statewide basis for all local partnerships, not more than eight percent (8%) of the total statewide allocation to all local partnerships. For purposes of this subsection, administrative costs shall include costs associated with partnership oversight, business and financial management, general accounting, human resources, budgeting, purchasing, contracting, and information systems management.

SECTION 10.5.(b)  The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and all local partnerships shall use competitive bidding practices in contracting for goods and services on contract amounts as follows:

(1)        For amounts of five thousand dollars ($5,000) or less, the procedures specified by a written policy to be developed by the Board of Directors of the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc.

(2)        For amounts greater than five thousand dollars ($5,000), but less than fifteen thousand dollars ($15,000), three written quotes.

(3)        For amounts of fifteen thousand dollars ($15,000) or more, but less than forty thousand dollars ($40,000), a request for proposal process.

(4)        For amounts of forty thousand dollars ($40,000) or more, a request for proposal process and advertising in a major newspaper.

SECTION 10.5.(c)  The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., and all local partnerships shall, in the aggregate, be required to match no less than fifty percent (50%) of the total amount budgeted for the program in each fiscal year of the biennium as follows:  contributions of cash equal to at least fifteen percent (15%) and in‑kind donated resources equal to no more than five percent (5%) for a total match requirement of twenty percent (20%) for each fiscal year. The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., may carry forward any amount in excess of the required match for a fiscal year in order to meet the match requirement of the succeeding fiscal year. Only in‑kind contributions that are quantifiable shall be applied to the in‑kind match requirement. Volunteer services may be treated as an in‑kind contribution for the purpose of the match requirement of this subsection. Volunteer services that qualify as professional services shall be valued at the fair market value of those services. All other volunteer service hours shall be valued at the statewide average wage rate as calculated from data compiled by the Employment Security Commission in the Employment and Wages in North Carolina Annual Report for the most recent period for which data are available. Expenses, including both those paid by cash and in‑kind contributions, incurred by other participating non‑State entities contracting with the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., or the local partnerships, also may be considered resources available to meet the required private match. In order to qualify to meet the required private match, the expenses shall meet the following requirements:

(1)        Be verifiable from the contractor's records.

(2)        If in‑kind, other than volunteer services, be quantifiable in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles for nonprofit organizations.

(3)        Not include expenses funded by State funds.

(4)        Be supplemental to and not supplant preexisting resources for related program activities.

(5)        Be incurred as a direct result of the Early Childhood Initiatives Program and be necessary and reasonable for the proper and efficient accomplishment of the Program's objectives.

(6)        Be otherwise allowable under federal or State law.

(7)        Be required and described in the contractual agreements approved by the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., or the local partnership.

(8)        Be reported to the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., or the local partnership by the contractor in the same manner as reimbursable expenses.

Failure to obtain a twenty percent (20%) match by June 30 of each fiscal year shall result in a dollar‑for‑dollar reduction in the appropriation for the Program for a subsequent fiscal year. The North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall be responsible for compiling information on the private cash and in‑kind contributions into a report that is submitted to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations in a format that allows verification by the Department of Revenue. The same match requirements shall apply to any expansion funds appropriated by the General Assembly.

SECTION 10.5.(d)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall continue to implement the performance‑based evaluation system.

SECTION 10.5.(e)  The Department of Health and Human Services and the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc., shall ensure that the allocation of funds for Early Childhood Education and Development Initiatives for State fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 shall be administered and distributed in the following manner:

(1)        Capital expenditures are prohibited for fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013. For the purposes of this section, "capital expenditures" means expenditures for capital improvements as defined in G.S. 143C‑1‑1(d)(5).

(2)        Expenditures of State funds for advertising and promotional activities are prohibited for fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013.

SECTION 10.5.(f)  A county may use the county's allocation of State and federal child care funds to subsidize child care according to the county's Early Childhood Education and Development Initiatives Plan as approved by the North Carolina Partnership for Children, Inc. The use of federal funds shall be consistent with the appropriate federal regulations. Child care providers shall, at a minimum, comply with the applicable requirements for State licensure pursuant to Article 7 of Chapter 110 of the General Statutes.

SECTION 10.5.(g)  For fiscal years 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013, the local partnerships shall spend an amount for child care subsidies that provides at least fifty‑two million dollars ($52,000,000) for the TANF maintenance of effort requirement and the Child Care Development Fund and Block Grant match requirement. The Department of Health and Human Services shall determine the level of funds that need to be expended in order to draw down all federal recovery funds and shall direct the local partnerships to spend at least at the determined level.  The local partnerships shall not spend at a level less than that directed by the Department.

 

ADMINISTRATIVE ALLOWANCE FOR COUNTY DEPARTMENTS OF SOCIAL SERVICES

SECTION 10.6.  Section 10.10 of S.L. 2009‑451 reads as rewritten:

"SECTION 10.10. The Division of Child Development of the Department of Health and Human Services shall increasefund the allowance that county departments of social services may use for administrative costs from four percent (4%) to five percent (5%)at three percent (3%) of the county's total child care subsidy funds allocated in the Child Care Development Fund Block Grant plan. The increase shall be effective for the 2009‑2010 fiscal year.The percentage of allowable use for administrative costs becomes effective July 1, 2011."

 

COST‑SHARING FOR SERVICES IN EARLY CHILDHOOD INTERVENTION PROGRAMS

SECTION 10.7.  The Department of Health and Human Services shall bill third‑party payers, including public and private insurers, for services provided by the First Family Infant and Preschool Program (FIPP).  In order to ensure maximum realization of receipts from third‑party payers for services provided, the Department shall take whatever administrative and billing actions are necessary to coordinate FIPP with the Children's Developmental Services Agency (CDSA), taking into account the age range of children served by CDSA and FIPP.  In addition, the Department shall pursue all available cost‑sharing for services, including grants, development of a sliding fee scale for individual payers, and accessing available child care subsidies for eligible families. Receipts from billings shall be used to offset State general funds.

 

CHANGES TO COMMUNITY‑FOCUSED ELIMINATING HEALTH DISPARITIES INITIATIVE

SECTION 10.8.(a)  Funds appropriated in this act from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services for the Community‑Focused Eliminating Health Disparities Initiative (CFEHDI) shall be used to provide grants‑in‑aid to local public health departments, American Indian tribes, and faith‑based and community‑based organizations to close the gap in the health status of African‑Americans, Hispanics/Latinos, and American Indians as compared to the health status of white persons. These grants shall focus on the use of preventive measures to support healthy lifestyles. The areas of focus on health status shall be infant mortality, HIV‑AIDS and sexually transmitted infections, cancer, diabetes, homicides, and motor vehicle deaths.

SECTION 10.8.(b)  Funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Public Health, for the CFEHDI shall be awarded as a grant‑in‑aid to honor the memory of the following recently deceased members of the General Assembly: Bernard Allen, John Hall, Robert Holloman, Howard Hunter, Jeanne Lucas, Vernon Malone, and William Martin. These funds shall be used for concerted efforts to address large gaps in health status among North Carolinians who are African‑American, as well as disparities among other minority populations in North Carolina.

SECTION 10.8.(c)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall report on the following with respect to funds appropriated to the CFEHDI for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year. The report shall address the following:

(1)        Which community programs and local health departments received CFEHDI grants.

(2)        The amount of funding each program or local health department received.

(3)        Which of the minority populations were served by the programs or local health departments.

(4)        Which counties were served by the programs or local health departments.

(5)        What activities were planned and implemented by the programs or local health departments to fulfill the community focus of the CFEHDI program.

(6)        How the activities implemented by the programs or local health departments fulfilled the goal of reducing health disparities among minority populations.

The report shall also include specific activities undertaken pursuant to subsection (a) of this section to address large gaps in health status among North Carolinians who are African‑American and other minority populations in this State. The Department shall submit the report not later than March 15, 2012, to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

 

FUNDS FOR SCHOOL NURSES

SECTION 10.9.(a)  All funds appropriated for the school nurse initiative shall be used to supplement and not supplant other State, local, or federal funds appropriated or allocated for this purpose. Communities shall maintain their current level of effort and funding for school nurses.  These funds shall not be used for funding nurses for State agencies.  All funds shall be used for direct services.

SECTION 10.9.(b)  All school nurses funded with State funds shall participate, as needed, in child and family teams.

 

ADAP

SECTION 10.10.  The Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS) shall work with the Department of Correction (DOC) to use DOC funds to purchase pharmaceuticals for the treatment of DOC inmates with HIV/AIDS in a manner that allows these funds to be accounted for as State matching funds in DHHS's drawdown of federal Ryan White funds.

 

MENTAL HEALTH CHANGES

SECTION 10.11.(a)  For the purpose of mitigating cash flow problems that many non‑single stream local management entities (LMEs) experience at the beginning of each fiscal year, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, shall adjust the timing and method by which allocations of service dollars are distributed to each non‑single stream LME.  To this end, the allocations shall be adjusted such that at the beginning of the fiscal year the Department shall distribute not less than one‑twelfth of the LME's continuation allocation and subtract the amount of the adjusted distribution from the LME's total reimbursements for the fiscal year.

SECTION 10.11.(b)  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, the sum of twenty‑nine million one hundred twenty‑one thousand six hundred forty‑four dollars ($29,121,644) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the sum of twenty‑nine million one hundred twenty‑one thousand six hundred forty‑four dollars ($29,121,644) for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year shall be allocated for the purchase of local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days. At the discretion of the Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services, existing mental health/developmental disabilities/substance abuse services funds allocated to the LMEs for these community services may be used to purchase additional local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days. These beds or bed days shall be distributed across the State in LME catchment areas and according to need as determined by the Department. The Department shall enter into contracts with the LMEs and community hospitals for the management of these beds or bed days.  Local inpatient psychiatric beds or bed days shall be managed and controlled by the LME, including the determination of which local or State hospital the individual should be admitted to pursuant to an involuntary commitment order. Funds shall not be allocated to LMEs but shall be held in a statewide reserve at the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services to pay for services authorized by the LMEs and billed by the hospitals through the LMEs. LMEs shall remit claims for payment to the Division within 15 working days of receipt of a clean claim from the hospital and shall pay the hospital within 30 working days of receipt of payment from the Division. If the Department determines (i) that an LME is not effectively managing the beds or bed days for which it has responsibility, as evidenced by beds or bed days in the local hospital not being utilized while demand for services at the State psychiatric hospitals has not reduced, or (ii) the LME has failed to comply with the prompt payment provisions of this subsection, the Department may contract with another LME to manage the beds or bed days, or, notwithstanding any other provision of law to the contrary, may pay the hospital directly.

SECTION 10.11.(c)  Section 10.12(f) of S.L. 2009‑451 reads as rewritten:

"SECTION 10.12.(f)

(1)        The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, shall continue implementation of the current Supports Intensity Scale (SIS) assessment tool pilot project if the pilot.tool. The project has demonstrated that the SIS tool:

a.         Is effective in identifying the appropriate array and intensity of services, including residential supports or placement, for individuals assessed.

b.         Is valid for determining intensity of support related to resource allocation for CAP‑MR/DD, public and private ICF‑MR facilities, developmental disability group homes, and other State‑ or federally funded services.

c.         Is used by an assessor that does not have a pecuniary interest in the determinations resulting from the assessment.

d.         Determines the level of intensity and type of services needed from developmental disability service providers.

(2)        The Department shall report on the progress of the pilot project by May 1, 2010. The Department shall submit the report to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall include the following:

a.         The infrastructure that will be needed to assure that the administration of the assessment tool is independent from service delivery, the qualifications of assessors, training and management of data, and test‑retest accountability.

b.         The cost to (i) purchase the tool, (ii) implement the tool, (iii) provide training, and (iv) provide for future expansion of the tool statewide.

(2)        The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, shall require a SIS assessment to be administered to all clients with developmental disabilities no later than June 30, 2012. DHHS shall use the results of the SIS assessment to determine the level of supports needed and allocation of resources within the CAP‑MR/DD Waiver and other needed services, according to their relative intensity of need."

 

CAP‑MR/DD SERVICE ELIGIBILITY

SECTION 10.12.  Except as otherwise provided in this section for former Thomas S. recipients, CAP‑MR/DD recipients are not eligible for any State‑funded services except for those services for which there is not a comparable service in the CAP‑MR/DD Waiver. The excepted services are limited to guardianship, room and board, and time‑limited supplemental staffing to stabilize residential placement. Former Thomas S. recipients currently living in community placements may continue to receive State‑funded services.

 

COLLABORATION AMONG DEPARTMENTS OF ADMINISTRATION, HEALTH AND HUMAN SERVICES, JUVENILE JUSTICE AND DELINQUENCY PREVENTION, AND PUBLIC INSTRUCTION ON SCHOOL‑BASED CHILD AND FAMILY TEAM INITIATIVE

SECTION 10.13.(a)  School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative Established. –

(1)        Purpose and duties. – There is established the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative. The purpose of the Initiative is to identify and coordinate appropriate community services and supports for children at risk of school failure or out‑of‑home placement in order to address the physical, social, legal, emotional, and developmental factors that affect academic performance. The Department of Health and Human Services, the Department of Public Instruction, the State Board of Education, the Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention, the Administrative Office of the Courts, and other State agencies that provide services for children shall share responsibility and accountability to improve outcomes for these children and their families. The Initiative shall be based on the following principles:

a.         The development of a strong infrastructure of interagency collaboration.

b.         One child, one team, one plan.

c.         Individualized, strengths‑based care.

d.         Accountability.

e.         Cultural competence.

f.          Children at risk of school failure or out‑of‑home placement may enter the system through any participating agency.

g.         Services shall be specified, delivered, and monitored through a unified Child and Family Plan that is outcome‑oriented and evaluation‑based.

h.         Services shall be the most efficient in terms of cost and effectiveness and shall be delivered in the most natural settings possible.

i.          Out‑of‑home placements for children shall be a last resort and shall include concrete plans to bring the children back to a stable, permanent home, their schools, and their community.

j.          Families and consumers shall be involved in decision making throughout service planning, delivery, and monitoring.

(2)        Program goals and services. – In order to ensure that children receiving services are appropriately served, the affected State and local agencies shall do the following:

a.         Increase capacity in the school setting to address the academic, health, mental health, social, and legal needs of children.

b.         Ensure that children receiving services are screened initially to identify needs and assessed periodically to determine progress and sustained improvement in educational, health, safety, behavioral, and social outcomes.

c.         Develop uniform screening mechanisms and a set of outcomes that are shared across affected agencies to measure children's progress in home, school, and community settings.

d.         Promote practices that are known to be effective based upon research or national best practice standards.

e.         Review services provided across affected State agencies to ensure that children's needs are met.

f.          Eliminate cost‑shifting and facilitate cost‑sharing among governmental agencies with respect to service development, service delivery, and monitoring for participating children and their families.

g.         Participate in a local memorandum of agreement signed annually by the participating superintendent of the local LEA, directors of the county departments of social services and health, director of the local management entity, the chief district court judge, and the chief district court counselor.

(3)        Local level responsibilities. – In coordination with the North Carolina Child and Family Leadership Council (Council), established in subsection (b) of this section, the local board of education shall establish the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative at designated schools and shall appoint the Child and Family Team Leaders, who shall be a school nurse and a school social worker. Each local management entity that has any selected schools in its catchment area shall appoint a Care Coordinator, and any department of social services that has a selected school in its catchment area shall appoint a Child and Family Teams Facilitator. The Care Coordinators and Child and Family Team Facilitators shall have as their sole responsibility working with the selected schools in their catchment areas and shall provide training to school‑based personnel, as required. The Child and Family Team Leaders shall identify and screen children who are potentially at risk of academic failure or out‑of‑home placement due to physical, social, legal, emotional, or developmental factors. Based on the screening results, responsibility for developing, convening, and implementing the Child and Family Team Initiative is as follows:

a.         School personnel shall take the lead role for those children and their families whose primary unmet needs are related to academic achievement.

b.         The local management entity shall take the lead role for those children and their families whose primary unmet needs are related to mental health, substance abuse, or developmental disabilities and who meet the criteria for the target population established by the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services.

c.         The local department of public health shall take the lead role for those children and their families whose primary unmet needs are health‑related.

d.         Local departments of social services shall take the lead for those children and their families whose primary unmet needs are related to child welfare, abuse, or neglect.

e.         The chief district court counselor shall take the lead for those children and their families whose primary unmet needs are related to juvenile justice issues. A representative from each named or otherwise identified publicly supported children's agency shall participate as a member of the Team as needed. Team members shall coordinate, monitor, and assure the successful implementation of a unified Child and Family Plan.

(4)        Reporting requirements. – School‑Based Child and Family Team Leaders shall provide data to the Council for inclusion in their report to the North Carolina General Assembly. The report shall include the following:

a.         The number of and other demographic information on children screened and assigned to a team and a description of the services needed by and provided to these children.

b.         The number of and information about children assigned to a team who are placed in programs or facilities outside the child's home or outside the child's county and the average length of stay in residential treatment.

c.         The amount and source of funds expended to implement the Initiative.

d.         Information on how families and consumers are involved in decision making throughout service planning, delivery, and monitoring.

e.         Other information as required by the Council to evaluate success in local programs and ensure appropriate outcomes.

f.          Recommendations on needed improvements.

(5)        Local advisory committee. – In each county with a participating school, the superintendent of the local LEA shall either identify an existing cross‑agency collaborative or council or shall form a new group to serve as a local advisory committee to work with the Initiative. Newly formed committees shall be chaired by the superintendent and one other member of the committee to be elected by the committee. The local advisory committee shall include the directors of the county departments of social services and health; the directors of the local management entity; the chief district court judge; the chief district court counselor; the director of a school‑based or school‑linked health center, if a center is located within the catchment area of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative; and representatives of other agencies providing services to children, as designated by the committee. The members of the committee shall meet as needed to monitor and support the successful implementation of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative. The Local Child and Family Team Advisory Committee may designate existing cross‑agency collaboratives or councils as working groups or to provide assistance in accomplishing established goals.

SECTION 10.13.(b)  North Carolina Child and Family Leadership Council. –

(1)        Leadership Council established; location. – There is established the North Carolina Child and Family Leadership Council (Council). The Council shall be located within the Department of Administration for organizational and budgetary purposes.

(2)        Purpose. – The purpose of the Council is to review and advise the Governor in the development of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative and to ensure the active participation and collaboration in the Initiative by all State agencies and their local counterparts providing services to children in participating counties in order to increase the academic success of and reduce out‑of‑home and out‑of‑county placements of children at risk of academic failure.

(3)        Membership. – The Superintendent of Public Instruction and the Secretary of Health and Human Services shall serve as cochairs of the Council. Council membership shall include the Secretary of the Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention, the Chairman of the State Board of Education, the Director of the Administrative Office of the Courts, and other members as appointed by the Governor.

(4)        The Council shall:

a.         Sign an annual memorandum of agreement (MOA) among the named State agencies to define the purposes of the program and to ensure that program goals are accomplished.

b.         Resolve State policy issues, as identified at the local level, which interfere with effective implementation of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative.

c.         Direct the integration of resources, as needed, to meet goals and ensure that the Initiative promotes the most effective and efficient use of resources and eliminates duplication of effort.

d.         Establish criteria for defining success in local programs and ensure appropriate outcomes.

e.         Develop an evaluation process, based on expected outcomes, to ensure the goals and objectives of this Initiative are achieved.

f.          Review progress made on integrating policies and resources across State agencies, reaching expected outcomes, and accomplishing other goals.

g.         Report semiannually, on January 1 and July 1, on progress made and goals achieved to the Office of the Governor, the Joint Appropriations Committees and Subcommittees on Education, Justice and Public Safety, and Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division of the Legislative Services Office. The Council may designate existing cross‑agency collaboratives or councils as working groups or to provide assistance in accomplishing established goals.

SECTION 10.13.(c)  Department of Health and Human Services. – The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services shall ensure that all agencies within the Department collaborate in the development and implementation of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative and provide all required support to ensure that the Initiative is successful.

SECTION 10.13.(d)  Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention. – The Secretary of the Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention shall ensure that all agencies within the Department collaborate in the development and implementation of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative and provide all required support to ensure that the Initiative is successful.

SECTION 10.13.(e)  Administrative Office of the Courts. – The Director of the Administrative Office of the Courts shall ensure that the Office collaborates in the development and implementation of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative and shall provide all required support to ensure that the Initiative is successful.

SECTION 10.13.(f)  Department of Public Instruction. – The Superintendent of Public Instruction shall ensure that the Department collaborates in the development and implementation of the School‑Based Child and Family Team Initiative and shall provide all required support to ensure that the Initiative is successful.

 

LME FUNDS FOR SUBSTANCE ABUSE SERVICES

SECTION 10.14.(a)  Consistent with G.S. 122C‑2, the General Assembly strongly encourages Local Management Entities (LMEs) to use a portion of the funds appropriated for substance abuse treatment services to support prevention and education activities.

SECTION 10.14.(b)  An LME may use up to one percent (1%) of funds allocated to it for substance abuse treatment services to provide nominal incentives for consumers who achieve specified treatment benchmarks, in accordance with the federal Substance Abuse and Mental Health Services Administration best practice model entitled Contingency Management.

SECTION 10.14.(c)  In providing treatment and services for adult offenders and increasing the number of Treatment Accountability for Safer Communities (TASC) case managers, local management entities shall consult with TASC to improve offender access to substance abuse treatment and match evidence‑based interventions to individual needs at each stage of substance abuse treatment. Special emphasis should be placed on intermediate punishment offenders, community punishment offenders at risk for revocation, and Department of Correction (DOC) releasees who have completed substance abuse treatment while in custody.

In addition to the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, to provide substance abuse services for adult offenders and to increase the number of TASC case managers, the Department shall allocate up to three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000) to TASC. These funds shall be allocated to TASC before funds are allocated to LMEs for mental health services, substance abuse services, and crisis services.

SECTION 10.14.(d)  In providing drug treatment court services, LMEs shall consult with the local drug treatment court team and shall select a treatment provider that meets all provider qualification requirements and the drug treatment court's needs. A single treatment provider may be chosen for non‑Medicaid‑eligible participants only. A single provider may be chosen who can work with all of the non‑Medicaid‑eligible drug treatment court participants in a single group. During the 52‑week drug treatment court program, participants shall receive an array of treatment and aftercare services that meet the participant's level of need, including step‑down services that support continued recovery.

 

TRANSITION OF UTILIZATION MANAGEMENT OF COMMUNITY‑BASED SERVICES TO LOCAL MANAGEMENT ENTITIES

SECTION 10.15.  The Department of Health and Human Services shall collaborate with LMEs to enhance their administrative capabilities to assume utilization management responsibilities for the provision of community‑based mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services.  The Department may, with approval of the Office of State Budget and Management, use funds available to implement this section.

 

DUTIES OF COUNTIES; APPROPRIATION AND ALLOCATION OF FUNDS BY COUNTIES AND CITIES

SECTION 10.16.  G.S. 122C‑115 reads as rewritten:

"§ 122C‑115.  Duties of counties; appropriation and allocation of funds by counties and cities.

(a)        A county shall provide mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services through an area authority or through a county program established pursuant to G.S. 122C‑115.1. The catchment area of an area authority or a county program shall contain either a minimum population of at least 200,000 or a minimum of six counties. Effective July 1, 2012, the catchment area of an area authority or a county program shall consist of a minimum population of 300,000. To the extent this section conflicts with G.S. 153A‑77(a), the provisions of G.S. 153A‑77(a) control.

(a1)      Effective July 1, 2007, through June 30, 2012, the Department of Health and Human Services shall reduce by ten percent (10%) annually the administrative funding for LMEs that do not comply with the catchment area requirements of subsection (a) of this section. However, an LME that does not comply with the catchment area requirements because of a change in county membership shall have 12 months from the effective date of the change to comply with subsection (a) of this section.Effective July 1, 2012, the management fee that each LME receives shall be based upon a minimum population of 300,000. Any savings resulting from the policy initiative shall be used to increase the availability of community‑based services. The amount of savings and the method of allocating savings shall be reported to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

(b)        Counties shall and cities may appropriate funds for the support of programs that serve the catchment area, whether the programs are physically located within a single county or whether any facility housing a program is owned and operated by the city or county. Counties and cities may make appropriations for the purposes of this Chapter and may allocate for these purposes other revenues not restricted by law, and counties may fund them by levy of property taxes pursuant to G.S. 153A‑149(c)(22).

(c)        Except as authorized in G.S. 122C‑115.1, within a catchment area designated in the business plan pursuant to G.S. 122C‑115.2, a board of county commissioners or two or more boards of county commissioners jointly shall establish an area authority with the approval of the Secretary.

(d)        Except as otherwise provided in this subsection, counties shall not reduce county appropriations and expenditures for current operations and ongoing programs and services of area authorities or county programs because of the availability of State‑allocated funds, fees, capitation amounts, or fund balance to the area authority or county program. Counties may reduce county appropriations by the amount previously appropriated by the county for one‑time, nonrecurring special needs of the area authority or county program."

 

Third‑Party Billing for State Facilities

SECTION 10.17.  G.S. 122C‑55 reads as rewritten:

"§ 122C‑55.  Exceptions; care and treatment.

(g)        Whenever there is reason to believe that the client is eligible for financial benefits through a governmental agency, a facility may disclose confidential information to State, local, or federal government agencies. Except as provided in G.S.122C‑55(a3), G.S. 122C‑55(a3) and G.S. 122C‑55(g1), disclosure is limited to that confidential information necessary to establish financial benefits for a client. After Except as provided in G.S. 122C‑55(g1), after establishment of these benefits, the consent of the client or his legally responsible person is required for further release of confidential information under this subsection.

(g1)      A facility may disclose confidential information for the purpose of collecting payment due the facility for the cost of care, treatment, or habilitation.

…."

 

MENTAL HEALTH TRUST FUND

SECTION 10.18.  G.S. 143C‑9‑2 reads as rewritten:

"§ 143C‑9‑2.  Trust Fund for Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services and Bridge Funding Needs.

(a)        The Trust Fund for Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services and Bridge Funding Needs is established as an interest‑bearing, nonreverting special trust fund in the Office of State Budget and Management. Moneys in the Trust Fund shall be held in trust and used solely to increase community‑based services that meet the mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services needs of the State. The Trust Fund shall be used to supplement and not to supplant or replace existing State and local funding available to meet the mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services needs of the State.

The State Treasurer shall hold the Trust Fund separate and apart from all other moneys, funds, and accounts. The State Treasurer shall be the custodian of the Trust Fund and shall invest its assets in accordance with G.S. 147‑69.2 and G.S. 147‑69.3. Investment earnings credited to the assets of the Trust Fund shall become part of the Trust Fund. Any balance remaining in the Trust Fund at the end of any fiscal year shall be carried forward in the Trust Fund for the next succeeding fiscal year.

Moneys in the Trust Fund shall be expended only in accordance with subsection (b) of this section and in accordance with limitations and directions enacted by the General Assembly.

(b)        The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services shall develop the criteria and process for the utilization of funds from the Trust Fund. Moneys in the Trust Fund for Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services and Bridge Funding Needs shall be allocated to area programs to be used only to:

(1)        Provide start‑up funds and operating support for programs and services that provide more appropriate and cost‑effective community treatment alternatives for individuals currently residing in the State's mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services institutions.

(2)        Repealed by Session Laws 2007‑323, s. 10.49(w1), effective July 1, 2007.

(3)        Facilitate reformEnhance operation of the mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services system and expand and enhance treatment and prevention services in these program areas to remove waiting lists and provide appropriate and safe services for clients.through the following:

a.         Start‑up costs and technical assistance associated with LME merger efforts and Medicaid waiver participation.

b.         Infrastructure development and training to ensure implementation of evidence‑based practices.

(4)        Provide bridge funding to maintain appropriate client services during transitional periods as a result of facility closings, including departmental restructuring of services.Enhance and expand appropriate treatment, support, and prevention services for consumers through the following:

a.         Primary care integration efforts, including, but not limited to, colocation of primary care and behavioral health systems.

b.         Increased community psychiatric inpatient capacity.

c.         Transition costs associated with the expansion of supported housing options.

d.         Increased coordination between local management entities (LMEs), State‑operated facilities, federal agencies, and community provider organizations through electronic health records.

(5)        Repealed by Session Laws 2007‑323, s. 10.49(w1), effective July 1, 2007.

(c)        Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑1‑2, any nonrecurring savings in State appropriations realized from the closure of any State psychiatric hospitals that are in excess of the cost of operating and maintaining a new State psychiatric hospital shall not revert to the General Fund but shall be placed in the Trust Fund and shall be used for the purposes authorized in this section. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑1‑2, recurring savings realized from the closure of any State psychiatric hospitals shall not revert to the General Fund but shall be credited to the Department of Health and Human Services to be used only for the purposes of subsections (b)(1) and (b)(3) of this section.

(d)        Beginning July 1, 2007, the Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services shall report annually to the Fiscal Research Division on the expenditures made during the preceding fiscal year from the Trust Fund. The report shall identify each expenditure by recipient and purpose and shall indicate the authority under subsection (b) of this section for the expenditure."

 

HEALTH INFORMATION TECHNOLOGY

SECTION 10.19.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services, in cooperation with the State Chief Information Officer and the North Carolina Office of Economic Recovery and Investment, shall coordinate health information technology (HIT) policies and programs within the State of North Carolina.  The Department's goal in coordinating State HIT policy and programs shall be to avoid duplication of efforts and to ensure that each State agency, public entity, and private entity that undertakes health information technology activities associated with the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (ARRA) does so within the area of its greatest expertise and technical capability and in a manner that supports coordinated State and national goals, which shall include at least all of the following:

(1)        Ensuring that patient health information is secure and protected, in accordance with applicable law.

(2)        Improving health care quality, reducing medical errors, reducing health disparities, and advancing the delivery of patient‑centered medical care.

(3)        Providing appropriate information to guide medical decisions at the time and place of care.

(4)        Ensuring meaningful public input into HIT infrastructure development.

(5)        Improving the coordination of information among hospitals, laboratories, physician offices, and other entities through an effective infrastructure for the secure and authorized exchange of health care information.

(6)        Improving public health services and facilitating early identification and rapid response to public health threats and emergencies, including bioterrorist events and infectious disease outbreaks.

(7)        Facilitating health and clinical research.

(8)        Promoting early detection, prevention, and management of chronic diseases.

SECTION 10.19.(b)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall establish and direct a HIT management structure that is efficient and transparent and that is compatible with the Office of the National Health Coordinator for Information Technology (National Coordinator) governance mechanism.  The HIT management structure shall be responsible for all of the following:

(1)        Developing a State plan for implementing and ensuring compliance with national HIT standards and for the most efficient, effective, and widespread adoption of HIT.

(2)        Ensuring that (i) specific populations are effectively integrated into the State plan, including aging populations, populations requiring mental health services, and populations utilizing the public health system and (ii) unserved and underserved populations receive priority consideration for HIT support.

(3)        Identifying all HIT stakeholders and soliciting feedback and participation from each stakeholder in the development of the State plan.

(4)        Ensuring that existing HIT capabilities are considered and incorporated into the State plan.

(5)        Identifying and eliminating conflicting HIT efforts where necessary.

(6)        Identifying available resources for the implementation, operation, and maintenance of health information technology, with emphasis on identifying resources and available opportunities for North Carolina institutions of higher education.

(7)        Ensuring that the appropriate State entities receive all the necessary information and support to successfully compete for federal funding.

(8)        Ensuring that potential State plan participants are aware of HIT policies and programs and the opportunity for improved health information technology.

(9)        Monitoring HIT efforts and initiatives in other states and replicating successful efforts and initiatives in North Carolina.

(10)      Monitoring the development of the National Coordinator's strategic plan and ensuring that all stakeholders are aware of and in compliance with its requirements.

(11)      Monitoring the progress and recommendations of the HIT Policy and Standards Committees and ensuring that all stakeholders remain informed of the Committee's recommendations.

(12)      Monitoring all studies and reports provided to the United States Congress and reporting to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology and the Fiscal Research Division on the impact of report recommendations on State efforts to implement coordinated HIT.

SECTION 10.19.(c)  Beginning July 1, 2011, the Department of Health and Human Services shall provide semiannual written reports on October 1 and April 1 of each year on the status of HIT efforts to the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall include the following:

(1)        Current status of federal HIT initiatives.

(2)        Current status of State HIT efforts and initiatives among both public and private entities.

(3)        A breakdown of current public and private funding sources and dollar amounts for State HIT initiatives.

(4)        Department efforts to coordinate HIT initiatives within the State and any obstacles or impediments to coordination.

(5)        HIT research efforts being conducted within the State and sources of funding for research efforts.

(6)        Opportunities for stakeholders to participate in HIT funding and other efforts and initiatives during the next quarter.

(7)        Issues associated with the implementation of HIT in North Carolina and recommended solutions to these issues.

 

TRANSFER TO OFFICE OF ADMINISTRATIVE HEARINGS

SECTION 10.20.  From funds available to the Department of Health and Human Services (Department) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, the sum of one million dollars ($1,000,000) and for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year, the sum of one million dollars ($1,000,000) shall be transferred by the Department of Health and Human Services to the Office of Administrative Hearings (OAH). These funds shall be allocated by the OAH for mediation services provided for Medicaid applicant and recipient appeals and to contract for other services necessary to conduct the appeals process. OAH shall continue the Memorandum of Agreement (MOA) with the Department for mediation services provided for Medicaid recipient appeals and contracted services necessary to conduct the appeals process. The MOA will facilitate the Department's ability to draw down federal Medicaid funds to support this administrative function. Upon receipt of invoices from OAH for covered services rendered in accordance with the MOA, the Department shall transfer the federal share of Medicaid funds drawn down for this purpose.

 

NC HEALTH CHOICE MEDICAL POLICY

SECTION 10.21.  Unless required for compliance with federal law, the Department shall not change medical policy affecting the amount, sufficiency, duration, and scope of NC Health Choice health care services and who may provide services until the Division of Medical Assistance has prepared a five‑year fiscal analysis documenting the increased cost of the proposed change in medical policy and submitted it for Departmental review. If the fiscal impact indicated by the fiscal analysis for any proposed medical policy change exceeds one million dollars ($1,000,000) in total requirements for a given fiscal year, then the Department shall submit the proposed medical policy change with the fiscal analysis to the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division. The Department shall not implement any proposed medical policy change exceeding one million dollars ($1,000,000) in total requirements for a given fiscal year unless the source of State funding is identified and approved by the Office of State Budget and Management. For medical policy changes exceeding one million dollars ($1,000,000) in total requirements for a given fiscal year that are required for compliance with federal law, the Department shall submit the proposed medical policy or policy interpretation change with a five‑year fiscal analysis to the Office of State Budget and Management prior to implementing the change. The Department shall provide the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division a quarterly report itemizing all medical policy changes with total requirements of less than one million dollars ($1,000,000).

 

NC HEALTH CHOICE

SECTION 10.22.(a)  Procedures for Changing Medical Policy. – Effective July 1, 2011, G.S. 108A‑54.3 reads as rewritten:

"§ 108A‑54.3.  Procedures for changing medical policy.

The Department shall develop, amend, and adopt medical coverage policy in accordance with the following:

(1)        During the development of new medical coverage policy or amendment to existing medical coverage policy applicable to the North Carolina Health Choice Program for Children, consult with and seek the advice of the Physician Advisory Group and other organizations the Secretary deems appropriate. The Secretary shall also consult with and seek the advice of officials of the professional societies or associations representing providers who are affected by the new medical coverage policy or amendments to existing medical coverage policy.

(2)        At least 45 days prior to the adoption of new or amended medical coverage policy, the Department shall:

a.         Publish the proposed new or amended medical coverage policy on the Department's Web site;

b.         Notify all North Carolina Health Choice Program for Children providers of the proposed, new, or amended policy; and

c.         Upon request, provide persons copies of the proposed medical coverage policy.

(3)        During the 45‑day period immediately following publication of the proposed new or amended medical coverage policy, accept oral and written comments on the proposed new or amended policy.

(4)        If, following the comment period, the proposed new or amended medical coverage policy is modified, then the Department shall do all of the following, at least 15 days prior to its adoption:

a.         Notify all North Carolina Health Choice Program for Children providers of the proposed policy.

b.         Upon request, provide persons notice of amendments to the proposed policy.

c.         Accept additional oral or written comments during this 15‑day period.

(5)        Any changes in medical policy that require an amendment to the Health Choice State Plan will be submitted by the Department upon approval of the proposed policy."

SECTION 10.22.(b)  Effective July 1, 2011, G.S. 108A‑70.21(b) reads as rewritten:

"(b)      Benefits. – Except as otherwise provided for eligibility, fees, deductibles, copayments, and other cost sharing charges, health benefits coverage provided to children eligible under the Program shall be equivalent to coverage provided for dependents under the Predecessor Plan.North Carolina Medicaid Program except for the following:

(1)        No services for long‑term care.

(2)        No nonemergency medical transportation.

(3)        No EPSDT.

(4)        Dental services shall be provided on a restricted basis in accordance with criteria adopted by the Department to implement this subsection.

In addition to the benefits provided under the Predecessor Plan,North Carolina Medicaid Program, the following services and supplies are covered under the Health Insurance Program for Children established under this Part:

(1)        Oral examinations, teeth cleaning, and topical fluoride treatments twice during a 12‑month period, full mouth X‑rays once every 60 months, supplemental bitewing X‑rays showing the back of the teeth once during a 12‑month period, sealants, extractions, other than impacted teeth or wisdom teeth, therapeutic pulpotomies, space maintainers, root canal therapy for permanent anterior teeth and permanent first molars, prefabricated stainless steel crowns, and routine fillings of amalgam or other tooth colored filling material to restore diseased teeth.

(1a)      Orthognathic surgery to correct functionally impairing malocclusions when orthodontics was approved and initiated while the child was covered by Medicaid and the need for orthognathic surgery was documented in the orthodontic treatment plan.

(2)        Vision: Scheduled routine eye examinations once every 12 months, eyeglass lenses or contact lenses once every 12 months, routine replacement of eyeglass frames once every 24 months, and optical supplies and solutions when needed. OpticalNCHC recipients must obtain optical services, supplies, and solutions must be obtainedfrom NCHC enrolled, licensed or certified ophthalmologists, optometrists, or optical dispensing laboratories.opticians. In accordance with G.S. 148‑134, NCHC providers must order complete eyeglasses, eyeglass lenses, and ophthalmic frames through Nash Optical Plant. Eyeglass lenses are limited to NCHC‑approved single vision, bifocal, trifocal, or other complex lenses necessary for a Plan enrollee's visual welfare. Coverage for oversized lenses and frames, designer frames, photosensitive lenses, tinted contact lenses, blended lenses, progressive multifocal lenses, coated lenses, and laminated lenses is limited to the coverage for single vision, bifocal, trifocal, or other complex lenses provided by this subsection. Eyeglass frames are limited to thoseNCHC‑approved frames made of zylonite, metal, or a combination of zylonite and metal. All visual aids covered by this subsection require prior approval. Requests for medically necessary complete eyeglasses, eyeglass lenses, and ophthalmic frames outside of the NCHC‑approved selection require prior approval. Requests for medically necessary fabrication of complete eyeglasses or eyeglass lenses outside of Nash Optical Plan require prior approval. Upon prior approval refractions may be covered more often than once every 12 months.

(3)        Hearing: Auditory diagnostic testing services and hearing aids and accessories when provided by a licensed or certified audiologist, otolaryngologist, or other approved hearing aid specialist. Prior approval is required for hearing aids, accessories, earmolds, repairs, loaners, and rental aids.

(4)        Over the counter medications: Selected over the counter medications provided the medication is covered under the State Medical Assistance Plan. Coverage shall be subject to the same policies and approvals as required under the Medicaid program.

(5)        Routine diagnostic examinations and tests: annual routine diagnostic examinations and tests, including x‑rays, blood and blood pressure checks, urine tests, tuberculosis tests, and general health check‑ups that are medically necessary for the maintenance and improvement of individual health are covered.

(3)        Under the North Carolina Health Choice Program for Children, the co‑payment for nonemergency visits to the emergency room for children whose family income is at or below one hundred fifty percent (150%) of the federal poverty level is ten dollars ($10.00). The co‑payment for children whose family income is between one hundred fifty‑one percent (151%) and two hundred percent (200%) of the federal poverty level is twenty‑five dollars ($25.00).

(4)        Over‑the‑counter medications: Selected over‑the‑counter medications provided the medication is covered under the State Medical Assistance Plan. Coverage shall be subject to the same policies and approvals as required under the Medicaid program.

(5)        Routine diagnostic examinations and tests: Annual routine diagnostic examinations and tests, including x‑rays, blood and blood pressure checks, urine tests, tuberculosis tests, and general health checkups that are medically necessary for the maintenance and improvement of individual health are covered.

No benefits are to be provided for services and materials under this subsection that do not meet the standards accepted by the American Dental Association.

The Department shall provide services to children enrolled in the NC Health Choice Program through Community Care of North Carolina (CCNC) and shall pay Community Care of North Carolina providers for these servicesthe per member, per month fees as allowed under Medicaid. The Department shall pay for these services only if sufficient information is available to the Department for utilization management of the services provided through CCNC."

SECTION 10.22.(c)  Effective July 1, 2011, G.S. 108A‑70.23 is repealed.

SECTION 10.22.(d)  Effective July 1, 2011, G.S. 108A‑70.27(c) reads as rewritten:

"(c)       The Executive Administrator and Board of Trustees of the North Carolina Teachers' and State Employees' Major Medical Plan ("Plan")DMA shall provide to the Department data required under this section that are collected by the Plan. Data shall be reported by the Plan in sufficient detail to meet federal reporting requirements under Title XXI. The Plan shall report periodically to the Joint Legislative Health Care Oversight Committee claims processing data for the Program and any other information the Plan or the Committee deems appropriate and relevant to assist the Committee in its review of the Program."

SECTION 10.22.(e)  Effective July 1, 2011, G.S. 108A‑70.29 reads as rewritten:

"§ 108A‑70.29.  Program review process.

(e)        Rule‑Making authority. – The Department shall have the authority to adopt rules for the implementation and operation of the NC Health Choice Program provider review process.

(f)         Rule‑Making authority. – The Department of Health and Human Services shall have the authority to adopt rules for the transition and operation of the North Carolina Health Choice Program. Notwithstanding G.S. 150B‑21.1(a), the Department of Health and Human Services may adopt temporary rules in accordance with Chapter 150B of the General Statutes for enrolling providers to participate in the NC Health Choice Program, for regulating provider participation in the NC Health Choice Program, and for other operational issues regarding the NC Health Choice Program."

 

COMMUNITY CARE OF NORTH CAROLINA

SECTION 10.24.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services (Department)  shall submit a report annually from a qualified entity with proven experience in conducting actuarial and health care studies on the Medicaid cost‑savings achieved by the CCNC networks, which shall include children, adults, and the aged, blind, and disabled, to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

SECTION 10.24.(b)  The Department and the Division of Medical Assistance (DMA) shall enter into a three‑party contract between North Carolina Community Care Networks, Inc., (NCCCN, Inc.) and each of the 14 participating local CCNC networks and shall require NCCCN, Inc., to provide standardized clinical and budgetary coordination, oversight, and reporting for a statewide Enhanced Primary Care Case Management System for Medicaid enrollees. The contracts shall require NCCCN, Inc., to build upon and expand the existing successful CCNC primary care case management model to include comprehensive statewide quantitative performance goals and deliverables which shall include all of the following areas: (i) service utilization management, (ii) budget analytics, (iii) budget forecasting methodologies, (iv) quality of care analytics, (v) participant access measures, and (vi) predictable cost containment methodologies.

SECTION 10.24.(c)  NCCCN, Inc., shall report quarterly to the Department and to the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM) on the development of the statewide Enhanced Primary Care Case Management System and its defined goals and deliverables as agreed upon in the contract. NCCCN, Inc., shall submit biannual reports to the Secretary of Health and Human Services, OSBM, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division on the progress and results of implementing the quantitative, analytical, utilization, quality, cost‑containment, and access goals and deliverables set out in the contract. NCCCN, Inc., shall conduct its own analysis of the CCNC system to identify any variations from the development plan for the Enhanced Primary Care Case Management System and its defined goals and deliverables set out in the contract between DMA and NCCCN, Inc. Upon identifying any variations, NCCCN, Inc., shall develop and implement a plan to address the variations. NCCCN, Inc., shall report the plan to DMA within 30 days after taking any action to implement the plan.

SECTION 10.24.(d)  By January 1, 2012, the Department and OSBM shall assess the performance of NCCCN, Inc., and CCNC regarding the goals and deliverables established in the contract. Based on this assessment, the Department and DMA shall expand, cancel, or alter the contract with NCCCN, Inc., and CCNC effective April 1, 2012. Expansion or alteration of the contract may reflect refinements based on clearly identified goals and deliverables in the areas of quality of care, participant access, cost containment, and service delivery.

SECTION 10.24.(e)  By July 1, 2012, the Department, DMA, and NCCCN, Inc., shall finalize a comprehensive plan that establishes management methodologies which include all of the following:  (i) quality of care measures, (ii) utilization measures, (iii) recipient access measures, (iv) performance incentive models in which past experience indicates a benefit from financial incentives, (v) accountable budget models, (vi) shared savings budget models, and (vii) budget forecasting analytics as agreed upon by the Department, DMA, and NCCCN, Inc. In the development of these methodologies, the Department, DMA, and NCCCN, Inc., shall consider options for shared risk. The Department and DMA shall provide assistance to NCCCN, Inc., in meeting the objectives of this section.

 

LIABILITY INSURANCE

SECTION 10.25.(a)  The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services, the Secretary of the Department of Environment and Natural Resources, and the Secretary of the Department of Correction may provide medical liability coverage not to exceed one million dollars ($1,000,000) per incident on behalf of employees of the Departments licensed to practice medicine or dentistry, on behalf of all licensed physicians who are faculty members of The University of North Carolina who work on contract for the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services for incidents that occur in Division programs, and on behalf of physicians in all residency training programs from The University of North Carolina who are in training at institutions operated by the Department of Health and Human Services.  This coverage may include commercial insurance or self‑insurance and shall cover these individuals for their acts or omissions only while they are engaged in providing medical and dental services pursuant to their State employment or training.

SECTION 10.25.(b)  The coverage provided under this section shall not cover any individual for any act or omission that the individual knows or reasonably should know constitutes a violation of the applicable criminal laws of any state or the United States or that arises out of any sexual, fraudulent, criminal, or malicious act or out of any act amounting to willful or wanton negligence.

SECTION 10.25.(c)  The coverage provided pursuant to this section shall not require any additional appropriations and shall not apply to any individual providing contractual service to the Department of Health and Human Services, the Department of Environment and Natural Resources, or the Department of Correction, with the exception that coverage may include physicians in all residency training programs from The University of North Carolina who are in training at institutions operated by the Department of Health and  Human  Services  and  licensed physicians who are faculty members of The University of North Carolina who work for the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services.

 

MEDICAID MANAGEMENT INFORMATION SYSTEM (MMIS) FUNDS/IMPLEMENTATION OF MMIS

SECTION 10.26.(a)  The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services may utilize prior year earned revenue received for the new Medicaid Management Information System (MMIS) in the amount of three million two hundred thirty‑two thousand three hundred four dollars ($3,232,304) in fiscal year 2011‑2012 and twelve million dollars ($12,000,000) in fiscal year 2012‑2013. The Department shall utilize prior year earned revenues received for the procurement, design, development, and implementation of the new MMIS. In the event that the Department does not receive prior year earned revenues in the amounts authorized by this section, the Department is authorized, with approval of the Office of State Budget and Management, to utilize other overrealized receipts and funds appropriated to the Department to achieve the level of funding specified in this section for the MMIS.

SECTION 10.26.(b)  The Department shall make full development of the replacement MMIS a top priority. During the development and implementation of MMIS, the Department shall develop plans to ensure the timely and effective implementation of enhancements to the system to provide the following capabilities:

(1)        Receiving and tracking premiums or other payments required by law.

(2)        Compatibility with the administration of the Health Information System.

The Department shall make every effort to expedite the implementation of the enhancements. The Office of Information Technology Services shall work in cooperation with the Department to ensure the timely and effective implementation of the MMIS and enhancements. The contract between the Department and the contract vendor shall contain an explicit provision requiring that the MMIS have the capability to fully implement the administration of NC Health Choice, NC Kids' Care, Ticket to Work, Families Pay Part of the Cost of Services under the CAP‑MR/DD, CAP Children's Program, and all relevant Medicaid waivers and the Medicare 646 waiver as it applies to Medicaid eligibles. The Department must have detailed cost information for each requirement before signing the contract. Any contract between the Department and a vendor for the MMIS that does not contain the explicit provision required under this subsection is void on its face. Notwithstanding any other provision of law to the contrary, the Secretary of the Department does not have the authority to sign a contract for the MMIS if the contract does not contain the explicit provision required under this section.

SECTION 10.26.(c)  Notwithstanding G.S. 114‑2.3, the Department shall engage the services of private counsel with the pertinent information technology and computer law expertise to review requests for proposals and to negotiate and review contracts associated with MMIS. The counsel engaged by the Department shall review the MMIS contract between the Department and the vendor to ensure that the requirements of subsection (b) of this section are met in their entirety.

SECTION 10.26.(d)  The Department shall develop a comprehensive schedule for the development and implementation of the MMIS that fully incorporates federal and State project management and review requirements.  The Department shall ensure that the schedule is as accurate as possible. Any changes to the design, development, and implementation schedule shall be reported as part of the Department's quarterly MMIS reporting requirements.  The Department shall submit the schedule to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Committee on Appropriations and the House of Representatives Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Chairs of the Senate Committee on Appropriations and the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.  Any change to key milestones in either schedule shall be immediately reported to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Committee on Appropriations and the House of Representatives Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Chairs of the Senate Committee on Appropriations and the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division with a full explanation of the reason for the change.

SECTION 10.26.(e)  Beginning July 1, 2011, the Department shall make quarterly reports on changes in the functionality and projected costs of the MMIS.  Each report shall be made to the Chairs of the House of Representatives Committee on Appropriations and the House of Representatives Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Chairs of the Senate Committee on Appropriations and the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.  A copy of the final report on the contract award also shall be submitted to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations.

SECTION 10.26.(f)  Upon initiation of the NC MMIS Program Reporting and Analytics Project and the Division of Health Services Regulation Project, the Department shall submit all reports regarding functionality, schedule, and cost in the next regular cycle of reporting identified in subsections (d) and (e) of this section.  The Department shall ensure that the solution developed in the Reporting and Analytics Project supports the capability, in its initial implementation, to interface with the North Carolina Teachers' and State Employees' Health Plan.  The costs for this capability shall be negotiated prior to the award of the Reporting and Analytics Project contract. The Reporting and Analytics Project solution must be completed simultaneously with the replacement MMIS.

 

North Carolina Families Accessing Services Through Technology (NC Fast) Funds

SECTION 10.27.  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Health and Human Services (Department), the nonrecurring sum of nine million five hundred ninety‑two thousand three hundred thirty‑two dollars ($9,592,332) for fiscal year 2011‑2012 and the nonrecurring sum of nine million five hundred ninety‑two thousand three hundred thirty‑two dollars ($9,592,332) for fiscal year 2012‑2013 shall be used to support the NC FAST project. These funds shall be (i) deposited to the Department's information technology budget code and (ii) used to match federal funds for the project. In addition, the Department shall utilize prior year earned revenues received in the amount of eight million seven hundred sixty‑seven thousand six hundred ninety‑six dollars ($8,767,696) in fiscal year 2011‑2012 for the NC FAST project.  Funds appropriated to the Department by this act shall be used to expedite the development and implementation of the Global Case Management and Food and Nutrition Services and the Eligibility Information System (EIS) components of the North Carolina Families Accessing Services through Technology (NC FAST) project. In the event that the Department does not receive prior year earned revenues in the amount authorized by this section, the Department is authorized, with approval of the Office of State Budget and Management, to utilize other overrealized receipts and funds appropriated to the Department to achieve the level of funding specified in this section for the NC FAST project. The Department shall not obligate any of its overrealized receipts or funds for this purpose without (i) prior written approval from the United States Department of Agriculture Food and Nutrition Service, the United States Department of Health and Human Services Administration for Children and Families, the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services, and any other federal partner responsible for approving changes to the annual Advance Planning Document update (APDu) for the NC FAST Program and (ii) prior review and approval from the Office of Information Technology Services (ITS) and the Office of State Budget and Management (OSBM). The Department shall report any changes to the NC FAST Program to the Joint Legislative Oversight Committee on Information Technology, the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, the House Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division not later than 30 days after receiving all the approvals required by this section.

 

NC NOVA

SECTION 10.28.  The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Health Service Regulation, may use up to thirty‑eight thousand dollars ($38,000) for fiscal year 2011‑2012 and thirty‑eight thousand dollars ($38,000) for fiscal year 2012‑2013 of existing resources to continue the NC New Organizational Vision Award certification program. The Division shall use federal civil monetary penalty receipts as a source of support for this initiative, when appropriate.

 

CHANGE EFFECTIVE DATE FOR WELL TESTING

SECTION 10.29.  Section 4 of S.L. 2009‑124 reads as rewritten:

"SECTION 4. Section 1 of this act becomes effective October 1, 2010.2012.The remainder of the act is effective when it becomes law."

 

SENIOR SERVICES:  PROJECT C.A.R.E. (CAREGIVER ALTERNATIVES TO RUNNING ON EMPTY)

SECTION 10.30.  Of the funds appropriated to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Aging and Adult Services, for the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years, the sum of two hundred thousand dollars ($200,000) in recurring funds shall be used to support Alzheimer's‑related activities consistent with the goals of Project Caregiver Alternatives To Running On Empty (Project C.A.R.E.).  The Division of Aging and Adult Services shall annually develop and implement a plan for use of these funds and beginning October 1, 2010, and annually thereafter, report the plan to the Governor's Advisory Council on Aging, the North Carolina Study Commission on Aging, and the Fiscal Research Division.

 

INTENSIVE FAMILY PRESERVATION SERVICES FUNDING AND PERFORMANCE ENHANCEMENTS

SECTION 10.31.(a)  Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 143B‑150.6, the Intensive Family Preservation Services (IFPS) Program shall provide intensive services to children and families in cases of abuse, neglect, and dependency where a child is at imminent risk of removal from the home and to children and families in cases of abuse where a child is not at imminent risk of removal. The Program shall be developed and implemented statewide on a regional basis. The IFPS shall ensure the application of standardized assessment criteria for determining imminent risk and clear criteria for determining out‑of‑home placement.

SECTION 10.31.(b)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall require that any program or entity that receives State, federal, or other funding for the purpose of Intensive Family Preservation Services shall provide information and data that allows for the following:

(1)        An established follow‑up system with a minimum of six months of follow‑up services.

(2)        Detailed information on the specific interventions applied, including utilization indicators and performance measurement.

(3)        Cost‑benefit data.

(4)        Data on long‑term benefits associated with Intensive Family Preservation Services. This data shall be obtained by tracking families through the intervention process.

(5)        The number of families remaining intact and the associated interventions while in IFPS and 12 months thereafter.

(6)        The number and percentage, by race, of children who received Intensive Family Preservation Services compared to the ratio of their distribution in the general population involved with Child Protective Services.

SECTION 10.31.(c)  The Department shall establish performance‑based funding protocol and shall provide funding only to those programs and entities providing the required information specified in subsection (b) of this section. The amount of funding shall be based on the individual performance of each program.

 

FOSTER CARE AND ADOPTION ASSISTANCE PAYMENTS

SECTION 10.32.(a)  The maximum rates for State participation in the foster care assistance program are established on a graduated scale as follows:

(1)        $475.00 per child per month for children aged birth through 5.

(2)        $581.00 per child per month for children aged 6 through 12.

(3)        $634.00 per child per month for children aged 13 through 18.

SECTION 10.32.(b)  The maximum rates for the State adoption assistance program are established consistent with the foster care rates as follows:

(1)        $475.00 per child per month for children aged birth through 5.

(2)        $581.00 per child per month for children aged 6 through 12.

(3)        $634.00 per child per month for children aged 13 through 18.

SECTION 10.32.(c)  In addition to providing board payments to foster and adoptive families of HIV‑infected children, as prescribed in Section 23.28 of Chapter 324 of the 1995 Session Laws, any additional funds remaining that were appropriated for this purpose shall be used to provide medical training in avoiding HIV transmission in the home.

SECTION 10.32.(d)  The maximum rates for the State participation in HIV foster care and adoption assistance are established on a graduated scale as follows:

(1)        $800.00 per child per month with indeterminate HIV status.

(2)        $1,000 per child per month confirmed HIV‑infected, asymptomatic.

(3)        $1,200 per child per month confirmed HIV‑infected, symptomatic.

(4)        $1,600 per child per month terminally ill with complex care needs.

SECTION 10.32.(e)  The State and a county participating in foster care and adoption assistance shall each contribute fifty percent (50%) of the nonfederal share of the cost of care for a child placed by a county department of social services or child placing agency in a family foster home or residential child care facility. A county shall be held harmless from contributing fifty percent (50%) of the nonfederal share of the cost for a child placed in a family foster home or residential child care facility under an agreement with that provider as of October 31, 2008, until the child leaves foster care or experiences a placement change.

SECTION 10.32.(f)  The Department of Health and Human Services may establish foster care and adoption assistance rates based on the United States Department of Agriculture (USDA) "Expenditures on Children by Families" index subject to State appropriations for each fiscal year.

 

CHILD CARING INSTITUTIONS

SECTION 10.33.  Until the Social Services Commission adopts rules setting standardized rates for child caring institutions as authorized under G.S. 143B‑153(8), the maximum reimbursement for child caring institutions shall not exceed the rate established for the specific child caring institution by the Department of Health and Human Services, Office of the Controller. In determining the maximum reimbursement, the State shall include county and IV‑E reimbursements.

 

MEDICAID RECIPIENT APPEALS

SECTION 10.34.(a)  G.S. 108A‑70.9A reads as rewritten:

"§ 108A‑70.9A.  Appeals commenced by Medicaid applicants or recipients.

(a)        Definitions. – The following definitions apply in this section, G.S. 108A‑70.9B and G.S. 108A‑70.9C, unless the context clearly requires otherwise:

(1)        Adverse determination. – A determination by the Department to deny, terminate, suspend, or reduce a Medicaid covered services service or an authorization for a Medicaid service.

(2)        Applicant or recipient. – This term includes an applicant's or recipient's parent, guardian, or legal representative.

(3)        Department. – This term includes the Department, its agents, contractors, or vendors who authorize, manage, or provide Medicaid services pursuant to the federal Medicaid Act, North Carolina Medicaid State Plan, or any waivers of the federal Medicaid Act granted by the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services.

(b)        General Rule. – Notwithstanding any provision of State law or rules to the contrary, this section shall govern the process used by a Medicaid applicant or recipient to appeal a determination made by the Department to deny, terminate, suspend, or reduce Medicaid covered services.

(c)        Notice. – Except as otherwise provided by federal law or regulation, at least 10 days before the effective date of an adverse determination, the Department shall notify the applicant or recipient, and the provider if applicable, in writing of the adverse determination and of the applicant's or recipient's right to appeal the adverse determination. The Department shall not be required to notify an applicant's or recipient's parent, guardian, or legal representative unless the parent, guardian, or legal representative has requested in writing to receive the notice. The notice shall be mailed on the date indicated on the notice as the date of the determination. The notice shall include:

(1)        An identification of the applicant or recipient whose services are being affected by the adverse determination, including full name and Medicaid identification number.

(2)        An explanation of what service is being denied, terminated, suspended, or reduced and the reason for the determination.

(3)        The specific regulation, statute, or medical coverage policy that supports or requires the adverse determination.

(4)        The effective date of the adverse determination.

(5)        An explanation of the applicant's or recipient's right to appeal the Department's adverse determination in an evidentiary hearing before an administrative law judge.

(6)        An explanation of the applicant's or recipient's right to examine at a reasonable time before the hearing and during the hearing the contents of the applicant's or recipient's case file and documents to be used by the Department in the hearing before the administrative law judge.

(7)        An explanation of the applicant's or recipient's right to an interpreter.

(8)        In instances in which the hearing involves medical issues, an explanation of the applicant's or recipient's right to request a medical assessment at the expense of the Department, if the administrative law judge determines that the medical assessment is necessary.

(9)        An explanation of how the applicant or recipient can request a hearing and a statement that the applicant or recipient may represent himself or herself or use legal counsel, a relative, or other spokesperson.

(10)      A statement that the applicant or recipient will continue to receive Medicaid services at the level provided on the day immediately preceding the Department's adverse determination or the amount requested by the applicant or recipient, whichever is less, if the applicant or recipient requests a hearing before the effective date of the adverse determination and if the request was received by Medicaid at least 10 days prior to the expiration of the current authorization. The services shall continue until the hearing is completed and a final decision is rendered.

(11)      The name and telephone numbers of a contact person at the Department's Medicaid Appeal Section and the CARE‑LINE to respond in a timely fashion to the applicant's or recipient's questions.

(12)      The telephone number by which the applicant or recipient may contact a Legal Aid/Legal Services office.

(13)      The appeal request form described in subsection (e) of this section that the applicant or recipient may use to request a hearing.

(d)        Appeals. – Except as provided by this section and G.S. 108A‑70.9B, a request for a hearing to appeal an adverse determination of the Department under this section is a contested case subject to the provisions of Article 3 of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes. The applicant or recipient must request a hearing within 30 days of the mailing of the notice (date on notice) and as required by subsection (c) of this section by sending the completed appeal request form provided by the department to the Office of Administrative Hearings and the Department. Where a request for hearing concerns the reduction, modification, or termination of Medicaid services, including the failure to approve a timely request for reauthorization, upon the receipt of a timely appeal, the Department shall reinstate the services to the level or manner prior to action by the Department as permitted by federal law or regulation and as required by subsection (c)(10) of this section. If the hearing request is submitted more than 30 days from the date the notice is mailed (date on notice), and regardless of whether the service request was submitted timely, the recipient shall not receive Medicaid services during the pendency of the appeal. The Department shall immediately forward a copy of the notice to the Office of Administrative Hearings electronically. The information contained in the notice is confidential unless the recipient appeals. The Office of Administrative Hearings may dispose of the records after one year. The Department may not influence, limit, or interfere with the applicant's or recipient's decision to request a hearing.

(e)        Appeal Request Form. – Along with the notice required by subsection (c) of this section, the Department shall also provide the applicant or recipient with an appeal request form which shall be no more than one side of one page. The form shall include the following:

(1)        A statement that in order to request an appeal, the applicant or recipient must send the completed departmental appeal request form by mail or fax to the address or fax number listed on the form within 30 days of mailing of the notice.

(2)        The applicant's or recipient's name, address, telephone number, and Medicaid identification number.

(3)        A preprinted statement that indicates that the applicant or recipient would like to appeal the specific adverse determination of which the applicant or recipient was notified in the notice.

(4)        A statement informing the applicant or recipient that he or she may choose to be represented by a lawyer, a relative, a friend, or other spokesperson.

(5)        A space for the recipient's signature and date.A space for the applicant's or recipient's signature, date, telephone number, and current address.

Only a completed hearing request form provided by the Department shall be accepted and processed by OAH. Appeal request forms filed untimely (that is more than 30 days from the date the notice was mailed and date on appeal request form) shall not be accepted/processed by OAH unless a statement of good cause is filed with the request initially.

(f)         Final Decision. – After a hearing before an administrative law judge, the judge shall return the decision and record to the Department in accordance with G.S. 108A‑70.9B. The Department shall make a final decision in the case within 20 days of receipt of the decision and record from the administrative law judge and promptly notify the applicant or recipient of the final decision and of the right to judicial review of the decision pursuant to Article 4 of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes."

SECTION 10.34.(b)  G.S. 108A‑70.9B(b)(1) reads as rewritten:

"(1)      To the extent possible, OAH shall schedule and hear contested Medicaid cases within 55 days of submission of a completed Department of Health and Human Services request for appeal. Appeal request forms filed untimely (that is more than 30 days from the date the notice was mailed and date on appeal request form) shall not be accepted/processed by OAH unless a statement of good cause is filed with the initial request for appeal."

 

CHILD WELFARE POSTSECONDARY SUPPORT PROGRAM

SECTION 10.35.  Section 10.50 of S.L. 2009‑451 reads as rewritten:

"SECTION 10.50.(a)  There is appropriated from the Escheat Fund income to the Department of Health and Human Services the sum of three million one hundred sixty‑eight thousand two hundred fifty dollars ($3,168,250) for the 2009‑2010 fiscal year. These funds shall be used to support the child welfare postsecondary support program for the educational needs of foster youth aging out of the foster care system and special needs children adopted from foster care after age 12 by providing assistance with the "cost of attendance" as that term is defined in 20 U.S.C. § 1087ll. The Department shall collaborate with the State Education Assistance Authority to develop policies and procedures for the distribution of these funds.

If the interest income generated from the Escheat Fund is less than the amounts referenced in this section, the difference may be taken from the Escheat Fund principal to reach the appropriations referenced in this section; however, under no circumstances shall the Escheat Fund principal be reduced below the sum required in G.S. 116B‑6(f).

Funds appropriated by this subsection shall be allocated by the State Education Assistance Authority.

The purpose for which funds are appropriated under this section is in addition to other purposes for which Escheat Fund income is distributed under G.S. 116B‑7 and shall not be construed to otherwise affect the distribution of funds under G.S. 116B‑7.

"SECTION 10.50.(a1)  Of the funds appropriated from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services, the sum of three million one hundred sixty‑eight thousand two hundred fifty dollars ($3,168,250)one million five hundred eighty‑four thousand one hundred twenty‑five dollars ($1,584,125) for the 2010‑2011 fiscal year 2011‑2012 fiscal year and one million five hundred eighty‑four thousand one hundred twenty‑five dollars ($1,584,125) for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year shall be used to support the child welfare postsecondary support program for the educational needs of foster youth aging out of the foster care system and special needs children adopted from foster care after age 12 by providing assistance with the "cost of attendance" as that term is defined in 20 U.S.C. § 1087ll.

Funds appropriated by this subsection shall be allocated by the State Education Assistance Authority.

"SECTION 10.50.(b)  Of the funds appropriated from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services the sum of fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) for the 2009‑20102011‑2012 fiscal year and the sum of fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) for the 2010‑20112012‑2013 fiscal year shall be allocated to the North Carolina State Education Assistance Authority (SEAA). The SEAA shall use these funds only to perform administrative functions necessary to manage and distribute scholarship funds under the child welfare postsecondary support program.

"SECTION 10.50.(c)  Of the funds appropriated from the General Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services the sum of five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000)three hundred thirty‑nine thousand four hundred ninety‑three dollars ($339,493) for the 2009‑20102011‑2012 fiscal year and the sum of five hundred thousand dollars ($500,000)three hundred thirty‑nine thousand four hundred ninety‑three dollars ($339,493) for the 2010‑20112012‑2013 fiscal year shall be used to contract with an entity to develop and administer the child welfare postsecondary support program described under subsection (a) of this section, which development and administration shall include the performance of case management services.

"SECTION 10.50.(d)  Funds appropriated to the Department of Health and Human Services for the child welfare postsecondary support program shall be used only for students attending public institutions of higher education in this State."

 

TANF BENEFIT IMPLEMENTATION

SECTION 10.36.(a)  The General Assembly approves the plan titled "North Carolina Temporary Assistance for Needy Families State Plan FY 2010‑2012," prepared by the Department of Health and Human Services and presented to the General Assembly. The North Carolina Temporary Assistance for Needy Families State Plan covers the period October 1, 2010, through September 30, 2012. The Department shall submit the State Plan, as revised in accordance with subsection (b) of this section, to the United States Department of Health and Human Services, as amended by this act or any other act of the 2009 General Assembly.

SECTION 10.36.(b)  The counties approved as Electing Counties in the North Carolina Temporary Assistance for Needy Families State Plan FY 2010‑2012, as approved by this section are:  Beaufort, Caldwell, Catawba, Lenoir, Lincoln, Macon, and Wilson.

SECTION 10.36.(c)  Counties that submitted the letter of intent to remain as an Electing County or to be redesignated as an Electing County and the accompanying county plan for fiscal years 2009 through 2011, pursuant to G.S. 108A‑27(e), shall operate under the Electing County budget requirements effective July 1, 2009. For programmatic purposes, all counties referred to in this subsection shall remain under their current county designation through September 30, 2012.

SECTION 10.36.(d)  For the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, Electing Counties shall be held harmless to their Work First Family Assistance allocations for the 2008‑2009 fiscal year, provided that remaining funds allocated for Work First Family Assistance and Work First Diversion Assistance are sufficient for payments made by the Department on behalf of Standard Counties pursuant to G.S. 108A‑27.11(b).

SECTION 10.36.(e)  In the event that departmental projections of Work First Family Assistance and Work First Diversion Assistance for the 2010‑2011 fiscal year indicate that remaining funds are insufficient for Work First Family Assistance and Work First Diversion Assistance payments to be made on behalf of Standard Counties, the Department is authorized to deallocate funds, of those allocated to Electing Counties for Work First Family Assistance in excess of the sums set forth in G.S. 108A‑27.11, up to the requisite amount for payments in Standard Counties. Prior to deallocation, the Department shall obtain approval by the Office of State Budget and Management. If the Department adjusts the allocation set forth in subsection (d) of this section, then a report shall be made to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

 

NON‑MEDICAID REIMBURSEMENT CHANGES

SECTION 10.37.(a)  Providers of medical services under the various State programs, other than Medicaid, offering medical care to citizens of the State shall be reimbursed at rates no higher than those under the North Carolina Medical Assistance Program.

The Department of Health and Human Services may reimburse hospitals at the full prospective per diem rates without regard to the Medical Assistance Program's annual limits on hospital days. When the Medical Assistance Program's per diem rates for inpatient services and its interim rates for outpatient services are used to reimburse providers in non‑Medicaid medical service programs, retroactive adjustments to claims already paid shall not be required.

Notwithstanding the provisions of this section, the Department of Health and Human Services may negotiate with providers of medical services under the various Department of Health and Human Services programs, other than Medicaid, for rates as close as possible to Medicaid rates for the following purposes:  contracts or agreements for medical services and purchases of medical equipment and other medical supplies. These negotiated rates are allowable only to meet the medical needs of its non‑Medicaid eligible patients, residents, and clients who require such services that cannot be provided when limited to the Medicaid rate.

Maximum net family annual income eligibility standards for services in these programs shall be as follows:

DSB Medical Eye Care                                                125% FPL

DSB Independent Living <55                                        125% FPL

DSB Independent Living 55>                                        200% FPL

DSB Vocational Rehabilitation                                      125% FPL

DVR Independent Living                                              125% FPL

DVR Vocational Rehabilitation                                      125% FPL

The Department of Health and Human Services shall contract at, or as close as possible to, Medicaid rates for medical services provided to residents of State facilities of the Department.

SECTION 10.37.(b)  Subject to the prior approval of the Office of State Budget and Management, the Secretary shall reduce provider rates for services rendered for the Medical Eye Care, Independent Living, and Vocational Rehabilitation programs within the Division of Services for the Blind, and Independent Living and Vocational Rehabilitation programs within the Division of Vocational Rehabilitation to accomplish the reduction in funds for this purpose enacted in this act.

 

STATE‑COUNTY SPECIAL ASSISTANCE

SECTION 10.38.(a)  The maximum monthly rate for residents in adult care home facilities shall be one thousand one hundred eighty‑two dollars ($1,182) per month per resident unless adjusted by the Department in accordance with subsection (d) of this section.  The eligibility of Special Assistance recipients residing in adult care homes on September 30, 2009, shall not be affected by an income reduction in the Special Assistance eligibility criteria resulting from the adoption of this maximum monthly rate, provided these recipients are otherwise eligible.

SECTION 10.38.(b)  The maximum monthly rate for residents in Alzheimer/Dementia special care units shall be one thousand five hundred fifteen dollars ($1,515) per month per resident unless adjusted by the Department in accordance with subsection (d) of this section.

SECTION 10.38.(c)  Notwithstanding any other provision of this section, the Department of Health and Human Services shall review activities and costs related to the provision of care in adult care homes and shall determine what costs may be considered to properly maximize allowable reimbursement available through Medicaid personal care services for adult care homes (ACH‑PCS) under federal law.  As determined, and with any necessary approval from the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS), and the approval of the Office of State Budget and Management, the Department may transfer necessary funds from the State‑County Special Assistance program within the Division of Social Services to the Division of Medical Assistance and may use those funds as State match to draw down federal matching funds to pay for such activities and costs under Medicaid's ACH‑PCS, thus maximizing available federal funds. The established rate for State‑County Special Assistance set forth in subsections (b) and (c) of this section shall be adjusted by the Department to reflect any transfer of funds from the Division of Social Services to the Division of Medical Assistance and related transfer costs and responsibilities from State‑County Special Assistance to the Medicaid ACH‑PCS. Subject to approval by the CMS and prior to implementing this section, the Department may disregard a limited amount of income for individuals whose countable income exceeds the adjusted State‑County Special Assistance rate. The amount of the disregard shall not exceed the difference between the State‑County Special Assistance rate prior to the adjustment and the State‑County Special Assistance rate after the adjustment and shall be used to pay a portion of the cost of the ACH‑PCS and reduce the Medicaid payment for the individual's personal care services provided in an adult care home. In no event shall the reimbursement for services through the ACH‑PCS exceed the average cost of the services as determined by the Department from review of cost reports as required and submitted by adult care homes. The Department shall report any transfers of funds and modifications of rates to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

SECTION 10.38.(d)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall recommend rates for State‑County Special Assistance and for Adult Care Home Personal Care Services.  The Department may recommend rates based on appropriate cost methodology and cost reports submitted by adult care homes that receive State‑County Special Assistance funds and shall ensure that cost reporting is done for State‑County Special Assistance and Adult Care Home Personal Care Services to the same standards as apply to other residential service providers.

 

MEDICAID

SECTION 10.40.(a)  Use of Funds, Allocation of Costs, Other Authorizations. –

(1)        Use of funds. – Funds appropriated in this act for services provided in accordance with Title XIX of the Social Security Act (Medicaid) are for both the categorically needy and the medically needy.

(2)        Allocation of nonfederal cost of Medicaid. – The State shall pay one hundred percent (100%) of the nonfederal costs of all applicable services listed in this section. In addition, the State shall pay one hundred percent (100%) of the federal Medicare Part D clawback payments under the Medicare Modernization Act of 2004.

(3)        Use of funds for development and acquisition of equipment and software. – If first approved by the Office of State Budget and Management, the Division of Medical Assistance, Department of Health and Human Services, may use funds that are identified to support the cost of development and acquisition of equipment and software and related operational costs through contractual means to improve and enhance information systems that provide management information and claims processing. The Department of Health and Human Services shall identify adequate funds to support the implementation and first year's operational costs that exceed funds allocated for the new contract for the fiscal agent for the Medicaid Management Information System.

(4)        Reports. – Unless otherwise provided, whenever the Department of Health and Human Services is required by this section to report to the General Assembly, the report shall be submitted to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division of the Legislative Services Office. Reports shall be submitted on the date provided in the reporting requirement.

SECTION 10.40.(b)  Policy. –

(1)        Volume purchase plans and single source procurement. – The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, may, subject to the approval of a change in the State Medicaid Plan, contract for services, medical equipment, supplies, and appliances by implementation of volume purchase plans, single source procurement, or other contracting processes in order to improve cost containment.

(2)        Cost containment programs. – The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, may undertake cost containment programs, including contracting for services, preadmissions to hospitals, and prior approval for certain outpatient surgeries before they may be performed in an inpatient setting.

(3)        Fraud and abuse. – The Division of Medical Assistance, Department of Health and Human Services, shall provide incentives to counties that successfully recover fraudulently spent Medicaid funds by sharing State savings with counties responsible for the recovery of the fraudulently spent funds.

(4)        Medical policy. – Unless required for compliance with federal law, the Department shall not change medical policy affecting the amount, sufficiency, duration, and scope of health care services and who may provide services until the Division of Medical Assistance has prepared a five‑year fiscal analysis documenting the increased cost of the proposed change in medical policy and submitted it for departmental review. If the fiscal impact indicated by the fiscal analysis for any proposed medical policy change exceeds three million dollars ($3,000,000) in total requirements for a given fiscal year, then the Department shall submit the proposed medical policy change with the fiscal analysis to the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division. The Department shall not implement any proposed medical policy change exceeding three million dollars ($3,000,000) in total requirements for a given fiscal year unless the source of State funding is identified and approved by the Office of State Budget and Management. For medical policy changes exceeding three million dollars ($3,000,000) in total requirements for a given fiscal year that are required for compliance with federal law, the Department shall submit the proposed medical policy or policy interpretation change with the five‑year fiscal analysis to the Office of State Budget and Management prior to implementing the change. The Department shall provide the Office of State Budget and Management and the Fiscal Research Division a quarterly report itemizing all medical policy changes with total requirements of less than three million dollars ($3,000,000).

SECTION 10.40.(c)  Eligibility. – Eligibility for Medicaid shall be determined in accordance with the following:

(1)        Medicaid and Work First Family Assistance. –

a.         Income eligibility standards. – The maximum net family annual income eligibility standards for Medicaid and Work First Family Assistance and the Standard of Need for Work First Family Assistance shall be as follows:

 

                                              CATEGORICALLY                                     MEDICALLY

                              NEEDY – WFFA*                                          NEEDY

 

                  Standard of Need

                       &

                  Families and

                  Families and                       WFFA*                       Children &

Family        Children                             Payment                       AA, AB, AD*

Size            Income Level                      Level                            Income Level

1                 $4,344                               $2,172                          $2,900

2                   5,664                                 2,832                            3,800

3                   6,528                                 3,264                            4,400

4                   7,128                                 3,564                            4,800

5                   7,776                                 3,888                            5,200

6                   8,376                                 4,188                            5,600

7                   8,952                                 4,476                            6,000

8                   9,256                                 4,680                            6,300

 

*Work First Family Assistance (WFFA); Aid to the Aged (AA); Aid to the Blind (AB); and Aid to the Disabled (AD).

b.         The payment level for Work First Family Assistance shall be fifty percent (50%) of the standard of need. These standards may be changed with the approval of the Director of the Budget.

c.         The Department of Health and Human Services shall provide Medicaid coverage to 19‑ and 20‑year‑olds in accordance with federal rules and regulations.

d.         Medicaid enrollment of categorically needy families with children shall be continuous for one year without regard to changes in income or assets.

(2)        For the following Medicaid eligibility classifications for which the federal poverty guidelines are used as income limits for eligibility determinations, the income limits will be updated each April 1 immediately following publication of federal poverty guidelines. The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall provide Medicaid coverage to the following:

a.         All elderly, blind, and disabled people who have incomes equal to or less than one hundred percent (100%) of the federal poverty guidelines.

b.         Pregnant women with incomes equal to or less than one hundred eighty‑five percent (185%) of the federal poverty guidelines and without regard to resources. Services to pregnant women eligible under this subsection continue throughout the pregnancy but include only those related to pregnancy and to those other conditions determined by the Department as conditions that may complicate pregnancy.

c.         Infants under the age of one with family incomes equal to or less than two hundred percent (200%) of the federal poverty guidelines and without regard to resources.

d.         Children aged one through five with family incomes equal to or less than two hundred percent (200%) of the federal poverty guidelines and without regard to resources.

e.         Children aged six through 18 with family incomes equal to or less than one hundred percent (100%) of the federal poverty guidelines and without regard to resources.

f.          Family planning services to men and women of childbearing age with family incomes equal to or less than one hundred eighty‑five percent (185%) of the federal poverty guidelines and without regard to resources.

g.         Workers with disabilities described in G.S. 108A‑54.1 with unearned income equal to or less than one hundred fifty percent (150%) of the federal poverty guidelines.

(3)        The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall provide Medicaid coverage to adoptive children with special or rehabilitative needs regardless of the adoptive family's income.

(4)        The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall provide Medicaid coverage to "independent foster care adolescents," ages 18, 19, and 20, as defined in section 1905(w)(1) of the Social Security Act [42 U.S.C. § 1396d(w)(1)], without regard to the adolescent's assets, resources, or income levels.

(5)        ICF and ICF/MR work incentive allowances. – The Department of Health and Human Services may provide an incentive allowance to Medicaid‑eligible recipients of ICF and ICF/MR services, who are regularly engaged in work activities as part of their developmental plan, and for whom retention of additional income contributes to their achievement of independence. The State funds required to match the federal funds that are required by these allowances shall be provided from savings within the Medicaid budget or from other unbudgeted funds available to the Department. The incentive allowances may be as follows:

Monthly Net Wages                                Monthly Incentive Allowance

$1.00 to $100.99                                       Up to $50.00

$101.00 to $200.99                                   $80.00

$201.00 to $300.99                                   $130.00

$301.00 and greater                                   $212.00

(6)        The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall provide Medicaid coverage to women who need treatment for breast or cervical cancer and who are defined in 42 U.S.C. § 1396a.(a)(10)(A)(ii)(XVIII).

SECTION 10.40.(d)  Services and Payment Bases. – The Department shall spend funds appropriated for Medicaid services in accordance with the following schedule of services and payment bases. All services and payments are subject to the language at the end of this subsection. Unless otherwise provided, services and payment bases will be as prescribed in the State Plan as established by the Department of Health and Human Services and may be changed with the approval of the Director of the Budget.

The Department of Health and Human Services (DHHS) shall operate and manage the Medicaid program within the annual State appropriation. DHHS shall establish policies, practices, rates, and expenditure procedures that are in compliance with CMS regulations and approved State Plans, State laws, and regulations.

Additionally, the Department shall be required to use the Physician's Advisory Group for review and will collaborate with other stakeholder groups in the adoption and implementation of all clinical and payment policies, including all public notice and posting provisions in use as of the effective date of this provision.

(1)        Mandatory Services – In order to manage the Medicaid program within the annual State appropriation, the Secretary shall have the authority to submit State Plan amendments and establish temporary rules affecting the amount of service and payment rate for the following mandatory services:

a.         Hospital inpatient. – Payment for hospital inpatient services will be prescribed by the State Plan as established by the Department of Health and Human Services.

b.         Hospital outpatient. – Eighty percent (80%) of allowable costs or a prospective reimbursement plan as established by the Department of Health and Human Services.

c.         Nursing facilities. – Nursing facilities providing services to Medicaid recipients who also qualify for Medicare must be enrolled in the Medicare program as a condition of participation in the Medicaid program. State facilities are not subject to the requirement to enroll in the Medicare program. Residents of nursing facilities who are eligible for Medicare coverage of nursing facility services must be placed in a Medicare‑certified bed. Medicaid shall cover facility services only after the appropriate services have been billed to Medicare.

d.         Physicians, certified nurse midwife services, nurse practitioners, physician assistants. – Fee schedules as developed by the Department of Health and Human Services.

e.         EPSDT Screens. – Payments in accordance with rate schedule developed by the Department of Health and Human Services.

f.          Home health and related services, durable medical equipment. – Payments according to reimbursement plans developed by the Department of Health and Human Services.

g.         Rural health clinical services. – Provider‑based, reasonable cost, nonprovider‑based, single‑cost reimbursement rate per clinic visit.

h.         Family planning. – Negotiated rate for local health departments. For other providers see specific services, e.g., hospitals, physicians.

i.          Independent laboratory and X‑ray services. – Uniform fee schedules as developed by the Department of Health and Human Services.

j.          Medicare Buy‑In. – Social Security Administration premium.

k.         Ambulance services. – Uniform fee schedules as developed by the Department of Health and Human Services. Public ambulance providers will be reimbursed at cost.

l.          Medicare crossover claims. – The Department shall apply Medicaid medical policy to Medicare claims for dually eligible recipients. The Department shall pay an amount up to the actual coinsurance or deductible or both, in accordance with the State Plan, as approved by the Department of Health and Human Services. The Department may disregard application of this policy in cases where application of the policy would adversely affect patient care.

m.        Pregnancy‑related services. – Covered services for pregnant women shall include nutritional counseling, psychosocial counseling, and predelivery and postpartum home visits as described in clinical policy.

n.         Mental health services. – Coverage is limited to children eligible for EPSDT services provided by:

1.         Licensed or certified psychologists, licensed clinical social workers, certified clinical nurse specialists in psychiatric mental health advanced practice, nurse practitioners certified as clinical nurse specialists in psychiatric mental health advanced practice, licensed psychological associates, licensed professional counselors, licensed marriage and family therapists, licensed clinical addictions specialists, and certified clinical supervisors, when Medicaid‑eligible children are referred by the Community Care of North Carolina primary care physician, a Medicaid‑enrolled psychiatrist, or the area mental health program or local management entity, and

2.         Institutional providers of residential services as defined by the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services and approved by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS) for children and Psychiatric Residential Treatment Facility services that meet federal and State requirements as defined by the Department.

(2)        Optional Services – In order to manage the Medicaid program within the annual State appropriation, the Secretary shall have the authority to submit State Plan amendments and establish temporary rules affecting the amount of service, payment rate, or elimination of the following optional services:

a.         Certified registered nurse anesthetists.

b.         Community Alternative Programs.

c.         Hearing aids. – Wholesale cost plus dispensing fee to provider.

d.         Ambulatory surgical centers.

e.         Private duty nursing, clinic services, prepaid health plans.

f.          Intermediate care facilities for the mentally retarded.

g.         Chiropractors, podiatrists, optometrists, dentists.

h.         Dental coverage. – Dental services shall be provided on a restricted basis in accordance with criteria adopted by the Department to implement this subsection.

i.          Optical supplies. – Payment for materials is made to a contractor in accordance with 42 C.F.R. § 431.54(d). Fees paid to dispensing providers are negotiated fees established by the State agency based on industry charges.

j.          Physical therapy, occupational therapy, and speech therapy. – Services for adults. Payments are to be made only to qualified providers at rates negotiated by the Department of Health and Human Services.

k.         Personal care services. – Payment in accordance with the State Plan developed by the Department of Health and Human Services.

l.          Case management services. – Reimbursement in accordance with the availability of funds to be transferred within the Department of Health and Human Services.

m.        Hospice and palliative care.

n.         Medically necessary prosthetics or orthotics. – In order to be eligible for reimbursement, providers must be licensed or certified by the occupational licensing board or the certification authority having authority over the provider's license or certification. Medically necessary prosthetics and orthotics are subject to prior approval and utilization review.

o.         Health insurance premiums.

p.         Medical care/other remedial care. – Services not covered elsewhere in this section include related services in schools; health professional services provided outside the clinic setting to meet maternal and infant health goals.

q.         Bariatric surgeries. – Covered as described in clinical policy 1A‑15, Surgery for Clinically Severe Obesity. In order to raise the standard of bariatric care in North Carolina, approval for these procedures shall only be granted to those providers (facilities and surgeons) who are designated as a Bariatric Surgery Center of Excellence (BSCOE) by the American Society for Metabolic and Bariatric Surgery (ASMBS). Providers must then submit to NC Medicaid documentation of their designation as a BSCOE as well as verify their continued annual participation.

r.          Drugs. –

1.         Reimbursements. – Reimbursements shall be available for prescription drugs as allowed by federal regulations plus a professional services fee per month, excluding refills for the same drug or generic equivalent during the same month. Payments for drugs are subject to the provisions of this subdivision or in accordance with the State Plan adopted by the Department of Health and Human Services, consistent with federal reimbursement regulations. Payment of the professional services fee shall be made in accordance with the State Plan adopted by the Department of Health and Human Services, consistent with federal reimbursement regulations. The professional services fee shall be established by the Department. In addition to the professional services fee, the Department may pay an enhanced fee for pharmacy services.

2.         Limitations on quantity. – The Department of Health and Human Services may establish authorizations, limitations, and reviews for specific drugs, drug classes, brands, or quantities in order to manage effectively the Medicaid program. The Department may impose prior authorization requirements on brand‑name drugs for which the phrase "medically necessary" is written on the prescription.

3.         Dispensing of generic drugs. – Notwithstanding G.S. 90‑85.27 through G.S. 90‑85.31, or any other law to the contrary, under the Medical Assistance Program (Title XIX of the Social Security Act), and except as otherwise provided in this subsection for drugs listed in the narrow therapeutic index, a prescription order for a drug designated by a trade or brand name shall be considered to be an order for the drug by its established or generic name, except when the prescriber has determined, at the time the drug is prescribed, that the brand‑name drug is medically necessary and has written on the prescription order the phrase "medically necessary." An initial prescription order for a drug listed in the narrow therapeutic drug index that does not contain the phrase "medically necessary" shall be considered an order for the drug by its established or generic name, except that a pharmacy shall not substitute a generic or established name prescription drug for subsequent brand or trade name prescription orders of the same prescription drug without explicit oral or written approval of the prescriber given at the time the order is filled. Generic drugs shall be dispensed at a lower cost to the Medical Assistance Program rather than trade or brand‑name drugs. Notwithstanding this subdivision to the contrary, the Secretary of Health and Human Services may prevent substitution of a generic equivalent drug, including a generic equivalent that is on the State maximum allowable cost list, when the net cost to the State of the brand‑name drug, after consideration of all rebates, is less than the cost of the generic equivalent. As used in this subsection, "brand name" means the proprietary name the manufacturer places upon a drug product or on its container, label, or wrapping at the time of packaging; and "established name" has the same meaning as in section 502(e)(3) of the Federal Food, Drug, and Cosmetic Act, as amended, 21 U.S.C. § 352(e)(3).

4.         Specialty drug provider network. – The Department of Health and Human Services shall work with specialty drug providers, manufacturers of specialty drugs, Medicaid recipients who are prescribed specialty drugs, and the medical professionals that treat Medicaid recipients who are prescribed specialty drugs to develop ways to ensure that best practices and the prevention of overutilization are maintained in the delivery and utilization of specialty drugs.

5.         Lock controlled substances prescriptions into single pharmacy/provider. – The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance (DMA), shall lock Medicaid enrollees into a single pharmacy and provider when the Medicaid enrollee's utilization of selected controlled substance medications meets the lock‑in criteria approved by the Physicians Advisory Group (PAG), as follows:

I.          Enrollees may be prescribed selected controlled substance medications by only one prescribing physician and may not change the prescribing physician at any time without prior approval or authorization by the Division.

II.         Enrollees may have prescriptions for selected controlled substance medications filled at only one pharmacy and may not change to another pharmacy at any time without prior approval or authorization by the Division.

6.         Preferred Drug List (PDL). – The Department of Health and Human Services shall establish and implement a PDL program under the DMA. Medications prescribed for the treatment of mental illness shall be included on the PDL.

The Physician Advisory Group Pharmacy and Therapeutics (PAG P&T) Committee shall provide ongoing review of the preferred drug list, including the implementation of prior authorization on identified drugs. Members of the committee shall submit conflict of interest disclosure statements to the Department and shall have an ongoing duty to disclose conflicts of interest not included in the original disclosure.

The Department, in consultation with the PAG, shall adopt and publish policies and procedures relating to the PDL, including:

I.          Guidelines for the presentation and review of drugs for inclusion on the PDL,

II.         The manner and frequency of audits of the PDL for appropriateness of patient care and cost‑effectiveness,

III.       An appeals process for the resolution of disputes, and

IV.       Such other policies and procedures as the Department deems necessary and appropriate.

The Department and the PAG P&T Committee shall consider all therapeutic classes of prescription drugs for inclusion on the PDL.

The Department shall maintain an updated PDL in electronic format and shall make the list available to the public on the Department's Internet Web site.

The Department shall (i) enter into a multistate purchasing pool; (ii) negotiate directly with manufacturers or labelers; (iii) contract with a pharmacy benefit manager for negotiated discounts or rebates for all prescription drugs under the Medical Assistance Program; or (iv) effectuate any combination of these options in order to achieve the lowest available price for such drugs under such program.

The Department may negotiate supplemental rebates from manufacturers that are in addition to those required by Title XIX of the federal Social Security Act. The committee shall consider a product for inclusion on the PDL if the manufacturer provides a supplemental rebate. The Department may procure a sole source contract with an outside entity or contractor to conduct negotiations for supplemental rebates.

The Secretary of the Department of Health and Human Services shall establish a PDL Policy Review Panel within 60 days after the effective date of this section. The purpose of the PDL Policy Review Panel is to review the Medicaid PDL recommendations from the DMA, and the PAG P&T Committee.

The Secretary shall appoint the following individuals to the review panel:

I.          The Director of Pharmacy for the DMA.

II.         A representative from the PAG P&T Committee.

III.       A representative from the Old North State Medical Society.

IV.       A representative from the North Carolina Association of Pharmacists.

V.        A representative from Community Care of North Carolina (CCNC).

VI.       A representative from the North Carolina Psychiatric Association.

VII.      A representative from the North Carolina Pediatric Society.

VIII.     A representative from the North Carolina Academy of Family Physicians.

IX.       A representative from the North Carolina Chapter of the American College of Physicians.

X.        A representative from a research‑based pharmaceutical company.

XI.       A representative from a hospital‑based pharmacy.

Individuals appointed to a PDL Policy Review Panel, except for the Division's Director of Pharmacy, shall serve only a two‑year term.

After the Department, in consultation with the PAG P&T Committee, publishes a proposed policy or procedure related to the Medicaid PDL, the PDL Policy Review Panel shall hold an open meeting to review the recommended policy or procedure along with any written public comments received as a result of the posting. The PDL Policy Review Panel shall provide an opportunity for public comment at the meeting. After the conclusion of the meeting, the PDL Policy Review Panel shall submit policy recommendations about the proposed Medicaid PDL policy or procedure to the Secretary.

The Department may establish a PDL for the North Carolina Health Choice for Children program and pursue negotiated discounts or rebates for all prescription drugs under the program in order to achieve the lowest available price for such drugs under such program. The Department may procure a sole source contract with an outside entity or contractor to conduct negotiations for these discounts or rebates. The PAG P&T Committee and PDL Policy Review Panel will provide recommendations on policies and procedures for the NC Health Choice PDL.

s.          Incentive payments as outlined in the State Medicaid Health Information Plan for Electronic Health Records.

t.          Other mental health services. – Unless otherwise covered by this section, coverage is limited to the following:

1.         Services as established by the DMA in consultation with the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services and approved by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS), when provided in agencies meeting the requirements and reimbursement is made in accordance with a State Plan developed by the Department of Health and Human Services not to exceed the upper limits established in federal regulations, and

2.         For Medicaid‑eligible adults, services provided by licensed or certified psychologists, licensed clinical social workers, certified clinical nurse specialists in psychiatric mental health advanced practice, nurse practitioners certified as clinical nurse specialists in psychiatric mental health advanced practice, licensed psychological associates, licensed professional counselors, licensed marriage and family therapists, certified clinical addictions specialists, and licensed clinical supervisors, may be self‑referred.

3.         Payments made for services rendered in accordance with this subdivision shall be to qualified providers in accordance with approved policies and the State Plan. Nothing in sub‑subdivision b. or c. of this subdivision shall be interpreted to modify the scope of practice of any service provider, practitioner, or licensee, nor to modify or attenuate any collaboration or supervision requirement related to the professional activities of any service provider, practitioner, or licensee. Nothing in sub‑subdivision b. or c. of this subdivision shall be interpreted to require any private health insurer or health plan to make direct third‑party reimbursements or payments to any service provider, practitioner, or licensee.

Notwithstanding G.S. 150B‑21.1(a), the Department of Health and Human Services may adopt temporary rules in accordance with Chapter 150B of the General Statutes further defining the qualifications of providers and referral procedures in order to implement this subdivision. Coverage policy for services established by the DMA in consultation with the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services under sub‑subdivisions a. and b.2. of this subdivision shall be established by the DMA.

u.         Experimental/investigational medical procedures. – Coverage is limited to services, supplies, drugs, or devices recognized as standard medical care for the condition, disease, illness, or injury being treated as determined by nationally recognized scientific professional organizations or scientifically based federal organizations such as the Food and Drug Administration, the National Institutes of Health, the Centers for Disease Control, or the Agency for Health Care Research and Quality.

v.         Clinical trials. – The DMA shall develop clinical policy for the coverage of routine costs in clinical trial services for life‑threatening conditions using resources such as coverage criteria from Medicare and the NC State Health Plan and the input of the PAG.

(3)        Never Events and Hospital Acquired Conditions (HACs) shall not be reimbursed. Medicaid will adhere to Medicare requirements for definition of events and conditions.

SECTION 10.40.(e)  Provider Performance Bonds and Visits. –

(1)        Subject to the provisions of this subdivision, the Department may require Medicaid‑enrolled providers to purchase a performance bond in an amount not to exceed one hundred thousand dollars ($100,000) naming as beneficiary the Department of Health and Human Services, DMA, or provide to the Department a validly executed letter of credit or other financial instrument issued by a financial institution or agency honoring a demand for payment in an equivalent amount. The Department may require the purchase of a performance bond or the submission of an executed letter of credit or financial instrument as a condition of initial enrollment, reenrollment, or reinstatement if:

a.         The provider fails to demonstrate financial viability.

b.         The Department determines there is significant potential for fraud and abuse.

c.         The Department otherwise finds it is in the best interest of the Medicaid program to do so.

The Department shall specify the circumstances under which a performance bond or executed letter of credit will be required.

(1a)      The Department may waive or limit the requirements of this subsection for individual Medicaid‑enrolled providers or for one or more classes of Medicaid‑enrolled providers based on the following:

a.         The provider's or provider class's dollar amount of monthly billings to Medicaid.

b.         The length of time an individual provider has been licensed, endorsed, certified, or accredited in this State to provide services.

c.         The length of time an individual provider has been enrolled to provide Medicaid services in this State.

d.         The provider's demonstrated ability to ensure adequate record keeping, staffing, and services.

e.         The need to ensure adequate access to care.

In waiving or limiting requirements of this subsection, the Department shall take into consideration the potential fiscal impact of the waiver or limitation on the State Medicaid Program. The Department shall provide to the affected provider written notice of the findings upon which its action is based and shall include the performance bond requirements and the conditions under which a waiver or limitation applies. The Department may adopt temporary rules in accordance with G.S. 150B‑21.1 as necessary to implement this provision.

(2)        Reimbursement is available for up to 30 visits per recipient per fiscal year for the following professional services: physicians, nurse practitioners, nurse midwives, physician assistants, clinics, health departments, optometrists, chiropractors, and podiatrists. The Department of Health and Human Services shall adopt medical policies in accordance with G.S. 108A‑54.2 to distribute the allowable number of visits for each service or each group of services consistent with federal law. In addition, the Department shall establish a threshold of some number of visits for these services. The Department shall ensure that primary care providers or the appropriate CCNC network are notified when a patient is nearing the established threshold to facilitate care coordination and intervention as needed.

Prenatal services, all Early and Periodic Screenings, Diagnosis, and Treatment (EPSDT) children, emergency room visits, and mental health visits subject to independent utilization review are exempt from the visit limitations contained in this subdivision. Subject to appropriate medical review, the Department may authorize exceptions when additional care is medically necessary. Routine or maintenance visits above the established visit limit will not be covered unless necessary to actively manage a life‑threatening disorder or as an alternative to more costly care options.

SECTION 10.40.(f)  Exceptions and Limitations on Services; Authorization of Co‑Payments and Other Services. –

(1)        Exceptions to service limitations, eligibility requirements, and payments. – Service limitations, eligibility requirements, and payment bases in this section may be waived by the Department of Health and Human Services, with the approval of the Director of the Budget, to allow the Department to carry out pilot programs for prepaid health plans, contracting for services, managed care plans, or community‑based services programs in accordance with plans approved by the United States Department of Health and Human Services or when the Department determines that such a waiver or innovation projects will result in a reduction in the total Medicaid costs.

(2)        Co‑payment for Medicaid services. – The Department of Health and Human Services may establish co‑payments up to the maximum permitted by federal law and regulation.

(3)        Provider enrollment fee. – Effective September 1, 2009, the Department of Health and Human Services, DMA, shall charge an enrollment fee of one hundred dollars ($100.00), or the amount federally required, to each provider enrolling in the Medicaid program for the first time. The fee shall be charged to all providers at recredentialling every three years.

SECTION 10.40.(g)  Rules, Reports, and Other Matters. –

The Department of Health and Human Services may adopt temporary or emergency rules according to the procedures established in G.S. 150B‑21.1 and G.S. 150B‑21.1A when it finds that these rules are necessary to maximize receipt of federal funds within existing State appropriations, to reduce Medicaid expenditures, and to reduce fraud and abuse. The Department of Health and Human Services shall adopt rules requiring providers to attend training as a condition of enrollment and may adopt temporary or emergency rules to implement the training requirement.

Prior to the filing of the temporary or emergency rules authorized under this subsection with the Rules Review Commission and the Office of Administrative Hearings, the Department shall consult with the Office of State Budget and Management on the possible fiscal impact of the temporary or emergency rule and its effect on State appropriations and local governments.

 

DMA CONTRACT SHORTFALL

SECTION 10.41.(a)  Budget approval is required by the Office of State Budget and Management prior to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, entering into any new contract or the renewal or amendment of existing contracts that exceed the current contract amounts.

SECTION 10.41.(b)  The Division of Medical Assistance shall make every effort to effect savings within its operational budget and use those savings to offset its contract shortfall. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑6‑4(b)(3), the Department may use funds appropriated in this act to cover the contract shortfall in the Division of Medical Assistance if insufficient funds exist within the Division.

 

MEDICAID COST CONTAINMENT ACTIVITIES

SECTION 10.42.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services may use up to five million dollars ($5,000,000) in the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and up to five million dollars ($5,000,000) in the 2012‑2013 fiscal year in Medicaid funds budgeted for program services to support the cost of administrative activities when cost‑effectiveness and savings are demonstrated.  The funds shall be used to support activities that will contain the cost of the Medicaid Program, including contracting for services, hiring additional staff, funding pilot programs, Health Information Exchange and Health Information Technology (HIE/HIT) administrative activities, or providing grants through the Office of Rural Health and Community Care to plan, develop, and implement cost containment programs.

Medicaid cost containment activities may include prospective reimbursement methods, incentive‑based reimbursement methods, service limits, prior authorization of services, periodic medical necessity reviews, revised medical necessity criteria, service provision in the least costly settings, plastic magnetic stripped Medicaid identification cards for issuance to Medicaid enrollees, fraud detection software or other fraud detection activities, technology that improves clinical decision making, credit balance recovery and data mining services, and other cost containment activities. Funds may be expended under this section only after the Office of State Budget and Management has approved a proposal for the expenditure submitted by the Department. Proposals for expenditure of funds under this section shall include the cost of implementing the cost containment activity and documentation of the amount of savings expected to be realized from the cost containment activity.

SECTION 10.42.(b)  The Department shall report annually on the expenditures under this section to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division. The report shall include the methods used to achieve savings and the amount saved by these methods.  The report is due to the House and Senate Appropriations Subcommittees on Health and Human Services and the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly not later than December 1 of each year for the activities of the previous State fiscal year.

 

MEDICAID SPECIAL FUND TRANSFER

SECTION 10.43.  Of the funds transferred to the Department of Health and Human Services for Medicaid programs pursuant to G.S. 143C‑9‑1, there is appropriated from the Medicaid Special Fund to the Department of Health and Human Services the sum of forty‑three million dollars ($43,000,000) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the sum of forty‑three million dollars ($43,000,000) for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.  These funds shall be allocated as prescribed by G.S. 143C‑9‑1(b) for Medicaid programs. Notwithstanding the prescription in G.S. 143C‑9‑1(b) that these funds not reduce State general revenue funding, these funds shall replace the reduction in general revenue funding effected in this act. The Department may also use funds in the Medicaid Special Fund to fund the settlement of the Disproportionate Share Hospital payment audit issues between the Department of Health and Human Services and the federal government related to fiscal years 1997‑2002, and funds are appropriated from the Fund for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year for this purpose.

 

FAMILIES PAY PART OF THE COST OF SERVICES UNDER THE CAP‑MR/DD PROGRAM AND THE CAP‑CHILDREN'S PROGRAM BASED ON FAMILY INCOME

SECTION 10.44.(a)  Subject to approval from the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS), the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall, in consultation with the Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, and Community Alternatives Program (CAP) stakeholders, develop a schedule of cost‑sharing requirements for children of families with incomes above the Medicaid allowable limit to share in the costs of their child's Medicaid expenses under the CAP‑MR/DD (Community Alternatives Program for Mental Retardation and Developmentally Disabled) and the CAP‑C (Community Alternatives Program for Children). The cost‑sharing amounts shall be based on a sliding scale of family income and shall take into account the impact on families with more than one child in the CAP programs. In developing the schedule, the Department shall also take into consideration how other states have implemented cost‑sharing in their CAP programs. The Division of Medical Assistance may establish monthly deductibles as a means of implementing this cost‑sharing. The Department shall provide for at least one public hearing and other opportunities for individuals to comment on the imposition of cost‑sharing under the CAP program schedule.

SECTION 10.44.(b)  The Division of Medical Assistance shall also, in collaboration with the Controller's Office of the Department of Health and Human Services, the Division of Information Resource Management (DIRM), and the new vendor of the replacement Medicaid Management Information System, develop business rules and program policies and procedures, and define relevant technical requirements.

SECTION 10.44.(c)  Implementation of this provision shall be delayed until the implementation of the new Medicaid Management Information System.

 

STATEWIDE EXPANSION OF CAPITATED 1915(B)/(C) BEHAVIORAL HEALTH  WAIVERS

SECTION 10.45.  The Department of Health and Human Services (Department) shall implement the capitated 1915(b)/(c) Medicaid waiver during the 2011‑2012 fiscal year through an RFA process that includes LME applicants who prove readiness.  The waiver program shall include all Medicaid‑covered mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse services.  Expansion of the waiver shall be contingent upon approval by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services.

 

MEDICAID WAIVER FOR ASSISTED LIVING

SECTION 10.46.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance (Division), shall develop and implement a home‑ and community‑based services program under Medicaid State Plan 1915(i) authority in order to continue Medicaid funding of personal care services to individuals living in adult care homes.

SECTION 10.46.(b)  The Division shall implement the program upon approval of the application by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services.

SECTION 10.46.(c)  On or before April 1, 2012, the Division shall provide a report on the status of approval and implementation of the program to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

 

ACCOUNTING FOR MEDICAID RECEIVABLES AS NONTAX REVENUE

SECTION 10.47.(a)  Receivables reserved at the end of the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years shall, when received, be accounted for as nontax revenue for each of those fiscal years.

SECTION 10.47.(b)  For the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, the Department of Health and Human Services shall deposit from its revenues one hundred fifteen million dollars ($115,000,000) with the Department of State Treasurer to be accounted for as nontax revenue.  For the 2012‑2013 fiscal year, the Department of Health and Human Services shall deposit from its revenues one hundred fifteen million dollars ($115,000,000) with the Department of State Treasurer to be accounted for as nontax revenue. These deposits shall represent the return of General Fund appropriations provided to hospitals that are owned and operated by the State to provide indigent and nonindigent care services and shall be returned to the DHHS. The treatment of any revenue derived from federal programs shall be in accordance with the requirements specified in the Code of Federal Regulations, Volume 2, Part 225.

 

AUTHORIZE THE DIVISION OF MEDICAL ASSISTANCE TO TAKE CERTAIN STEPS TO EFFECTUATE COMPLIANCE WITH BUDGET REDUCTIONS IN THE MEDICAID PROGRAM

SECTION 10.48.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, may take the following actions, notwithstanding any other provision of this act or other State law or rule to the contrary and subject to the requirements of subsection (e) of this section:

(1)        Electronic transactions. –

a.         Medicaid providers shall follow the Department's established procedures for securing electronic payments. The Department shall not issue routine provider payments by check.

b.         All Medicaid providers shall file claims electronically to the fiscal agent. Nonelectronic claims submission may be required when it is in the best interest of the Department.

c.         Enrolled Medicaid providers shall submit Preadmission Screening and Annual Resident Reviews (PASARR) through the Department's Web‑based tool or through a vendor with interface capability to submit data into the Web‑based PASARR.

d.         Providers shall submit requests for prior authorizations electronically via the vendor's Web site. Providers may opt to access their authorizations via online portals rather than receiving hard copies by mail. Recipients will continue to receive adverse decisions via trackable mail. Providers shall receive copies electronically.

e.         Once Web portal is live for provider enrollment, providers must submit their provider enrollment applications online. Thereafter, the Department will accept electronic signatures, rather than require receipt of signed hard copies.

(2)        Clinical coverage. – The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, shall amend applicable clinical policies and submit applicable State Plan amendments to Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services (CMS) to implement the budget reductions authorized in the following clinical coverage areas in this act:

a.         Eliminate or limit adult physical therapy, occupational therapy, and speech therapy visits to three visits per calendar year.

(3)        Medicaid Personal Care Service provision. – Upon the enactment of this act, the Division of Medical Assistance shall implement the following new criteria for personal care services (PCS) set out in subdivision (3a) of this section.

(3a)      In‑Home Care provision. – In order to enhance in‑home aide services to Medicaid recipients, the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance (DMA), shall:

a.         No longer provide services under PCS and PCS‑Plus the later of January 1, 2011, or whenever CMS approves the elimination of the PCS and PCS‑Plus programs and the implementation of the following two new services:

1.         In‑Home Care for Children (IHCC). – Services to assist families to meet the in‑home care needs of children, including those individuals under the age of 21 receiving comprehensive and preventive child health services through the Early and Periodic Screening, Diagnosis, and Treatment (EPSDT) program.

2.         In‑Home Care for Adults (IHCA). – Services to meet the eating, dressing, bathing, toileting, and mobility needs of individuals 21 years of age or older who, because of a medical condition, disability, or cognitive impairment, demonstrate unmet needs for, at a minimum (i) three of the five qualifying activities of daily living (ADLs) with limited hands‑on assistance; (ii) two ADLs, one of which requires extensive assistance; or (iii) two ADLs, one of which requires assistance at the full dependence level. The five qualifying ADLs are eating, dressing, bathing, toileting, and mobility. IHCA shall serve individuals at the highest level of need for in‑home care who are able to remain safely in the home.

b.         Establish, in accordance with G.S. 108A‑54.2, a Medical Coverage Policy for each of these programs to include:

1.         For IHCC, up to 60 hours per month in accordance with an assessment conducted by DMA or its designee and a plan of care developed by the service provider and approved by DMA or its designee. Additional hours may be authorized when the services are required to correct or ameliorate defects and physical and mental illnesses and conditions in this age group, as defined in 42 U.S.C. § 1396d(r)(5), in accordance with a plan of care approved by DMA or its designee.

2.         For IHCA, up to 80 hours per month in accordance with an assessment conducted by DMA or its designee and a plan of care developed by the service provider and approved by DMA or its designee.

c.         Implement the following program limitations and restrictions to apply to both IHCC and IHCA:

1.         Additional services to children required under federal EPSDT requirements shall be provided to qualified recipients in the IHCC Program.

2.         Services shall be provided in a manner that supplements, rather than supplants, family roles and responsibilities.

3.         Services shall be authorized in amounts based on assessed need of each recipient, taking into account care and services provided by the family, other public and private agencies, and other informal caregivers who may be available to assist the family. All available resources shall be utilized fully, and services provided by such agencies and individuals shall be disclosed to the DMA assessor.

4.         Services shall be directly related to the hands‑on assistance and related tasks to complete each qualifying ADL in accordance with the IHCC or IHCA assessment and plan of care, as applicable.

5.         Services provided under IHCC and IHCA shall not include household chores not directly related to the qualifying ADLs, nonmedical transportation, financial management, and non‑hands‑on assistance such as cueing, prompting, guiding, coaching, or babysitting.

6.         Essential errands that are critical to maintaining the health and welfare of the recipient may be approved on a case‑by‑case basis by the DMA assessor when there is no family member, other individual, program, or service available to meet this need. Approval, including the amount of time required to perform this task, shall be documented on the recipient's assessment form and plan of care.

d.         Utilize the following process for admission to the HCC programs:

1.         The recipient shall be seen by his or her primary or attending physician, who shall provide written authorization for referral for the service and written attestation to the medical necessity for the service.

2.         All assessments for admission to IHCC and IHCA, continuation of these services, and change of status reviews for these services shall be performed by DMA or its designee. The DMA designee may not be an owner of a provider business or provider of in‑home or personal care services of any type.

3.         DMA or its designee shall determine and authorize the amount of service to be provided on a "needs basis," as determined by its review and findings of each recipient's degree of functional disability and level of unmet needs for hands‑on personal assistance in the five qualifying ADLs.

e.         Take all appropriate actions to manage the cost, quality, program compliance, and utilization of services provided under the IHCC and IHCA programs, including, but not limited to, the following:

1.         Priority independent reassessment of recipients before the anniversary date of their initial admission or reassessment for those recipients likely to qualify for the restructured IHCC and IHCA programs.

2.         Priority independent reassessment of recipients requesting a change of service provider.

3.         Targeted reassessments of recipient prior to their anniversary dates when the current provider assessment indicates they may not qualify for the program or for the amount of services they are currently receiving.

4.         Targeted reassessment of recipients receiving services from providers with a history of program noncompliance.

5.         Provider desk and on‑site reviews and recoupment of all identified overpayments or improper payments.

6.         Recipient reviews, interviews, and surveys.

7.         The use of mandated electronic transmission of referral forms, plans of care, and reporting forms.

8.         The use of mandated electronic transmission of uniform reporting forms for recipient complaints and critical incidents.

9.         The use of automated systems to monitor, evaluate, and profile provider performance against established performance indicators.

10.       Establishment of rules that implement the requirements of 42 C.F.R. § 441.16.

f.          Time line for implementation of new IHCC and IHCA programs.

1.         Subject to approvals from CMS, DMA shall make every effort to implement the new IHCC and IHCA programs.

2.         DMA shall ensure that individuals who qualify for the IHCC and IHCA programs shall not experience a lapse in service and, if necessary, shall be admitted on the basis of their current provider assessment when an independent reassessment has not yet been performed and the current assessment documents that the medical necessity requirements for the IHCC or IHCA program, as applicable, have been met.

3.         Prior to the implementation date of the new IHCC and IHCA programs, all recipients in the PCS and PCS‑Plus programs shall be notified pursuant to 42 C.F.R. § 431.220(b) and discharged, and the Department shall no longer provide services under the PCS and PCS‑Plus programs, which shall terminate. Recipients who qualify for the new IHCC and IHCA programs shall be admitted and shall be eligible to receive services immediately.

(4)        MH/DD/SA Personal Care and Personal Assistance Services Provision. – A denial, reduction, or termination of Medicaid‑funded in‑home care services shall result in a similar denial, reduction, or termination of State‑funded MH/DD/SA personal care and personal assistance services.

(5)        MH Residential. – The Department of Health and Human Services shall restructure the Medicaid child mental health, developmental disabilities, and substance abuse residential services to ensure that total expenditures are within budgeted levels. All restructuring activities shall be in compliance with federal and State law or rule. The Divisions of Medical Assistance and Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services shall establish a team inclusive of providers, LMEs, and other stakeholders to assure effective transition of recipients to appropriate treatment options. The restructuring shall address all of the following:

a.         Submission of the therapeutic family service definition to CMS.

b.         The Department shall reexamine the entrance and continued stay criteria for all residential services. The revised criteria shall promote least restrictive services in the home prior to residential placement. During treatment, there must be inclusion in community activities and parent or legal guardian participation in treatment.

c.         Require all existing residential providers or agencies to be nationally accredited within one year of enactment of this act. Any providers enrolled after the enactment of this act shall be subject to existing endorsement and nationally accrediting requirements. In the interim, providers who are nationally accredited will be preferred providers for placement considerations.

d.         Before a child can be admitted to Level III or Level IV placement, one or more of the following shall apply:

1.         Placement shall be a step down from a higher level placement such as a psychiatric residential treatment facility or inpatient.

2.         Multisystemic therapy or intensive in‑home therapy services have been unsuccessful.

3.         The Child and Family Team has reviewed all other alternatives and recommendations and recommends Level III or Level IV placement due to maintaining health and safety.

4.         Transition or discharge plan shall be submitted as part of the initial or concurrent request.

e.         Length of stay is limited to no more than 120 days. Any exceptions granted will require (i) an independent psychiatric assessment, (ii) Child and Family Team review of goals and treatment progress, (iii) family or discharge placement setting actively engaged in treatment goals and objectives, and (iv) active participation of the prior authorization of vendor.

f.          Submission of discharge plan is required in order for the request to be considered complete. Failure to submit a complete discharge plan will result in the request being returned as unable to process.

g.         Any residential provider that ceases to function as a provider shall provide written notification to DMA, the Local Management Entity, recipients, and the prior authorization vendor 30 days prior to closing of the business.

h.         Record maintenance is the responsibility of the provider and must be in compliance with record retention requirements. Records shall also be available to State, federal, and local agencies.

i.          Failure to comply with notification, recipient transition planning, or record maintenance shall be grounds for withholding payment until such activity is concluded. In addition, failure to comply shall be conditions that prevent enrollment for any Medicaid or State‑funded service. A provider (including its officers, directors, agents, or managing employees or individuals or entities having a direct or indirect ownership interest or control interest of five percent (5%) or more as set forth in Title XI of the Social Security Act) that fails to comply with the required record retention may be subject to sanctions, including exclusion from further participation in the Medicaid program, as set forth in Title XI of the Social Security Act.

(6)        Medicaid identification cards. – The Department shall issue Medicaid identification cards to recipients on an annual basis with quarterly updates.

(7)        The Division of Medical Assistance together with NCCCN shall develop a State plan amendment that maximizes the increased FMAP available through Health Home for enrollees with chronic conditions under PPACA. This may include, but is not limited to, modification to clinical policies and further case and care management consolidation.

(8)        For the purpose of promoting cost‑effective utilization of outpatient mental health services for children, DMA shall require prior authorization for services following the sixteenth visit.

(9)        Provision of Medicaid Private Duty Nursing (PDN). – DMA shall change the Medicaid Private Duty Nursing program provided under the State Medicaid Plan, as follows:

a.         Restructure the current PDN program to provide services that are:

1.         Provided only to qualified recipients under the age of 21.

2.         Authorized by the recipient's primary care or attending physician.

3.         Limited to 16 hours of service per day, unless additional services are required to correct or ameliorate defects and physical and mental illnesses and conditions as defined in 42 U.S.C. § 1396d(r)(5).

4.         Approved based on an initial assessment and continuing need reassessments performed by an Independent Assessment Entity (IAE) that does not provide PDN services and authorized in amounts that are medically necessary based on the recipient's medical condition, amount of family assistance available, and other relevant conditions and circumstances, as defined by the Medicaid Clinical Coverage Policy for this service.

5.         Provided in accordance with a plan of care approved by DMA or its designee.

b.         Develop and submit to CMS a 1915(c) Home and Community Based Services Waiver for individuals dependent on technology to substitute for a vital body function.

c.         Once approved by CMS and upon approval of the Medicaid Clinical Coverage Policy, all qualified recipients age 21 and older currently receiving PDN will be transitioned to waiver services provided under the Technology‑Dependent Waiver.

SECTION 10.48.(b)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall not implement any actions directed by this act if the Department determines that such actions would jeopardize the receipt of federal funds appropriated or allocated to the Department.

The Department of Health and Human Services shall not implement any actions directed by this act if the Department determines that such actions would jeopardize the receipt of federal Medicaid funds appropriated or allocated to the Department.

 

ADOPTION ASSISTANCE VENDOR PAYMENTS AND STATE ADOPTION ASSISTANCE

SECTION 10.49.(a)  The Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, is authorized to eliminate the Adoption Assistance Vendor payments for all adoptions finalized on or after July 1, 2011. All agreements entered into prior to July 1, 2011, will remain in effect.

SECTION 10.49.(b)  Eligibility for Adoption Assistance is clarified to mean that only children who have been in foster care are eligible for Adoption Assistance.

 

REDUCE FRAUD AND ABUSE IN THE MEDICAID AND HEALTH CHOICE PROGRAMS

SECTION 10.50.(a)  The General Statutes are amended by adding a new Chapter to read:

"Chapter 108C.

"Medicaid and Health Choice Provider Requirements.

"§ 108C‑1.  Scope; applicability of this Chapter.

(a)        This Chapter shall apply to health care providers as that term is defined in G.S. 108C‑2(e).

(b)        Nothing in the North Carolina General Statutes or the North Carolina Administrative Code shall be construed to give rise to any property or liberty right in initial or continued participation as a provider in the North Carolina Medicaid or Health Choice programs.

(c)        Entering into a Medicaid or Health Choice administrative participation or enrollment agreement with the Department does not give rise to any property or liberty right in continued participation as a provider in the North Carolina Medicaid or Health Choice programs.

(d)        The approval or acceptance of a Medicaid administrative participation or enrollment agreement by the Department that grants Medicaid billing privileges or allows a provider to furnish services under the North Carolina State Plan for Medical Assistance in accordance with 42 C.F.R. § 431.107 shall not be construed to waive the Department's sovereign immunity.

"§ 108C‑2.  Definitions.

(a)        Department. – The North Carolina Department of Health and Human Services.

(b)        Division. – The Division of Medical Assistance of the North Carolina Department of Health and Human Services.

(c)        Medicaid. – The Medical Assistance program authorized by G.S. 108A‑54 and as set forth in the North Carolina State Plan for Medical Assistance.

(d)        Health Choice. – The Health Insurance Program for Children authorized by G.S. 108A‑70.25 and as set forth in the North Carolina State Plan for the Health Insurance Program for Children.

(e)        Health Care Provider or Provider. – An individual, partnership, group, association, corporation, institution, or entity enrolled or seeking to enroll in the North Carolina Medicaid program or the North Carolina Health Insurance Program for Children, or who provides State‑funded behavioral health services or any other services reimbursed from any federal block grant funds.

(f)         Program Integrity. – This term means all activities undertaken by the Department, its Divisions, contractors, vendors, and authorized agents to prevent fraud, waste, and abuse in and ensure the integrity of the North Carolina Medicaid and Health Choice programs.

(g)        Revalidation. – This term means the reenrollment of a provider in the Medicaid or Health Choice programs as required under State or federal law.

"§ 108C‑3.  Medicaid and Health Choice provider screening.

(a)        The Department shall conduct provider screening of Medicaid and Health Choice providers in accordance with the Affordable Care Act and implementing regulations and this Chapter.

(b)        The Department must screen all initial and revalidation applications for enrollment in Medicaid and Health Choice, including applications for a new practice location, based on Department assessment of risk and assignment to a categorical risk level of "limited," "moderate," or "high." If a provider could fit within more than one risk level, the highest level of screening is applicable.

(c)        Limited Categorical Risk Provider Categories. – The following provider types are hereby designated as "limited" categorical risk:

(1)        Physician or nonphysician practitioners (including nurse practitioners, CRNAs, physician assistants, physician extenders, occupational therapists, speech/language pathologists, chiropractors, optometrists, and audiologists) and medical groups or clinics.

(2)        Ambulatory surgical centers.

(3)        End‑stage renal disease facilities.

(4)        Federally qualified health centers.

(5)        Histocompatibility laboratories.

(6)        Vision and hearing aid providers.

(7)        Transplant and transplant‑related service providers.

(8)        Hospitals, including critical access hospitals, Department of Veterans Affairs Hospitals, and other State or federally owned hospital facilities.

(9)        Health programs operated by an Indian Health Program (as defined in section 4(12) of the Indian Health Care Improvement Act) or an urban Indian organization (as defined in section 4(29) of the Indian Health Care Improvement Act) that receives funding from the Indian Health Service pursuant to Title V of the Indian Health Care Improvement Act.

(10)      Mammography screening centers.

(11)      Mass immunization roster billers.

(12)      Organ procurement organizations.

(13)      Radiation therapy centers.

(14)      Rural health clinics.

(15)      Nursing facilities, including intermediate care facilities for the mentally retarded.

(16)      Local education agencies.

(d)        Moderate Categorical Risk Provider Categories. – The following provider types are hereby designated as "moderate" categorical risk:

(1)        Directly‑enrolled outpatient behavioral health services providers.

(2)        Comprehensive outpatient rehabilitation facilities.

(3)        Revalidating Critical Access Behavioral Health Agencies.

(4)        Hospice organizations.

(5)        Independent clinical laboratories.

(6)        Independent diagnostic testing facilities.

(7)        Physical therapists enrolling as individuals or as group practices.

(8)        Pharmacy services.

(9)        Dentists and orthodontists.

(10)      Revalidating agencies providing private duty nursing, home health, or home infusion services.

(11)      Revalidating agencies providing home‑ or community‑based services pursuant to waivers authorized by the federal Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services under 42 U.S.C. § 1396n(c).

(e)        High Categorical Risk Provider Categories. – The following provider types are hereby designated as "high" categorical risk:

(1)        Agencies providing personal care services or in‑home care services.

(2)        Adult care homes delivering Medicaid reimbursed services.

(3)        Agencies providing durable medical equipment, including, but not limited to, orthotics and prosthetics.

(4)        Agencies providing behavioral health services, excluding revalidating critical access behavioral health agencies and all directly‑enrolled outpatient behavioral health services providers.

(5)        Prospective (newly enrolling) critical access behavioral health agencies.

(6)        Prospective (newly enrolling) agencies providing private duty nursing, home health, or home infusion services.

(7)        Prospective (newly enrolling) agencies providing home‑ or community‑based services pursuant to waivers authorized by the federal Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services under 42 U.S.C. § 1396n(c).

(8)        Agencies providing HIV case management.

(9)        Ambulance services.

(10)      Providers who have incurred a Medicaid or Health Choice overpayment to the Department in excess of ten percent (10%) of the provider's payments received from Medicaid and Health Choice in the previous 12‑month period.

(11)      Providers against whom the Department has imposed a payment suspension in accordance with 42 C.F.R. § 455.23 or G.S. 108C‑4 within the previous 12‑month period.

(12)      Providers whose owners, operators, or managing employees were convicted of a disqualifying offense pursuant to G.S. 108C‑3A but were granted an exemption by the Department within the previous 10 years.

(13)      Providers that were excluded, or whose owners, operators, or managing employees were excluded, by the OIG or another state's Medicaid program within the previous 10 years.

(f)         Adjustment of Risk Level. – The Department may adjust the categorical risk level for any individual provider or provider type from "limited" or "moderate" to "high" when any of the conditions described in 42 C.F.R. § 455.450(c)(3) or any of the following conditions occur:

(1)        The Department places a provider on prepayment review.

(2)        The provider has an outstanding overpayment owed to the Department.

(3)        The Department or any licensing board institutes a licensure action against a provider.

The Department shall establish a procedure for a provider who has had its risk level adjusted to the "moderate" or "high" category to be adjusted back to the previous risk level after the above condition(s) are resolved to the satisfaction of the Department.

(g)        For providers dually‑enrolled in the federal Medicare program and the North Carolina Medicaid program, the Department may rely on the results of the provider screening performed by Medicare contractors.

(h)        For out‑of‑state providers, the Department may rely on the results of the provider screening performed by the Medicaid agencies or Health Insurance Program for Children agencies of other states.

"§ 108C‑3A.  Criminal background checks for certain providers.

(a)        The Division shall conduct a criminal background check of and require the submission of fingerprints from a provider subject to G.S. 108C‑3(e) (a high categorical risk provider), an owner and/or operator of that provider, and its managing employees, unless it is relying upon the results of screenings pursuant to G.S. 108C‑3(g) or (h). The Division may also require a criminal background check of employees involved in direct patient care on behalf of the high categorical risk provider. For purposes of this section:

(1)        A "managing employee" means a general manager, business manager, administrator, director, or other individual who exercises operational or managerial control over, or who directly or indirectly conducts the day‑to‑day operation of an institution, organization, or agency, including the chief financial officer for the organization.

(2)        An "owner and/or operator" means a person or corporation that:

a.         Has an ownership interest totaling five percent (5%) or more in a health care provider;

b.         Has an indirect ownership interest equal to five percent (5%) or more in a health care provider;

c.         Has a combination of direct and indirect ownership interests equal to five percent (5%) or more in a health care provider;

d.         Is an officer or director of a health care provider that is organized as a corporation or limited liability company; or

e.         Is a partner in a health care provider that is organized as a partnership.

(b)        Upon request by the Division, the North Carolina Department of Justice shall provide to the Division a national criminal history for a provider or other person subject to this section. The Division shall provide to the Department of Justice the fingerprints of the covered person to be checked, any additional information required by the Department of Justice, and a form signed by the person to be checked consenting to the check of the criminal record and to the use of fingerprints and other identifying information required by the State or National Repositories. The fingerprints of the individual shall be forwarded to the State Bureau of Investigation for a search of the State criminal history record file, and the State Bureau of Investigation shall forward a set of fingerprints to the Federal Bureau of Investigation for a national criminal history record check. The Division shall keep all information pursuant to this section confidential. The Department of Justice shall charge a reasonable fee for conducting the checks of the criminal history records authorized by this section. A provider or applicant shall reimburse the Department for the cost of capturing fingerprints pursuant to this Chapter.

(c)        All releases of criminal history information under this section shall be subject to, and in compliance with, rules governing the dissemination of criminal history record checks as adopted by the North Carolina Division of Criminal Information. All of the information received through the checking of the criminal history is privileged information and for the exclusive use of the Division.

(d)        The Division shall deny enrollment or terminate the enrollment of a provider where any person with a five percent (5%) or greater direct or indirect ownership interest in the provider has been convicted of any criminal offense related to that person's involvement with the Medicare, Medicaid, or Health Choice program in the last 10 years, unless the Division determines that denial or termination of enrollment is not in the best interests of the Medicaid program and the State Medicaid agency documents that determination in writing.

(e)        The Division may deny enrollment or terminate the enrollment of a provider subject to G.S. 108C‑3(e) if it is determined that the applicant, provider, or owner, operator, or employee of the provider or applicant has been convicted of any of the following offenses, if, after review of the seriousness, age, and other circumstances involving the offense, the Division determines it is in the best interest of the integrity of the Medicaid program or Health Choice program to do so: any criminal offenses as set forth in any of the following Articles of Chapter 14 of the General Statutes; Article 5, Counterfeiting and Issuing Monetary Substitutes; Article 5A, Endangering Executive and Legislative Officers; Article 6, Homicide; Article 7A, Rape and Other Sex Offenses; Article 8, Assaults; Article 10, Kidnapping and Abduction; Article 13, Malicious Injury or Damage by Use of Explosive or Incendiary Device or Material; Article 14, Burglary and Other Housebreakings; Article 15, Arson and Other Burnings; Article 16, Larceny; Article 17, Robbery; Article 18, Embezzlement; Article 19, False Pretenses and Cheats; Article 19A, Obtaining Property or Services by False or Fraudulent Use of Credit Device or Other Means; Article 19B, Financial Transaction Card Crime Act; Article 20, Frauds; Article 21, Forgery; Article 26, Offenses Against Public Morality and Decency; Article 26A, Adult Establishments; Article 27, Prostitution; Article 28, Perjury; Article 29, Bribery; Article 31, Misconduct in Public Office; Article 35, Offenses Against the Public Peace; Article 36A, Riots and Civil Disorders; Article 39, Protection of Minors; Article 40, Protection of the Family; Article 59, Public Intoxication; and Article 60, Computer‑Related Crime. The crimes also include possession or sale of drugs in violation of the North Carolina Controlled Substances Act, Article 5 of Chapter 90 of the General Statutes, and alcohol‑related offenses such as sale to underage persons in violation of G.S. 18B‑302, or driving while impaired in violation of G.S. 20‑138.1 through G.S. 20‑138.5.

"§ 108C‑4.  Payment suspension.

(a)        In addition to the procedures for suspending payment set forth in 42 C.F.R. § 455.23, the Department shall also suspend payment to any North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice provider which:

(1)        Owes an outstanding overpayment, assessment, fine or other accounts receivable to the Department; or

(2)        Has had its participation in the North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice programs suspended or terminated by the Division of Medical Assistance.

(b)        For providers who owe an outstanding overpayment, assessment, or other accounts receivable to the Department, the suspension of payment shall not exceed the amount owed to the Department, including any applicable penalty and interest charges, and shall continue during the pendency of any appeal filed at the Office of Administrative Hearings or State or federal courts.

(c)        Providers whose participation in the North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice programs has been suspended or terminated shall have all payments suspended beginning on the 31st day after the notice of suspension or termination is mailed by the Department to the provider's last known address on file with the Division, and the suspension of payment shall continue during the pendency of any appeal filed at the Office of Administrative Hearings or State or federal courts. The notice to the provider of the overpayment, assessment, other accounts receivable, suspension, or termination shall include notice of the potential payment suspension. The Department is not required to send a separate notice of the payment suspension.

(d)        If the final agency decision is in favor of the provider, or if the provider appeals the final agency decision and the final court decision is in favor of the provider, the Department shall reimburse the provider for payments for all clean claims suspended during the period of appeal.

(e)        The Department shall not make any payment to a North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice provider unless and until all outstanding recoupments, assessments, fines, or overpayments have been repaid in full to the Department, together with any applicable penalty and interest charges, or unless and until the provider has entered into a payment plan approved by the Department not to exceed 24 months. The Department has the sole discretion whether to allow a provider to enter into a payment plan and to set terms and conditions for such plans.

(f)         A recoupment, assessment, fine, or overpayment owed to the Department becomes outstanding on the 31st day after the final notice of such recoupment, assessment, fine, or overpayment is mailed by the Department to the provider's last known address on file with the Division. For purposes of this Chapter, "outstanding" means 31 days after the provider receives notification that the Department has identified an overpayment, fine, or assessment or other accounts receivable owed to the Department, or upon the 31st day after the recoupment, assessment, fine, or overpayment is upheld, in full or in part, by a Department hearing officer following an informal hearing or reconsideration review, regardless of whether the provider has appealed such notification or determination to the Office of Administrative Hearings or any State or federal courts.

(g)        All payments suspended in accordance with this Chapter shall be applied toward any outstanding recoupment, assessment, fine, or overpayment owed to the Department unless the Department is required to remit such payments to the United States Internal Revenue Service in accordance with federal law.

(h)        When issuing payment suspensions in accordance with this Chapter, the Department may suspend payment to all providers which share the same IRS Employee Identification Number or corporate parent as the provider or provider site location which owes the recoupment, fine, assessment, or overpayment.

(i)         If the Office of Administrative Hearings issues a stay of the agency action giving rise to the payment suspension described herein in accordance with G.S. 1A‑1, Rule 65 of the Rules of Civil Procedure, a bond equal to the outstanding amount owed to the Department, or one month of the provider's average annual billing, shall be required, the case shall be placed on an expedited hearing docket and such stay shall only be in effect for a maximum of 30 days from issuance.

(j)         The Office of Administrative Hearings is prohibited from issuing a stay of a payment suspension implemented in accordance with 42 C.F.R. § 455.23.

"§ 108C‑5.  Agents, clearinghouses, and alternate payees; registration required.

The Department is authorized to establish a registry of billing agents, clearinghouses, and/or alternate payees that submit claims on behalf of health care providers and to charge a reasonable fee to cover the costs of creating the registry in accordance with the Affordable Care Act and implementing regulations. All billing agents, clearinghouses, or alternate payees shall register with the Department within six months of the enactment of this Chapter before submitting claims on behalf of health care providers. Any billing agent, clearinghouse, or alternate payee that fails to register with the Department prior to submitting claims on behalf of health care providers shall be excluded from the registry for a period not to exceed one year.

"§ 108C‑6.  Prepayment claims review.

(a)        In order to ensure that all claims presented by a provider for payment by the Department meet the Department's medical necessity criteria and all other Medicaid, Health Choice, or other federal or State documentation requirements, a provider may be required to undergo prepayment claims review by the Department. Grounds for being placed on prepayment claims review include, but shall not be limited to, receipt by the Department of allegations of fraud, waste, or abuse and identification of aberrant billing practices as a result of investigations or data analysis performed by the Division, its contractors, and agents.

(b)        Providers are not entitled to payment prior to claims review by the Department. The Department or its applicable contractor is required to notify the provider in writing of the decision and the process for submitting claims for prepayment claims review within no less than fourteen calendar days prior to instituting prepayment claims review, and the notice shall contain the following:

(1)        An explanation of the Department's decision to place the provider on prepayment claims review.

(2)        A description of the review process and time lines.

(3)        A list of all supporting documentation that the provider will need to submit contemporaneously with the claims that will be subject to the prepayment claims review.

(4)        The process for submitting claims and supporting documentation.

(c)        The Department or its applicable contractor is required to process all claims submitted for prepayment review within 30 calendar days of submission by the provider. If the Department or its applicable contractor need additional information to process a claim pursuant to this section, a request for additional information must be sent to the provider in writing within 15 calendar days of receipt of such claim, and the provider shall have 15 calendar days to provide additional information. The Department or its applicable contractor shall have an additional 30 days to process a claim after receipt of additional information. If the provider fails to submit additional information for review, the claim may be denied.

(d)        The provider's claims shall remain subject to the prepayment claims review process until the provider achieves three consecutive months with a minimum seventy percent (70%) clean claims rate. A provider shall not withhold claims to avoid the claims review process. If the provider does not meet this standard within six months of being placed on prepayment claims review, the Department may implement sanctions, including termination of the applicable Medicaid Administrative Participation Agreement, or continuation of prepayment review for an additional six‑month period. In no instance shall prepayment claims review continue longer than 12 months.

(e)        The decision to place a provider on prepayment review does not give rise to a contested case appealable under Chapter 150B of the General Statutes. A provider may not appeal or otherwise contest a decision of the Department to place a provider on prepayment review. A determination by the Department that the provider did not satisfy the threshold set forth in subsection (d) of this section is an adverse determination, and the provider is entitled to appeal such a determination. The provider maintains its right to appeal the denial of any claims subject to prepayment claims review by the Department in accordance with procedures set forth by the Department and its fiscal agent.

(f)         Nothing in this section shall prevent the Department from engaging in random prepayment claims review or otherwise reviewing or auditing providers' claims before payment.

(g)        The Office of Administrative Hearings is prohibited from issuing a stay of the Department's decision to place a provider on prepayment review.

"§ 108C‑7.  Threshold recovery amount.

The Department shall not pursue recovery of Medicaid or Health Choice overpayments owed to the State for any total amount less than one hundred fifty dollars ($150.00) unless directed to do so by the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services or unless such recovery would be cost‑effective and in the best interest of the State of North Carolina and Medicaid recipients.

"§ 108C‑8.  Cooperation with investigations and audits.

(a)        Providers must permit all announced and unannounced site visits, audits, investigations, postpayment reviews, or other program integrity activities conducted by licensing agencies, regulatory boards, the Department, its Divisions, or its contractors, vendors, or authorized agents. Providers who fail to grant prompt and reasonable access or who fail to timely provide documentation to licensing agencies, regulatory boards, the Department, its Divisions, or its contractors, vendors, or authorized agents shall be subject to a five hundred dollar ($500.00) per day fine and may be terminated from the North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice programs.

(b)        The Department shall establish deadlines of no less than 24 hours for providers to submit documentation in response to announced and unannounced site visits, audits, investigations, postpayment reviews, or other program integrity activities. Once the provider has been notified in writing of the findings, including, but not limited to, any overpayment determination, resulting from any announced or unannounced site visit, audit, investigation, postpayment review, or other program integrity action, the provider shall have no more than 30 business days in which to submit additional documentation to the Department or longer if the provider can show good cause. There shall be no additional opportunities in which to submit further documentation for review by the Department in relation to the specific audit, investigation, or postpayment review findings. This section does not apply to criminal investigations conducted by the Medicaid Investigations Unit of the Attorney General's Office.

(c)        Nothing in this Chapter shall be construed to limit the ability of the federal government, the Centers for Medicare and Medicaid Services, the U.S. Department of Health and Human Services Office of Inspector General, the U.S. Department of Justice, or any of the foregoing entities' contractors or agents, to enforce federal requirements for the submission of documentation in response to an audit or investigation.

"§ 108C‑9.  Collaboration among agencies to ensure effective investigation, monitoring, and prosecution of Medicaid fraud and abuse.

(a)        All State regulatory agencies, licensing boards, and accrediting bodies that are involved in the monitoring, investigation, licensure, or prosecution of health care providers are directed to meet on a regular basis, but no more often than quarterly, to facilitate early identification of payment error trends, to review procedures for incident reporting and response, and to identify system challenges and inconsistencies with the goal of improving operational performance of the North Carolina Medicaid and North Carolina Health Choice programs at the State and provider level.

(b)        Meetings shall consist of a closed session and an open session:

(1)        Closed session:  Licensing boards, law enforcement, and State regulatory agencies will share information, to the extent they are authorized or permitted under federal and State law, regarding actions taken against health care providers, and will develop strategies and procedures for responding to fraud, abuse, neglect, exploitation, and quality of care issues.

(2)        Open session:  Stakeholders, provider representatives, and other health care professionals, including health insurers and pharmacy benefit managers, will be invited to participate.

(c)        The Department shall establish and announce the meetings' schedule, and meetings shall be chaired by the State Medicaid Director or his or her designee.

"§ 108C‑10.  Provider enrollment criteria.

(a)        Providers who submit an initial application for enrollment in North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice, including applications for a new practice or site location, shall be required to submit an attestation and complete required trainings prior to being enrolled. Currently enrolled providers shall be required to submit an attestation and complete required trainings within six months of the enactment of this Chapter.

(b)        The attestation shall contain a statement that the applicant has the minimum business requirements necessary to comply with all federal and State requirements governing the Medicaid and Children's Health Insurance programs, does not owe any outstanding taxes or fines to the U.S. or North Carolina Departments of Revenue or Labor or the Employment Security Commission, does not owe any overpayment, assessment, or fine to the North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice programs or any other State Medicaid or Children's Health Insurance program, and has implemented a corporate compliance program as required under federal law.

(c)        A provider representative shall be required to attend trainings on at least the following topics prior to the provider being enrolled in the North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice programs:

(1)        Basic Medicaid 101, including the Basic Medicaid Billing Guide, audit procedures, common billing errors and how to avoid them;

(2)        How to identify Medicaid recipient fraud;

(3)        How to report suspected fraud or abuse; and

(4)        Medicaid recipient due process and appeal rights.

Online training shall be available for completion through the Department's Web site. The Department may charge a fee for such training as necessary to control costs.

(d)        Making any false or misleading statement in an attestation or enrollment application shall be grounds for denial or termination of, or permanent exclusion from, enrollment in the North Carolina Medicaid or North Carolina Health Choice programs.

"§ 108C‑11.  Change of ownership and successor liability.

(a)        For purposes of health care providers subject to this Chapter, any of the following occurrences shall constitute a change of ownership:

(1)        Partnership. – In the case of a partnership, the removal, addition, or substitution of a partner, unless the partners expressly agree otherwise, as permitted by Chapter 59 of the General Statutes, constitutes change of ownership.

(2)        Limited liability company. – In the case of an LLC, the withdrawal or removal of a member, or when a person acquires a membership interest from the LLC or when a business entity converts or merges into the LLC pursuant to Chapter 57A of the General Statutes, constitutes change of ownership.

(3)        Unincorporated sole proprietorship. – Transfer of title and property to another party constitutes change of ownership.

(4)        Corporation. – The merger of the provider corporation into another corporation, or the consolidation of two or more corporations, resulting in the creation of a new corporation constitutes change of ownership. Transfer of corporate stock or the merger of another corporation into the provider corporation does not constitute change of ownership.

(5)        Leasing. – The lease of all or part of a provider facility constitutes change of ownership of the leased portion. The provider agreement will be assigned to the lessee only to the extent of the leased portion of the facility.

(b)        Notice to the Department. – A provider must notify the Department at least 30 days prior to the effective date of any change of ownership and provide a copy of the document(s) which the provider purports to constitute the sale or lease agreement between the parties.

(c)        Assignment of Agreement. – When there is a change of ownership as specified in subsection (a) of this section, the existing provider agreement will automatically be assigned to the new owner.

(d)        Conditions That Apply to Assigned Agreements. – An assigned agreement is subject to all applicable statutes and regulations and to the terms and conditions under which it was originally issued including, but not limited to, the following:

(1)        Any existing plan of correction.

(2)        Compliance with applicable health and safety standards.

(3)        Assumption of any liability associated with the agreement.

(4)        Payment of any outstanding debts, recoupments, overpayments, assessments, taxes, or other accounts receivables owed to the Department or the State of North Carolina arising from the agreement.

(e)        If the purchaser or lessee elects not to accept a transfer of the provider agreement, then the old agreement should be terminated, and the purchaser or lessee is considered a new applicant. The Department may deny the application based on any outstanding debts, recoupments, overpayments, assessments, taxes, or other accounts receivables owed to the Department or the State of North Carolina arising from the previous agreement."

SECTION 10.50.(b)  The Division, in consultation with stakeholder groups and the North Carolina Department of Justice, may study the status of criminal and other employment background checks among all providers and health care licensing boards and may make recommendations to the 2012 Regular Session of the 2011 General Assembly concerning the use of background checks with respect to participation in the Medicaid and Health Choice programs.

SECTION 10.50.(c)  G.S. 108A‑54.2 reads as rewritten:

"§ 108A‑54.2.  Procedures for changing medical policy.medical or clinical coverage policy.

(a)        The Department shall develop, amend, and adopt medical or clinical coverage policy in accordance with the following:this section.

(b)        Medical and clinical coverage policy is defined as those policies, definitions, or guidelines utilized to evaluate the health conditions of a recipient so as to determine eligibility, authorization, or continued authorization for a covered procedure, product, or service and to establish requirements for how a covered procedure, product, or service shall be delivered by a provider, including, but not limited to, service records requirements.

(c)        The Department shall:

(1)        During the development of new medical or clinical coverage policy or amendment to existing medical coverage policy, consult with and seek the advice of the Physician Advisory Group and other organizations the Secretary deems appropriate. The Secretary shall also consult with and seek the advice of officials of the professional societies or associations representing providers who are affected by the new medical or clinical coverage policy or amendments to existing medical or clinical coverage policy.

(2)        At least 45 days prior to the adoption of new or amended medical or clinical coverage policy, the Department shall:

a.         Publish the proposed new or amended medical or clinical coverage policy on the Department's Web site;

b.         Notify all Medicaid providers of the proposed, new, or amended policy; and

c.         Upon request, provide persons copies of the proposed medical or clinical coverage policy.

(3)        During the 45‑day period immediately following publication of the proposed new or amended medical or clinical coverage policy, accept oral and written comments on the proposed new or amended policy.

(4)        If, following the comment period, the proposed new or amended medical or clinical coverage policy is modified, then the Department shall, at least 15 days prior to its adoption:

a.         Notify all Medicaid providers of the proposed policy;

b.         Upon request, provide persons notice of amendments to the proposed policy; and

c.         Accept additional oral or written comments during this 15‑day period."

SECTION 10.50.(d)  G.S. 150B‑1 reads as rewritten:

"§ 150B‑1.  Policy and scope.

(a)        Purpose. – This Chapter establishes a uniform system of administrative rule making and adjudicatory procedures for agencies. The procedures ensure that the functions of rule making, investigation, advocacy, and adjudication are not all performed by the same person in the administrative process.

(b)        Rights. – This Chapter confers procedural rights.

(c)        Full Exemptions. – This Chapter applies to every agency except:

(1)        The North Carolina National Guard in exercising its court‑martial jurisdiction.

(2)        The Department of Health and Human Services in exercising its authority over the Camp Butner reservation granted in Article 6 of Chapter 122C of the General Statutes.

(3)        The Utilities Commission.

(4)        The Industrial Commission.

(5)        The Employment Security Commission.

(6)        The State Board of Elections in administering the HAVA Administrative Complaint Procedure of Article 8A of Chapter 163 of the General Statutes.

(7)        The North Carolina State Lottery.

(8)        (Expires June 30, 2012) Except as provided in G.S. 150B‑21.1B, any agency with respect to contracts, disputes, protests, and/or claims arising out of or relating to the implementation of the American Recovery and Reinvestment Act of 2009 (Public Law 111‑5).

(d)        Exemptions from Rule Making. – Article 2A of this Chapter does not apply to the following:

(1)        The Commission.

(2)        Repealed by Session Laws 2000‑189, s. 14, effective July 1, 2000.

(3)        Repealed by Session Laws 2001‑474, s. 34, effective November 29, 2001.

(4)        The Department of Revenue, with respect to the notice and hearing requirements contained in Part 2 of Article 2A.

(5)        The North Carolina Global TransPark Authority with respect to the acquisition, construction, operation, or use, including fees or charges, of any portion of a cargo airport complex.

(6)        The Department of Correction, with respect to matters relating solely to persons in its custody or under its supervision, including prisoners, probationers, and parolees.

(7)        The State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees in administering the provisions of Article 3A of Chapter 135 of the General Statutes.

(8)        The North Carolina Federal Tax Reform Allocation Committee, with respect to the adoption of the annual qualified allocation plan required by 26 U.S.C. § 42(m), and any agency designated by the Committee to the extent necessary to administer the annual qualified allocation plan.

(9)        The Department of Health and Human Services in adopting new or amending existing medical coverage policies under the State Medicaid Program.Program pursuant to G.S. 108A‑54.2.

(10)      The Economic Investment Committee in developing criteria for the Job Development Investment Grant Program under Part 2F of Article 10 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes.

(11)      The North Carolina State Ports Authority with respect to fees established pursuant to G.S. 143B‑454(a)(11).

(12)      The Department of Commerce and the Economic Investment Committee in developing criteria and administering the Site Infrastructure Development Program under G.S. 143B‑437.02.

(13)      The Department of Commerce and the Governor's Office in developing guidelines for the One North Carolina Fund under Part 2H of Article 10 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes.

(14)      The Community Colleges System Office in developing guidelines for the Community College Facilities and Equipment Fund.

(15)      Repealed by Session Laws 2009‑445, s. 41(b), effective August 7, 2009.

(16)      The State Ethics Commission with respect to Chapter 138A and Chapter 120C of the General Statutes.

(17)      The Department of Commerce in developing guidelines for the NC Green Business Fund under Part 2B of Article 10 of Chapter 143B of the General Statutes.

(18)      The Department of Commerce and the Economic Investment Committee in developing criteria and administering the Job Maintenance and Capital Development Fund under G.S. 143B‑437.012.

(19)      The Community Colleges System Office in developing criteria and guidelines administering the Customized Training Program under G.S. 115D‑5.1.

(e)        Exemptions From Contested Case Provisions. – The contested case provisions of this Chapter apply to all agencies and all proceedings not expressly exempted from the Chapter. The contested case provisions of this Chapter do not apply to the following:

(1)        The Department of Health and Human Services and the Department of Environment and Natural Resources in complying with the procedural safeguards mandated by Section 680 of Part H of Public Law 99‑457 as amended (Education of the Handicapped Act Amendments of 1986).

(2)        Repealed by Session Laws 1993, c. 501, s. 29.

(3),       (4) Repealed by Session Laws 2001‑474, s. 35, effective November 29, 2001.

(5)        Hearings required pursuant to the Rehabilitation Act of 1973, (Public Law 93‑122), as amended and federal regulations promulgated thereunder. G.S. 150B‑51(a) is considered a contested case hearing provision that does not apply to these hearings.

(6)        Repealed by Session Laws 2007‑491, s. 2, effective January 1, 2008.

(7)        The Department of Correction.

(8)        The Department of Transportation, except as provided in G.S. 136‑29.

(9)        The North Carolina Occupational Safety and Health Review Commission.

(10)      The North Carolina Global TransPark Authority with respect to the acquisition, construction, operation, or use, including fees or charges, of any portion of a cargo airport complex.

(11)      Hearings that are provided by the Department of Health and Human Services regarding the eligibility and provision of services for eligible assaultive and violent children, as defined in G.S. 122C‑3(13a), shall be conducted pursuant to the provisions outlined in G.S. 122C, Article 4, Part 7.

(12)      The State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees respect to disputes involving the performance, terms, or conditions of a contract between the Plan and an entity under contract with the Plan.

(13)      The State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees with respect to determinations by the Executive Administrator and Board of Trustees, the Plan's designated utilization review organization, or a self‑funded health maintenance organization under contract with the Plan that an admission, availability of care, continued stay, or other health care service has been reviewed and, based upon the information provided, does not meet the Plan's requirements for medical necessity, appropriateness, health care setting, or level of care or effectiveness, and the requested service is therefore denied, reduced, or terminated.

(14)      The Department of Crime Control and Public Safety for hearings and appeals authorized under Chapter 20 of the General Statutes.

(15)      The Wildlife Resources Commission with respect to determinations of whether to authorize or terminate the authority of a person to sell licenses and permits as a license agent of the Wildlife Resources Commission.

(16)      The Department of Health and Human Services with respect to contested cases commenced by (i) Medicaid providers appealing a denial or reduction in reimbursement for community support services, and (ii) community support services providers appealing decisions by the LME to deny or withdraw the provider's endorsement.

(17)      The Department of Health and Human Services with respect to the review of North Carolina Health Choice Program determinations regarding delay, denial, reduction, suspension, or termination of health services, in whole or in part, including a determination about the type or level of services.

(f)         Exemption for the University of North Carolina. – Except as provided in G.S. 143‑135.3, no Article in this Chapter except Article 4 applies to The University of North Carolina."

SECTION 10.50.(e)  G.S. 150B‑34 reads as rewritten:

"§ 150B‑34.  Decision of administrative law judge.

(a)        Except as provided in G.S. 150B‑36(c), and subsection (c) of this section, in each contested case the administrative law judge shall make a decision that contains findings of fact and conclusions of law and return the decision to the agency for a final decision in accordance with G.S. 150B‑36. The administrative law judge shall decide the case based upon the preponderance of the evidence, giving due regard to the demonstrated knowledge and expertise of the agency with respect to facts and inferences within the specialized knowledge of the agency. All references in this Chapter to the administrative law judge's decision shall include orders entered pursuant to G.S. 150B‑36(c).

(b)        Repealed by Session Laws 1991, c. 35, s. 6.

(c)(c1)  Notwithstanding subsection (a) of this section, in cases arising under Article 9 of Chapter 131E of the General Statutes, the administrative law judge shall make a recommended decision or order that contains findings of fact and conclusions of law. A final decision shall be made by the agency in writing after review of the official record as defined in G.S. 150B‑37(a) and shall include findings of fact and conclusions of law. The final agency decision shall recite and address all of the facts set forth in the recommended decision. For each finding of fact in the recommended decision not adopted by the agency, the agency shall state the specific reason, based on the evidence, for not adopting the findings of fact and the agency's findings shall be supported by substantial evidence admissible under G.S. 150B‑29(a), 150B‑30, or 150B‑31. The provisions of G.S. 150B‑36(b), (b1), (b2), (b3), and (d), and G.S. 150B‑51 do not apply to cases decided under this subsection.

(c2)      Notwithstanding subsection (a) of this section, in all cases arising from decisions made by the North Carolina Department of Health and Human Services in its capacity as the Medicaid single State agency as set forth in Subpart A of Part 431 of Title 42 of the Code of Federal Regulations, the administrative law judge shall make a recommended decision or order that contains findings of fact and conclusions of law. A final decision shall be made by the agency in writing after review of the official record as defined in G.S. 150B‑37(a) and shall include findings of fact and conclusions of law. The provisions of G.S. 150B‑36(b), (b1), (b2), (b3), and (d), and G.S. 150B‑51(a), (b), (c), and (d) do not apply to cases decided under this subsection.

(d)        Except for the exemptions contained in G.S. 150B‑1(c) and (e), and subsection (c) of this section, the provisions of this section regarding the decision of the administrative law judge shall apply only to agencies subject to Article 3 of this Chapter, notwithstanding any other provisions to the contrary relating to recommended decisions by administrative law judges."

SECTION 10.50.(f)  G.S. 150B‑51 is amended to add a new subsection to read:

"(e)       In reviewing a final decision in a contested case in which an administrative law judge made a recommended decision in accordance with G.S. 150B‑34(c2), the superior court shall examine all the record evidence to determine whether there is substantial evidence to justify the final agency decision."

SECTION 10.50.(g)  This section is effective when it becomes law.

 

DHHS BLOCK GRANTS

SECTION 10.51.(a)  Appropriations from federal block grant funds are made for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2012, according to the following schedule:

 

TEMPORARY ASSISTANCE TO NEEDY FAMILIES

(TANF) FUNDS

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Social Services

 

01.       Work First Family Assistance                                                            $ 80,840,356

 

02.       Work First County Block Grants                                                          94,453,315

 

03.       Work First Electing Counties                                                                  2,378,213

 

04.       Adoption Services – Special Children's Adoption Fund                           3,609,355

 

05.       Family Violence Prevention                                                                     2,200,000

 

06.       Child Protective Services – Child Welfare

            Workers for Local DSS                                                                        14,452,391

 

07.       Child Welfare Collaborative                                                                    1,129,115

 

Division of Child Development

 

08.       Subsidized Child Care Program                                                            61,087,077

 

Division of Public Health

 

09.       Teen Pregnancy Initiatives                                                                          450,000

 

Department of Public Instruction

 

10.       More at Four                                                                                          6,352,644

           

DHHS Administration

 

11.       Division of Social Services                                                                      1,093,176

 

12.       Office of the Secretary                                                                                 75,392

 

Transfers to Other Block Grants

 

Division of Child Development

 

13.       Transfer to the Child Care and Development Fund                                82,210,675

 

14.       Transfer to Social Services Block Grant for Child

            Protective Services – Child Welfare Training in

            Counties                                                                                                 1,300,000

 

15.       Transfer to Social Services Block Grant for

            Foster Care Services                                                                                 650,829

 

16.       Transfer to Social Services Block Grant for Child

            Protective Services                                                                                 5,040,000

 

17.       Transfer to Social Services Block Grant for Adult

            Protective Services                                                                                 1,191,925

 

TOTAL TEMPORARY ASSISTANCE TO NEEDY FAMILIES

(TANF) FUNDS                                                                                               $358,514,463

 

TEMPORARY ASSISTANCE TO NEEDY FAMILIES (TANF)

EMERGENCY CONTINGENCY FUNDS RECEIVED THROUGH

THE AMERICAN RECOVERY AND REINVESTMENT ACT (ARRA)

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Social Services

 

01.       NC FAST                                                                                           $ 1,664,936

 

02.       Work First – Boys and Girls Clubs                                                         2,500,000

 

03.       Maternity Homes                                                                                       943,002

 

Division of Public Health

 

04.       Teen Pregnancy Initiatives                                                                       3,889,084

 

TOTAL TEMPORARY ASSISTANCE TO NEEDY FAMILIES (TANF)

EMERGENCY CONTINGENCY FUNDS RECEIVED THROUGH THE

AMERICAN RECOVERY AND REINVESTMENT ACT (ARRA)                     $8,997,022

 

SOCIAL SERVICES BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Divisions of Social Services and Aging and Adult Services

 

01.       County Departments of Social Services                                              $ 30,710,585

 

02.       Child Protective Services (Transfer from TANF)                                     5,040,000

 

03.       Adult Protective Services (Transfer from TANF)                                     1,191,925

 

04.       State In‑Home Services Fund                                                                 2,101,113

 

05.       State Adult Day Care Fund                                                                     2,155,301

 

06.       Child Protective Services/CPS Investigative

            Services‑Child Medical Evaluation Program                                               609,455

 

07.       Foster Care Services                                                                              2,147,967

            (Transfer from TANF $650,829)

 

08.       Special Children Adoption Incentive Fund                                                  500,000

 

09.       Child Protective Services‑Child Welfare Training

            for Counties (Transfer from TANF)                                                        1,300,000

 

10.       Home and Community Care Block Grant (HCCBG)                               1,834,077

 

Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance

Abuse Services

 

11.       Mental Health Services Program                                                                422,003

 

12.       Developmental Disabilities Services Program                                           5,000,000

 

13.       Mental Health Services‑Adult and

            Child/Developmental Disabilities Program/

            Substance Abuse Services‑Adult                                                            3,234,601

 

Division of Vocational Rehabilitation

 

14.       Vocational Rehabilitation Services – Easter Seal Society/UCP

            Community Health Program                                                                       188,263

 

DHHS Program Expenditures

 

Division of Aging and Adult Services

 

15.       UNC‑CARES Training Contract                                                               247,920

 

Division of Services for the Blind

 

16.       Independent Living Program                                                                   3,633,077

 

Division of Health Service Regulation

 

17.       Adult Care Licensure Program                                                                   411,897

 

18.       Mental Health Licensure and Certification Program                                     205,668

 

DHHS Administration

 

19.       Division of Aging and Adult Services                                                          688,436

 

20.       Division of Social Services                                                                         892,624

 

21.       Office of the Secretary/Controller's Office                                                  138,058

 

22.       Office of the Secretary/DIRM                                                                      87,483

 

23.       Division of Child Development                                                                     15,000

 

24.       Division of Mental Health, Developmental

            Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services                                                   29,665

 

25.       Division of Health Service Regulation                                                         235,625

 

26.       Office of the Secretary‑NC Interagency Council

            for Coordinating Homeless Programs                                                         250,000

 

27.       Office of the Secretary                                                                                 48,053

 

Transfers to Other State Agencies

 

Department of Administration

 

28.       NC Commission of Indian Affairs In‑Home

            Services for the Elderly                                                                              203,198

 

Transfers to Other Block Grants

 

Division of Public Health

 

29.       Transfer to Preventive Health Services Block Grant

            for HIV/STD Prevention and Community Planning                                      145,819

 

TOTAL SOCIAL SERVICES BLOCK GRANT                                               $ 63,667,813

 

LOW‑INCOME HOME ENERGY ASSISTANCE BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Social Services

 

01.       Low‑Income Energy Assistance Program (LIEAP)                             $ 41,516,978

 

02.       Crisis Intervention Program (CIP)                                                         18,905,645

 

DHHS Program Expenditures

 

Central Management

 

03.       NC FAST Implementation                                                                      4,732,667

 

Local Administration

 

Division of Social Services

 

04.       County DSS Administration                                                                    5,296,962

 

DHHS Administration

 

05.       Division of Social Services                                                                         307,987

 

06.       Division of Mental Health, Developmental

            Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services                                                     9,218

 

07.       Office of the Secretary/DIRM                                                                    276,784

 

08.       Office of the Secretary/Controller's Office                                                    12,332

 

Transfers to Other State Agencies

 

Department of Commerce

 

09.       Weatherization Program                                                                             500,000

 

10.       Heating Air Repair and Replacement

            Program (HARRP)                                                                                 4,744,344

 

11.       Local Residential Energy Efficiency Service

            Providers – Weatherization                                                                          25,000

 

12.       Local Residential Energy Efficiency Service

            Providers – HARRP                                                                                  227,038

 

13.       Department of Commerce Administration –

            Weatherization                                                                                             25,000

 

14.       Department of Commerce Administration –

            HARRP                                                                                                    227,038

 

15.       Department of Administration

 

N.C. State Commission of Indian Affairs                                                                110,638

 

TOTAL LOW‑INCOME HOME ENERGY ASSISTANCE

BLOCK GRANT                                                                                               $ 76,917,631

 

CHILD CARE AND DEVELOPMENT FUND BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Child Development

 

01.       Subsidized Child Care Services (CCDF)                                           $154,459,810

 

02.       Electronic Tracking System                                                                     3,336,345

 

03.       Subsidized Child Care Services

            (Transfer from TANF)                                                                          82,210,675

 

04.       Quality and Availability Initiatives                                                          25,948,434

 

Division of Social Services

 

05.       Local Subsidized Child Care Services Support                                      13,546,397

 

DHHS Administration

 

Division of Child Development

 

06.       DCD Administrative Expenses                                                                6,539,277

 

Division of Central Administration

 

07.       DHHS Central Administration – DIRM

            Technical Services                                                                                     774,317

 

TOTAL CHILD CARE AND DEVELOPMENT FUND

BLOCK GRANT                                                                                           $   286,815,255

 

MENTAL HEALTH SERVICES BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

01.       Mental Health Services – Adult                                                      $       6,656,212

 

02.       Mental Health Services – Child                                                               5,121,991

 

03.       Administration                                                                                           100,000

 

TOTAL MENTAL HEALTH SERVICES BLOCK GRANT                              $ 11,878,203

 

SUBSTANCE ABUSE PREVENTION AND TREATMENT BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services

 

01.       Substance Abuse Services – Adult                                                     $ 20,008,541

 

02.       Substance Abuse Treatment Alternative for Women                                8,107,303

 

03.       Substance Abuse – HIV and IV Drug                                                     5,116,378

 

04.       Substance Abuse Prevention – Child                                                       7,186,857

 

05.       Substance Abuse Services – Child                                                          4,940,500

 

06.       Institute of Medicine                                                                                  250,000

 

07.       Administration                                                                                           250,000

 

Division of Public Health

 

08.       Risk Reduction Projects                                                                             633,980

 

09.       Aid‑to‑Counties                                                                                        209,576

 

TOTAL SUBSTANCE ABUSE PREVENTION

AND TREATMENT BLOCK GRANT                                                              $ 46,703,135

 

MATERNAL AND CHILD HEALTH BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Public Health

 

01.       Children's Health Services                                                                       9,347,015

 

02.       Women's Health                                                                                     7,691,924

 

03.       Oral Health                                                                                                  42,268

 

DHHS Program Expenditures

 

Division of Public Health

 

04.       Children's Health Services                                                                       1,417,087

 

05.       Women's Health                                                                                        136,628

 

06.       State Center for Health Statistics                                                                164,318

 

07.       Quality Improvement in Public Health                                                             1,636

 

08.       Health Promotion                                                                                         89,374

 

09.       Office of Minority Health                                                                             40,141

 

DHHS Administration

 

Division of Public Health

 

10.       Division of Public Health Administration                                                     631,966

 

TOTAL MATERNAL AND CHILD

HEALTH BLOCK GRANT                                                                               $ 19,562,357

 

PREVENTIVE HEALTH SERVICES BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Division of Public Health

 

01.       NC Statewide Health Promotion                                                           $1,730,653

 

02.       Services to Rape Victims                                                                             89,152

 

03.       HIV/STD Prevention and Community Planning

            (Transfer from Social Services Block Grant)                                               145,819

 

DHHS Program Expenditures

 

Division of Public Health

 

04.       State Center for Health Statistics                                                                  55,040

 

05.       NC Statewide Health Promotion                                                                947,056

 

06.       Oral Health                                                                                                  70,000

 

07.       State Laboratory of Public Health                                                                16,600

 

08.       Services to Rape Victims                                                                           107,960

 

TOTAL PREVENTIVE HEALTH SERVICES BLOCK GRANT                         $3,162,280

 

COMMUNITY SERVICES BLOCK GRANT

 

Local Program Expenditures

 

Office of Economic Opportunity

 

01.       Community Action Agencies                                                              $ 18,075,488

 

02.       Limited Purpose Agencies                                                                       1,004,194

 

DHHS Administration

 

03.       Office of Economic Opportunity                                                              1,004,194

 

TOTAL COMMUNITY SERVICES BLOCK GRANT                                     $ 20,083,876

 

GENERAL PROVISIONS

SECTION 10.51.(b)  Information to Be Included in Block Grant Plans. – The Department of Health and Human Services shall submit a separate plan for each Block Grant received and administered by the Department, and each plan shall include the following:

(1)        A delineation of the proposed allocations by program or activity, including State and federal match requirements.

(2)        A delineation of the proposed State and local administrative expenditures.

(3)        An identification of all new positions to be established through the Block Grant, including permanent, temporary, and time‑limited positions.

(4)        A comparison of the proposed allocations by program or activity with two prior years' program and activity budgets and two prior years' actual program or activity expenditures.

(5)        A projection of current year expenditures by program or activity.

(6)        A projection of federal Block Grant funds available, including unspent federal funds from the current and prior fiscal years.

SECTION 10.51.(c)  Changes in Federal Fund Availability. – If the Congress of the United States increases the federal fund availability for any of the Block Grants or contingency funds and other grants related to existing Block Grants administered by the Department of Health and Human Services from the amounts appropriated in this section, the Department shall allocate the increase proportionally across the program and activity appropriations identified for that Block Grant in this section. In allocating an increase in federal fund availability, the Office of State Budget and Management shall not approve funding for new programs or activities not appropriated in this section.

If the Congress of the United States decreases the federal fund availability for any of the Block Grants or contingency funds and other grants related to existing Block Grants administered by the Department of Health and Human Services from the amounts appropriated in this section, the Department shall reduce State administration by at least the percentage of the reduction in federal funds. After determining the State administration, the remaining reductions shall be allocated proportionately across the program and activity appropriations identified for that Block Grant in this section. The Office of State Budget and Management shall report on these changes.

Prior to allocating the change in federal fund availability, the proposed allocation must be approved by the Office of State Budget and Management. If the Department adjusts the allocation of any Block Grant due to changes in federal fund availability, then a report shall be made to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division.

SECTION 10.51.(d)  Appropriations from federal Block Grant funds are made for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2012, according to the schedule enacted for State fiscal year 2011‑2012 or until a new schedule is enacted by the General Assembly.

SECTION 10.51.(e)  All changes to the budgeted allocations to the Block Grants or contingency funds and other grants related to existing Block Grants administered by the Department of Health and Human Services that are not specifically addressed in this section shall be approved by the Office of State Budget and Management, and the Office of State Budget and Management shall consult with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations for review prior to implementing the changes. The report shall include an itemized listing of affected programs, including associated changes in budgeted allocations. All changes to the budgeted allocations to the Block Grants shall be reported immediately to the House of Representatives Appropriations Subcommittee on Health and Human Services, the Senate Appropriations Committee on Health and Human Services, and the Fiscal Research Division. This subsection does not apply to Block Grant changes caused by legislative salary increases and benefit adjustments.

 

TEMPORARY ASSISTANCE FOR NEEDY FAMILIES (TANF) FUNDS

SECTION 10.51.(f)  The sum of one million ninety‑three thousand one hundred seventy‑six dollars ($1,093,176) appropriated in this section in TANF funds to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used to support administration of TANF‑funded programs.

SECTION 10.51.(g)  The sum of two million two hundred thousand dollars ($2,200,000) appropriated under this section in TANF funds to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used to provide domestic violence services to Work First recipients. These funds shall be used to provide domestic violence counseling, support, and other direct services to clients. These funds shall not be used to establish new domestic violence shelters or to facilitate lobbying efforts. The Division of Social Services may use up to seventy‑five thousand dollars ($75,000) in TANF funds to support one administrative position within the Division of Social Services to implement this subsection.

Each county department of social services and the local domestic violence shelter program serving the county shall develop jointly a plan for utilizing these funds. The plan shall include the services to be provided and the manner in which the services shall be delivered. The county plan shall be signed by the county social services director or the director's designee and the domestic violence program director or the director's designee and submitted to the Division of Social Services by December 1, 2011. The Division of Social Services, in consultation with the Council for Women, shall review the county plans and shall provide consultation and technical assistance to the departments of social services and local domestic violence shelter programs, if needed.

The Division of Social Services shall allocate these funds to county departments of social services according to the following formula: (i) each county shall receive a base allocation of five thousand dollars ($5,000) and (ii) each county shall receive an allocation of the remaining funds based on the county's proportion of the statewide total of the Work First caseload as of July 1, 2011, and the county's proportion of the statewide total of the individuals receiving domestic violence services from programs funded by the Council for Women as of July 1, 2011. The Division of Social Services may reallocate unspent funds to counties that submit a written request for additional funds.

SECTION 10.51.(h)  The sum of fourteen million four hundred fifty‑two thousand three hundred ninety‑one dollars ($14,452,391) appropriated in this section to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, in TANF funds for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year for child welfare improvements shall be allocated to the county departments of social services for hiring or contracting staff to investigate and provide services in Child Protective Services cases; to provide foster care and support services; to recruit, train, license, and support prospective foster and adoptive families; and to provide interstate and postadoption services for eligible families.

SECTION 10.51.(i)  The sum of three million six hundred nine thousand three hundred fifty‑five dollars ($3,609,355) appropriated in this section in TANF funds to the Department of Health and Human Services, Special Children Adoption Fund, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used in accordance with G.S. 108A‑50.2, as enacted in Section 10.48 of S.L. 2009‑451. The Division of Social Services, in consultation with the North Carolina Association of County Directors of Social Services and representatives of licensed private adoption agencies, shall develop guidelines for the awarding of funds to licensed public and private adoption agencies upon the adoption of children described in G.S. 108A‑50 and in foster care. Payments received from the Special Children Adoption Fund by participating agencies shall be used exclusively to enhance the adoption services program. No local match shall be required as a condition for receipt of these funds.

SECTION 10.51.(j)  The sum of one million one hundred twenty‑nine thousand one hundred fifteen dollars ($1,129,115) appropriated in this section to the Department of Health and Human Services in TANF funds for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used to continue support for the Child Welfare Collaborative.

 

TEMPORARY ASSISTANCE FOR NEEDY FAMILIES (TANF) EMERGENCY CONTINGENCY FUNDS

SECTION 10.51.(k)  The sum of two million five hundred thousand dollars ($2,500,000) appropriated in this section to the Department in TANF funds for Boys and Girls Clubs for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used to make grants for approved programs. The Department of Health and Human Services, in accordance with federal regulations for the use of TANF Emergency Contingency funds, shall administer a grant program to award funds to the Boys and Girls Clubs across the State in order to implement programs that improve the motivation, performance, and self‑esteem of youths and to implement other initiatives that would be expected to reduce gang participation, school dropout, and teen pregnancy rates. The Department shall facilitate collaboration between the Boys and Girls Clubs and Support Our Students, Communities in Schools, and similar programs and encourage them to submit joint applications for the funds if appropriate.

 

SOCIAL SERVICES BLOCK GRANT

SECTION 10.51.(l)  The sum of one million three hundred thousand dollars ($1,300,000) appropriated in this section in the Social Services Block Grant to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used to support various child welfare training projects as follows:

(1)        Provide a regional training center in southeastern North Carolina.

(2)        Provide training for residential child caring facilities.

(3)        Provide for various other child welfare training initiatives.

SECTION 10.51.(m)  The sum of two million one hundred forty‑seven thousand nine hundred sixty‑seven dollars ($2,147,967) appropriated in this section in the Social Services Block Grant for child caring agencies for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be allocated in support of State foster home children.

SECTION 10.51.(n)  The Department of Health and Human Services is authorized, subject to the approval of the Office of State Budget and Management, to transfer Social Services Block Grant funding allocated for departmental administration between divisions that have received administrative allocations from the Social Services Block Grant.

SECTION 10.51.(o)  Social Services Block Grant funds appropriated for the Special Children's Adoption Incentive Fund will require a fifty percent (50%) local match.

SECTION 10.51.(p)  The sum of four hundred twenty‑two thousand three dollars ($422,003) appropriated in this section in the Social Services Block Grant to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be used to continue a Mental Health Services Program for children.

SECTION 10.51.(q)  The sum of five million forty thousand dollars ($5,040,000) appropriated in this section in the Social Services Block Grant for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be allocated to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Social Services.  The Division shall allocate these funds to local departments of social services to replace the loss of Child Protective Services State funds that are currently used by county government to pay for Child Protective Services staff at the local level. These funds shall be used to maintain the number of Child Protective Services workers throughout the State.  These SSBG funds  shall be used to pay for salaries and related expenses only and are exempt from 10A NCAC 71R .0201(3) requiring a local match of twenty‑five percent (25%).

 

LOW‑INCOME HOME ENERGY ASSISTANCE BLOCK GRANT

SECTION 10.51.(r)  Additional emergency contingency funds received may be allocated for Energy Assistance Payments or Crisis Intervention Payments without prior consultation with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations. Additional funds received shall be reported to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Fiscal Research Division upon notification of the award. The Department of Health and Human Services shall not allocate funds for any activities, including increasing administration, other than assistance payments, without prior consultation with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations.

 

CHILD CARE AND DEVELOPMENT FUND BLOCK GRANT

SECTION 10.51.(s)  Payment for subsidized child care services provided with federal TANF funds shall comply with all regulations and policies issued by the Division of Child Development for the subsidized child care program.

SECTION 10.51.(t)  If funds appropriated through the Child Care and Development Fund Block Grant for any program cannot be obligated or spent in that program within the obligation or liquidation periods allowed by the federal grants, the Department may move funds to child care subsidies, unless otherwise prohibited by federal requirements of the grant, in order to use the federal funds fully.

 

SUBSTANCE ABUSE PREVENTION AND TREATMENT BLOCK GRANT

SECTION 10.51.(u)  The sum of two hundred fifty thousand dollars ($250,000) appropriated in this section in the Substance Abuse Prevention and Treatment Block Grant to the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Mental Health, Developmental Disabilities, and Substance Abuse Services, for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year for the North Carolina Institute of Medicine (NCIOM) shall be used to continue its Task Force on the mental health, social, and emotional needs of young children and their families. In addition to the issues identified in Section 16.1 of S.L. 2010‑152, the Task Force shall study the impact of parents' substance use problems on the mental health and social and emotional well‑being of children from conception through age five. The NCIOM shall make an interim report to the General Assembly no later than January 15, 2012, which may include legislative and other recommendations, and shall issue its final report with findings, recommendations, and any proposed legislation to the 2013 General Assembly upon its convening.

 

MATERNAL AND CHILD HEALTH BLOCK GRANT

SECTION 10.51.(v)  If federal funds are received under the Maternal and Child Health Block Grant for abstinence education, pursuant to section 912 of Public Law 104‑193 (42 U.S.C. § 710), for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, then those funds shall be transferred to the State Board of Education to be administered by the Department of Public Instruction. The Department of Public Instruction shall use the funds to establish an abstinence until marriage education program and shall delegate to one or more persons the responsibility of implementing the program and G.S. 115C‑81(e1)(4) and (4a). The Department of Public Instruction shall carefully and strictly follow federal guidelines in implementing and administering the abstinence education grant funds.

SECTION 10.51.(w)  The Department of Health and Human Services shall ensure that there will be follow‑up testing in the Newborn Screening Program.

 

PART XI. Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services

 

TRANSFER FARMLAND PRESERVATION TRUST FUND

SECTION 11.1.(a)  The North Carolina Agricultural Development and Farmland Preservation Trust Fund, a program that supports the purchase of agricultural conservation easements and promotes the development and sustainability of farming and assists in the transition of existing farms to new farm families, is transferred from the Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services to the Division of Soil and Water Conservation of the Department of Environment and Natural Resources. This transfer has all the elements of a Type I transfer as defined in G.S. 143A‑6.

SECTION 11.1.(b)  The Department of Environment and Natural Resources shall delegate to the Agricultural Advancement Consortium of the North Carolina Rural Economic Development Center the responsibility of implementing the public and private enterprise programs that promote profitable and sustainable family farms as defined in G.S. 106‑744(c)(2).

 

TRANSFER THE RESEARCH STATIONs DIVISION TO NORTH CAROLINA LAND GRANT UNIVERSITY

SECTION 11.2.(a)  The Research Stations Division is transferred from the North Carolina Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina to be managed by North Carolina State University.

This transfer shall comprise all of the elements of a Type I transfer as defined by G.S. 143A‑6 including (i) the ownership, possession, and control of its properties, including buildings, grounds, personal property, vehicles, and equipment and (ii) the resources, assets, liabilities, and operations maintained, possessed, or controlled by the Research Stations Division of North Carolina Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services prior to the transfer, except for the five management tracts owned and managed under the Forest Management Program.

The five management tracts, totaling 3,150 acres, owned and managed by the North Carolina Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services under the Forest Management Program shall be transferred to the Division of Forest Resources of the North Carolina Department of Environment and Natural Resources as a Type I transfer as defined by G.S. 143A‑6 including (i) the ownership, possession, and control of its properties, including buildings, grounds, personal property, vehicles, and equipment and (ii) the resources, assets, liabilities, and operations maintained, possessed, or controlled by the Forest Management Program of the Research Stations Division of North Carolina Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services prior to the transfer.

SECTION 11.2.(b)  There is created a multidisciplinary, multiagency Agricultural Research Facilities System Advisory Board (Board) to provide ongoing vision and leadership for the system of agricultural research facilities. Board members are charged with representing statewide interests, including the practical, applied concerns of local farmers and the perspectives of commodity associations as well as the broader citizenry. At a minimum, the Board shall perform the following functions:

(1)        Conduct a thorough, comprehensive review of the system and formulate a strategic plan for the management of system within budgeted resources. The review shall include, at a minimum, an assessment of the scientific merit of all agricultural research facilities, an examination of current research needs and anticipated future research trends, and the evaluation of the capacity for teaching and extension activities. The review shall also contain recommendations on land that might be sold, purchased, or transferred out of the system and the related potential cost effects.

(2)        Periodically review the strategic plan and modify as needed to meet the needs of stakeholders, including scientists, farmers, and commodity associations.

(3)        Ensure the concerns of stakeholders concerning ongoing facility operations, activities, and future planning, as well as holding public hearings as needed to gather input.

(4)        Review the role of receipts in supporting research facilities and operations.

The Board should report all findings and recommendations to the Dean of the College of Agriculture and Life Sciences at North Carolina State University and the Dean of the School of Agriculture and Environmental Sciences at North Carolina Agricultural and Technical State University.

SECTION 11.2.(c)  To assure the continued representation of the interests of production agriculture as well as basic research at the facilities, the Board shall consist of 10 voting members as follows:

(1)        The Commissioner of Agriculture or a designee.

(2)        The Director of NCSU Agricultural Research and Cooperative Extension Service from the College of Agriculture and Life Sciences.

(3)        The Director of NC A&T Agricultural Research and Cooperative Extension Service from the School of Agriculture and Environmental Sciences.

(4)        One department head from the NCSU College of Agriculture and Life Sciences.

(5)        One department head from the NC A&T College of Agriculture and Environmental Sciences.

(6)        Five members representing wide agricultural interests to be appointed by the following:

a.         The Commissioner of Agriculture (3 members).

b.         The Dean of NCSU College of Agriculture and Life Sciences (1 member).

c.         The Dean of NC A&T School of Agriculture and Environmental Sciences (1 member).

Board members shall elect their own chair.

SECTION 11.2.(d)  The Board shall meet regularly at the direction of Dean of the College of Agriculture and Life Sciences at North Carolina State University and the Dean of the School of Agriculture and Environmental Sciences at North Carolina Agricultural and Technical State University to ensure the system of agricultural research facilities fulfills the needs of stakeholders who rely on rigorous research, far‑reaching cooperative extension, and accessible academic opportunities.

SECTION 11.2.(e)  The Board shall be in place no later than October 1, 2011.

SECTION 11.2.(f)  Any research station facility and associated land managed by North Carolina State University (NCSU) that is recommended for sale shall be sold as surplus property by the Department of Administration (DOA) State Property Office.  After allowable DOA service charges, NCSU may retain twenty‑five percent (25%) of sale receipts for one‑time purchases associated with managing the remaining research stations.  The remaining funds shall revert to the General Fund.

SECTION 11.2.(g)  Any forest management tract that is not needed or cannot be properly managed within existing funds of the Division of Forest Resources (DFR) shall be sold as surplus property by the DOA State Property Office.  After allowable DOA service charges, DFR may retain twenty‑five percent (25%) of sale receipts for one‑time purchases associated with forest management, and remaining funds shall revert to the General Fund.

 

PART Xii. Department of Environment and Natural Resources

 

AMEND HAZARDOUS WASTE MANAGEMENT PROGRAM

SECTION 12.1.  G.S. 130A‑294.1(b) reads as rewritten:

"(b)      Funds collected pursuant to this section shall be used for personnel and other resources necessary to:

(1)        Provide a high level of technical assistance and waste minimization effort for the hazardous waste management program;

(2)        Provide timely review of permit applications;

(3)        Insure that permit decisions are made on a sound technical basis and that permit decisions incorporate all conditions necessary to accomplish the purposes of this Part;

(4)        Improve monitoring and compliance of the hazardous waste management program;

(5)        Increase the frequency of inspections;

(6)        Provide chemical, biological, toxicological, and analytical support for the hazardous waste management program; and

(7)        Provide resources for emergency response to imminent hazards associated with the hazardous waste management program.program;

(8)        Provide implementation and oversight of activities involving actions necessary to respond to inactive hazardous substance or waste disposal sites; and

(9)        Provide compliance and prevention activities within the solid waste program to ensure hazardous waste is not disposed in solid waste management facilities."

 

OYSTER SANCTUARY PROGRAM

SECTION 12.2.  G.S. 113‑175.1(c) reads as rewritten:

"(c)       The Marine Fisheries Commission and the Wildlife Resources Commission may authorize the disbursement of the principal of the Marine Resources Fund and marine resources investment income only to manage, protect, restore, develop, cultivate, conserve, and enhance the marine resources of the State. The Marine Fisheries Commission and the Wildlife Resources Commission are encouraged to consider supporting the Oyster Sanctuary Program managed by the Division of Marine Fisheries. The Marine Fisheries Commission and the Wildlife Resources Commission may not authorize the disbursement of the principal of the Marine Resources Fund and marine resources investment income to establish positions without specific authorization from the General Assembly. All proposals to the Marine Fisheries Commission and the Wildlife Resources Commission for the disbursement of funds from the Marine Resources Fund shall be made by and through the Fisheries Director. Expenditure of the assets of the Marine Resources Fund shall be made through the State budget accounts of the Division of Marine Fisheries in accordance with the provisions of the Executive Budget Act. The Marine Resources Fund is subject to the oversight of the State Auditor pursuant to Article 5A of Chapter 147 of the General Statutes."

 

GRASSROOTS SCIENCE PROGRAM

SECTION 12.4.(a)  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Environment and Natural Resources for the Grassroots Science Program, the sum of three million seventy thousand five hundred forty‑two dollars ($3,070,542) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the sum of three million seventy thousand five hundred forty‑two dollars ($3,070,542) for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year is allocated as grants‑in‑aid for each fiscal year as follows:

 

                                                                                                     2011‑2012                2012‑2013

 

Aurora Fossil Museum                                                                   $      52,088              $      52,088

Cape Fear Museum                                                                             142,008                    142,008

Carolina Raptor Center                                                                          98,938                      98,938

Catawba Science Center                                                                     129,086                    129,086

Colburn Earth Science Museum, Inc.                                                     65,749                      65,749

Core Sound Waterfowl Museum                                                            44,100                      44,100

Discovery Place                                                                                   584,647                    584,647

Eastern NC Regional Science Center                                                     44,100                      44,100

Fascinate‑U                                                                                           71,506                      71,506

Granville County Museum Commission,

      Inc. – Harris Gallery                                                                        49,765                      49,765

Greensboro Children's Museum                                                           119,137                    119,137

The Health Adventure Museum of Pack

      Place Education, Arts and Science Center, Inc.                              137,249                    137,249

Highlands Nature Center                                                                        69,915                      69,915

Imagination Station                                                                                75,882                      75,882

The Iredell Museums, Inc.                                                                      54,072                      54,072

Kidsenses                                                                                              71,690                      71,690

Museum of Coastal Carolina                                                                  68,814                      68,814

The Natural Science Center of Greensboro, Inc.                                  164,364                    164,364

NC Museum of Life and Science                                                         335,006                    335,006

Pisgah Astronomical Research Institute                                                   44,100                      44,100

Port Discover: Northeastern North Carolina's

      Center for Hands‑On Science, Inc.                                                  44,100                      44,100

Rocky Mount Children's Museum                                                          63,728                      63,728

Schiele Museum of Natural History and

      Planetarium, Inc.                                                                            202,460                    202,460

Sci Works Science Center and

      Environmental Park of Forsyth County                                           129,212                    129,212

Sylvan Heights Waterfowl Park and Eco‑Center                                    44,100                      44,100

Western North Carolina Nature Center                                                  99,559                      99,559

Wilmington Children's Museum                                                              65,167                      65,167

 

Total                                                                                           $  3,070,542             $  3,070,542

SECTION 12.4.(b)  No later than March 1, 2012, the Department of Environment and Natural Resources shall report to the Fiscal Research Division all of the following information for each museum that receives funds under this section:

(1)        The actual operating budget for the 2010‑2011 fiscal year.

(2)        The proposed operating budget for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year.

(3)        The total attendance at the museum during the 2011 calendar year.

SECTION 12.4.(c)  No later than March 1, 2013, the Department of Environment and Natural Resources shall report to the Fiscal Research Division all of the following information for each museum that receives funds under this section:

(1)        The actual operating budget for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year.

(2)        The proposed operating budget for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.

(3)        The total attendance at the museum during the 2012 calendar year.

 

PART XIII. Department of Commerce

 

INDUSTRIAL COMMISSION FEES/COMPUTER SYSTEM REPLACEMENT

SECTION 13.1.  The North Carolina Industrial Commission may retain the additional revenue generated as a result of an increase in the fee charged to parties for the filing of compromised settlements. These funds shall be used for the purpose of replacing existing computer hardware and software used for the operations of the Commission. These funds may also be used to prepare any assessment of hardware and software needs prior to purchase and to develop and administer the needed databases and new Electronic Case Management System. The Commission may not retain any fees under this section unless they are in excess of the former two hundred dollar ($200.00) fee charged by the Commission for filing a compromised settlement.

 

REPEAL E‑NC SUNSET

SECTION 13.2.  The sunset provision pertaining to the e‑NC Authority, as described in Section 4 of S.L. 2003‑425, and as amended by Section 12.3(a) of S.L. 2006‑66, is hereby repealed.

 

SET REGULATORY FEE FOR UTILITIES COMMISSION

SECTION 13.3.(a)  The percentage rate to be used in calculating the public utility regulatory fee under G.S. 62‑302(b)(2) is fifteen one‑hundredths of one percent (0.15%) for each public utility's North Carolina jurisdictional revenues earned during each quarter that begins on or after July 1, 2011.

SECTION 13.3.(b)  The electric membership corporation regulatory fee imposed under G.S. 62‑302(b1) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year is two hundred thousand dollars ($200,000).

SECTION 13.3.(c)  This section becomes effective July 1, 2011.

 

ONE NORTH CAROLINA FUND

SECTION 13.5.  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the One North Carolina Fund for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, the Department of Commerce may use up to three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000) to cover its expenses in administering the One North Carolina Fund and other economic development incentive grant programs during the 2011‑2012 fiscal year.

 

RURAL ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT CENTER

SECTION 13.6.(a)  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the North Carolina Rural Economic Development Center, Inc. (Rural Center), the sum of three million five hundred eighty‑three thousand six hundred seventy‑eight dollars ($3,583,678) for each year in the 2011‑2013 biennium shall be allocated as follows:

                                                                                                     2011‑2012                2012‑2013

Center Administration, Technical Assistance, & Oversight             $  1,302,165             $  1,302,165

Research and Demonstration Grants                                                     294,120                    294,120

Institute for Rural Entrepreneurship                                                       114,570                    114,570

Community Development Grants                                                          844,258                    844,258

Microenterprise Loan Program                                                            155,610                    155,610

Water/Sewer/Business Development

Matching Grants                                                                                  701,955                    701,955

Statewide Water/Sewer Database                                                          79,515                    $79,515

Agricultural Advancement Consortium                                                    91,485                    $91,485

 

SECTION 13.6.(b)  Funds allocated in subsection (a) of this section for community development grants shall support development projects and activities within the State's minority communities. Any new or previously funded community development corporation, as that term is defined in subsection (c) of this section, is eligible to apply for community development grant funds. However, no community development grant funds shall be released to a community development corporation unless the corporation can demonstrate that there are no outstanding or proposed assessments or other collection actions against the corporation for any State or federal taxes, including related penalties, interest, and fees.

SECTION 13.6.(c)  For purposes of this section, the term "community development corporation" means a nonprofit corporation:

(1)        Chartered pursuant to Chapter 55A of the General Statutes;

(2)        Tax‑exempt pursuant to section 501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986;

(3)        Whose primary mission is to develop and improve low‑income communities and neighborhoods through economic and related development;

(4)        Whose activities and decisions are initiated, managed, and controlled by the constituents of those local communities; and

(5)        Whose primary function is to act as deal maker and packager of projects and activities that will increase their constituencies' opportunities to become owners, managers, and producers of small businesses, affordable housing, and jobs designed to produce positive cash flow and curb blight in the targeted community.

SECTION 13.6.(d)  The Rural Center shall provide a report containing detailed budget, personnel, and salary information to the Office of State Budget and Management in the same manner as State departments and agencies in preparation for biennium budget requests.

SECTION 13.6.(e)  By September 1 of each year, and more frequently as requested, the Rural Center shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Fiscal Research Division on prior State fiscal year program activities, objectives, and accomplishments and prior State fiscal year itemized expenditures and fund sources.

 

RURAL ECONOMIC DEVELOPMENT CENTER/INFRASTRUCTURE PROGRAM

SECTION 13.7.(a)  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the North Carolina Rural Economic Development Center, Inc. (Rural Center), the sum of sixteen million five hundred five thousand seven hundred seventy‑five dollars ($16,505,775) for each year in the 2011‑2013 biennium shall be allocated as follows:

(1)        To continue the North Carolina Infrastructure Program. The purpose of the Program is to provide grants to local governments to construct critical water and wastewater facilities and to provide other infrastructure needs, including technology needs, to sites where these facilities will generate private job‑creating investment. The grants under this Program shall not be subject to the provisions of G.S. 143‑355.4.

(2)        To provide matching grants and/or loans to local governments in distressed areas that will productively reuse vacant buildings and properties, with priority given to towns or communities with populations of less than 5,000.

(3)        To provide grants and technical assistance to reinvigorate the economies of towns with populations of less than 7,500 and to invest in economic innovation that stimulates business and job growth in distressed areas.

(4)        Recipients of grant funds appropriated under this section shall contribute a cash match for the grant that is equivalent to at least five percent (5%) of the grant amount. The cash match shall come from local resources and may not be derived from other State or federal grant funds or from funds provided by the Rural Center.

SECTION 13.7.(b)  During each year of the 2011‑2013 biennium, the Rural Center may use up to three hundred twenty‑nine thousand one hundred seventy‑five dollars ($329,175) of the funds appropriated in this act to cover its expenses in administering the North Carolina Economic Infrastructure Program.

SECTION 13.7.(c)  By September 1 of each year, and more frequently as requested, the Rural Center shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Fiscal Research Division concerning the progress of the North Carolina Economic Infrastructure Program in the prior State fiscal year.

 

OPPORTUNITIES INDUSTRIALIZATION CENTERS FUNDS

SECTION 13.8.(a)  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the North Carolina Rural Economic Development Center, Inc. (Rural Center), the sum of two hundred eighty‑seven thousand two hundred eighty dollars ($287,280) for each year in the 2011‑2013 biennium shall be equally distributed among the certified Opportunities Industrialization Centers (OI Centers).

SECTION 13.8.(b)  By September 1 of each year, and more frequently as requested, the Rural Center shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Fiscal Research Division on OI Centers receiving funds pursuant to subsection (a) of this section.  The report shall include data for each OI Center on all itemized expenditures and all fund sources for the prior State fiscal year. The report shall also contain a written narrative on prior fiscal year program activities, objectives, and accomplishments that were funded with funds appropriated in subsection (a) of this section.

SECTION 13.8.(c)  The Rural Center shall ensure that each OI Center complies with the audit and reporting requirements prescribed by G.S. 143C‑6‑23 and 09 NCAC 03M .0101.

SECTION 13.8.(d)  No funds appropriated under this act shall be released to an OI Center listed in subsection (a) of this section if the OI Center has any overdue tax debts, as that term is defined in G.S. 105‑243.1, at the federal or State level.

 

RURAL CENTER/AGRICULTURAL DEVELOPMENT FUNDS

SECTION 13.9.  Of the funds appropriated in this act to the North Carolina Rural Economic Development Center, Inc. (Rural Center), the sum of two hundred fifty thousand dollars ($250,000) for each year in the 2011‑2013 biennium shall be allocated to the Agricultural Advancement Consortium to provide grants for agricultural development projects in North Carolina's farm communities designed to reduce the costs of producing agricultural products or increase the market for North Carolina agricultural products.

 

NER BLOCK GRANTS

SECTION 13.10.(a)  Appropriations from federal block grant funds are made for the fiscal year ending June 30, 2012, according to the following schedule:

 

COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT BLOCK GRANT (CDBG)

 

      01.    State Administration                                                                                $         1,000,000

 

      02.    Scattered Site Housing                                                                                      16,500,000

 

      03.    Economic Development                                                                                      7,210,000

 

      04.    Small Business/Entrepreneurship                                                                         3,000,000

 

      05.    NC Catalyst                                                                                                       7,240,000

 

      06.    State Technical Assistance                                                                                     450,000

 

      07.    Infrastructure                                                                                                      8,000,000

 

      08.    Capacity Building                                                                                                1,600,000

 

TOTAL COMMUNITY DEVELOPMENT

BLOCK GRANT – 2012 Program Year                                                            $       45,000,000

 

SECTION 13.10.(b)  Decreases in Federal Fund Availability. – If federal funds are reduced below the amounts specified above after the effective date of this act, then every program in each of these federal block grants shall be reduced by the same percentage as the reduction in federal funds.

SECTION 13.10.(c)  Increases in Federal Fund Availability for Community Development Block Grant. – Any block grant funds appropriated by the Congress of the United States in addition to the funds specified in this section shall be expended with each program category under the Community Development Block Grant increasing by the same percentage as the increase in federal funds.

SECTION 13.10.(d)  Limitations on Community Development Block Grant Funds. – Of the funds appropriated in this section for the Community Development Block Grant, the following shall be allocated in each category for each program year: up to one million dollars ($1,000,000) may be used for State Administration; up to sixteen million five hundred thousand dollars ($16,500,000) may be used for Scattered Site Housing; up to seven million two hundred ten thousand dollars ($7,210,000) may be used for Economic Development; up to three million dollars ($3,000,000) may be used for Small Business/Entrepreneurship; up to seven million two hundred forty thousand dollars ($7,240,000) shall be used for NC Catalyst; up to four hundred fifty thousand dollars ($450,000) may be used for State Technical Assistance; up to eight million dollars ($8,000,000) may be used for Infrastructure; up to one million six hundred thousand dollars ($1,600,000) may be used for Capacity Building.  If federal block grant funds are reduced or increased by the Congress of the United States after the effective date of this act, then these reductions or increases shall be allocated in accordance with subsection (b) or (c) of this section, as applicable.

SECTION 13.10.(e)  Increase Capacity for Nonprofit Organizations. – Assistance to nonprofit organizations to increase their capacity to carry out CDBG‑eligible activities in partnership with units of local government is an eligible activity under any program category in accordance with federal regulations.  Capacity building grants may be made from funds available within program categories, program income, or unobligated funds.

SECTION 13.10.(f)  The Department of Commerce shall consult with the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior to reallocating Community Development Block Grant Funds.  Notwithstanding the provisions of this subsection, whenever the Director of the Budget finds that:

(1)        A reallocation is required because of an emergency that poses an imminent threat to public health or public safety, the Director of the Budget may authorize the reallocation without consulting the Commission. The Department of Commerce shall report to the Commission on the reallocation no later than 30 days after it was authorized and shall identify in the report the emergency, the type of action taken, and how it was related to the emergency.

(2)        The State will lose federal block grant funds or receive less federal block grant funds in the next fiscal year unless a reallocation is made; the Department of Commerce shall provide a written report to the Commission on the proposed reallocation and shall identify the reason that failure to take action will result in the loss of federal funds. If the Commission does not hear the issue within 30 days of receipt of the report, the Department may take the action without consulting the Commission.

 

PRIVATIZE WELCOME CENTERS

SECTION 13.11.  The Department of Commerce shall work collaboratively with the Department of Transportation to develop an implementation plan to privatize the State's Welcome Center and Visitor Centers. At a minimum, the plan shall identify all barriers to privatizing the Centers and propose solutions to overcome all barriers, including all necessary federal waivers, and recommend an implementation time frame that has as a goal the privatization of the Welcome and Visitor Centers for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.  If privatization is not possible, the Departments shall jointly propose a plan for future funding of the Welcome and Visitor Centers that minimizes the use of State funds.  The Department of Commerce and Department of Transportation shall submit the joint plan to the Office of the Governor and the Office of State Budget and Management no later than January 31, 2012.

 

PART XiV. Judicial Department

 

COLLECTION OF WORTHLESS CHECKs FUND

SECTION 14.1.(a)  Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 7A‑308(c), the Judicial Department may use any balance remaining in the Collection of Worthless Checks Fund on June 30, 2011, for the purchase or repair of office or information technology equipment during the 2011‑2012 fiscal year. Prior to using any funds under this section, the Judicial Department shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations and the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Appropriations Subcommittees on Justice and Public Safety on the equipment to be purchased or repaired and the reasons for the purchases.

SECTION 14.1.(b)  This section becomes effective June 30, 2011.

 

PART XV. Department of Justice

 

Reduce Sex Offender Postage Budget

SECTION 15.1.(a)  Part 2 of Article 27A of Chapter 14 of the General Statutes reads as rewritten:

"Part 2. Sex Offender and Public Protection Registration Program.

"§ 14‑208.7.  Registration.

(a)        A person who is a State resident and who has a reportable conviction shall be required to maintain registration with the sheriff of the county where the person resides. If the person moves to North Carolina from outside this State, the person shall register within three business days of establishing residence in this State, or whenever the person has been present in the State for 15 days, whichever comes first. If the person is a current resident of North Carolina, the person shall register:

(1)        Within three business days of release from a penal institution or arrival in a county to live outside a penal institution; or

(2)        Immediately upon conviction for a reportable offense where an active term of imprisonment was not imposed.

Registration shall be maintained for a period of at least 30 years following the date of initial county registration unless the person, after 10 years of registration, successfully petitions the superior court to shorten his or her registration time period under G.S. 14‑208.12A.

(a1)      A person who is a nonresident student or a nonresident worker and who has a reportable conviction, or is required to register in the person's state of residency, is required to maintain registration with the sheriff of the county where the person works or attends school. In addition to the information required under subsection (b) of this section, the person shall also provide information regarding the person's school or place of employment as appropriate and the person's address in his or her state of residence.

(b)        The Division shall provide each sheriff with forms for registering persons as required by this Article. The registration form shall require all of the following:

(1)        The person's full name, each alias, date of birth, sex, race, height, weight, eye color, hair color, drivers license number, and home address.home and mailing addresses.

(2)        The type of offense for which the person was convicted, the date of conviction, and the sentence imposed.

(3)        A current photograph taken by the sheriff, without charge, at the time of registration.

(4)        The person's fingerprints taken by the sheriff, without charge, at the time of registration.

(5)        A statement indicating whether the person is a student or expects to enroll as a student within a year of registering. If the person is a student or expects to enroll as a student within a year of registration, then the registration form shall also require the name and address of the educational institution at which the person is a student or expects to enroll as a student.

(6)        A statement indicating whether the person is employed or expects to be employed at an institution of higher education within a year of registering. If the person is employed or expects to be employed at an institution of higher education within a year of registration, then the registration form shall also require the name and address of the educational institution at which the person is or expects to be employed.

(7)        Any online identifier that the person uses or intends to use.

(c)        When a person registers, the sheriff with whom the person registered shall immediately send the registration information to the Division in a manner determined by the Division. The sheriff shall retain the original registration form and other information collected and shall compile the information that is a public record under this Part into a county registry.

(d)        Any person required to register under this section shall report in person at the appropriate sheriff's office to comply with the registration requirements set out in this section. The sheriff shall provide the registrant with written proof of registration at the time of registration."

SECTION 15.1.(b)  G.S. 14‑208.9A reads as rewritten:

"§ 14‑208.9A.  Verification of registration information.

(a)        The information in the county registry shall be verified semiannually for each registrant as follows:A person required to register under G.S. 14‑208.7 shall have a verification date every six months following the date of initial county registration. The offender's verification dates will be the same two calendar dates every calendar year until the person's registration requirements are terminated. During the initial registration and each subsequent verification process, the sheriff will notify the offender of his or her next verification date.

(1)        Every year on the anniversary of a person's initial registration date, and again six months after that date, the Division shall mail a nonforwardable verification form to the last reported address of the person.Within three business days of each verification date, a person required to register must report in person at the appropriate sheriff's office and  complete and sign a verification form approved by the State Bureau of Investigation. Except as provided below, the verification form shall require the person to provide all of the information required for registration under G.S. 14‑208.7.

a.         New photographs do not have to be taken if it appears to the sheriff that the record photograph provides a true and accurate likeness of the offender.

b.         New fingerprints do not have to be taken if a set of the offender's fingerprints has previously been accepted and entered into the State's fingerprint database as a result of the Sex Offender and Public Protection registration process.

c.         If information on the type of offense for which the person was convicted, the date of conviction, and the sentence imposed has previously been provided to the sheriff, the offender does not have to provide this information during verification.

(2)        The person shall return the verification form in person to the sheriff within three business days after the receipt of the form.If a person required to register fails to report in person to the sheriff and complete and sign the verification forms within three business days after any of his or her verification dates, the person is subject to the penalties provided in G.S. 14‑208.11 unless he or she has complied with one of the following exceptions:

a.         If a registrant is unable to report in person to the sheriff due to medical reasons, the registrant must provide written notice to the sheriff prior to his or her verification date. The registrant must also provide a letter from a medical care provider stating that due to medical reasons the registrant is unable to report to the sheriff's office. The sheriff shall make reasonable efforts to have a law enforcement officer make an in‑person visit to the registrant so the registrant can complete the verification forms in the presence of a law enforcement officer. Once the registrant is medically able to report in‑person to the sheriff,  the registrant must report in‑person to the sheriff within three business days and complete a verification form. The fact that a registrant is exempt from reporting in‑person to the sheriff's office for medical reasons is public record, but information about the registrant's specific medical diagnosis or condition is not public record.

b.         If a registrant will be out‑of‑state during the entire three business days prior to his or her verification date, on his or her verification date, and the entire three business days after his or her verification date, the registrant must report in‑person to the sheriff's office prior to leaving the State. The registrant must complete a verification form and provide the sheriff with a written itinerary including a description of any motor vehicle the registrant will be traveling in while out‑of‑state, the vehicle identification numbers, the license tag number, the registration number, and a description, including color scheme, of each motor vehicle; temporary lodging information, including the physical address of each location the registrant will be spending the night at while out‑of‑state, the dates the registrant will be staying at each location, and any known telephone numbers, including cellular phone numbers, at which the registrant may be reached while out‑of‑state. The registrant's itinerary information, except for phone numbers, vehicle registration numbers, and vehicle identification numbers, is public record. The registrant must report in‑person to the sheriff within three business days of reentering the State and complete a verification form.

(3)        The verification form shall be signed by the person and shall indicate the following:

a.         Whether the person still resides at the address last reported to the sheriff. If the person has a different address, then the person shall indicate that fact and the new address.

b.         Whether the person still uses or intends to use any online identifiers last reported to the sheriff. If the person has any new or different online identifiers, then the person shall provide those online identifiers to the sheriff.

At least 10 days prior to each of his or her verification dates, the Division shall mail to the last reported mailing address of the person required to register, a reminder of the person's verification date and the person's responsibility to report in person to the registering sheriff. Nonreceipt of notice does not constitute a defense to failure to comply with this Article. The Division shall not mail notice to the following:

a.         Persons who are reported to be incarcerated.

b.         Persons, except nonresident students and nonresident workers, who have reported they reside out‑of‑state.

(3a)      If it appears to the sheriff that the record photograph of the sex offender no longer provides a true and accurate likeness of the sex offender, then the sheriff shall take a photograph of the offender to include with the verification form.

(4)        If the person fails to return the verification form in person to the sheriff within three business days after receipt of the form, the person is subject to the penalties provided in G.S. 14‑208.11. If the person fails to report in person and provide the written verification as provided by this section, the sheriff shall make a reasonable attempt to verify that the person is residing at the registered address. If the person cannot be found at the registered address and has failed to report a change of address, the person is subject to the penalties provided in G.S. 14‑208.11, unless the person reports in person to the sheriff and proves that the person has not changed his or her residential address.If the person fails to report in person and provide the written verification as provided by this section, the sheriff shall make a reasonable attempt to verify that the person is residing at the registered address. If the person cannot be found at the registered address and has failed to report a change of address, the person is subject to the penalties provided in G.S. 14‑208.11, unless the person reports in person to the sheriff and proves that the person has not changed his or her residential address.

(b)        Additional Verification May Be Required. – During the period that an offender is required to be registered under this Article, the sheriff is authorized to attempt to verify that the offender continues to reside at the address last registered by the offender.

(c)        Additional Photograph May Be Required. – If it appears to the sheriff that the current photograph of the sex offender no longer provides a true and accurate likeness of the sex offender, upon in‑person notice from the sheriff, the sex offender shall allow the sheriff to take another photograph of the sex offender at the time of the sheriff's request. If requested by the sheriff, the sex offender shall appear in person at the sheriff's office during normal business hours within three business days of being requested to do so and shall allow the sheriff to take another photograph of the sex offender. A person who willfully fails to comply with this subsection is guilty of a Class 1 misdemeanor."

SECTION 15.1.(c)  G.S. 14‑208.11 reads as rewritten:

"§ 14‑208.11.  Failure to register; falsification of verification notice; failure to return verification form; order for arrest.

(a)        A person required by this Article to register who willfully does any of the following is guilty of a Class F felony:

(1)        Fails to register as required by this Article.

(2)        Fails to notify the last registering sheriff of a change of address as required by this Article.

(3)        Fails to returncomplete and sign a verification notice as required under G.S. 14‑208.9A.

(4)        Forges or submits under false pretenses the information or verification notices required under this Article.

(5)        Fails to inform the registering sheriff of enrollment or termination of enrollment as a student.

(6)        Fails to inform the registering sheriff of employment at an institution of higher education or termination of employment at an institution of higher education.

(7)        Fails to report in person to the sheriff's office as required by G.S. 14‑208.7, 14‑208.9, and 14‑208.9A.

(8)        Reports his or her intent to reside in another state or jurisdiction but remains in this State without reporting to the sheriff in the manner required by G.S. 14‑208.9.

(9)        Fails to notify the registering sheriff of out‑of‑county employment if temporary residence is established as required under G.S. 14‑208.8A.

(10)      Fails to inform the registering sheriff of any new or changes to existing online identifiers that the person uses or intends to use.

(a1)      If a person commits a violation of subsection (a) of this section, the probation officer, parole officer, or any other law enforcement officer who is aware of the violation shall immediately arrest the person in accordance with G.S. 15A‑401, or seek an order for the person's arrest in accordance with G.S. 15A‑305.

(b)        Before a person convicted of a violation of this Article is due to be released from a penal institution, an official of the penal institution shall conduct the prerelease notification procedures specified under G.S. 14‑208.8(a)(2) and (3). If upon a conviction for a violation of this Article, no active term of imprisonment is imposed, the court pronouncing sentence shall, at the time of sentencing, conduct the notification procedures specified under G.S. 14‑208.8(a)(2) and (3).

(c)        A person who is unable to meet the registration or verification requirements of this Article shall be deemed to have complied with its requirements if:

(1)        The person is incarcerated in, or is in the custody of, a local, State, private, or federal correctional facility,

(2)        The person notifies the official in charge of the facility of their status as a person with a legal obligation or requirement under this Article and

(3)        The person meets the registration or verification requirements of this Article no later than 10 days after release from confinement or custody."

SECTION 15.1.(d)  G.S. 14‑208.24 reads as rewritten:

"§ 14‑208.24.  Verification of registration information.

(a)        The information in the county registry shall be verified by the sheriff for each registrant who is a recidivist, who is convicted of an aggravated offense, or who is classified as a sexually violent predator every 90 days after the person's initial registration date. Each registrant who is a recidivist, who is convicted of an aggravated offense, or who is classified as a sexually violent predator shall have a verification date every 90 days following the date of initial county registration. The registrant's verification dates will be the same four calendar dates every calendar year.

(b)        The procedure for verifying the information in the criminal offender registry is the same as under G.S. 14‑208.9A, except that verification shall be every 90 days as provided by subsection (a) of this section."

 

PART XVI. Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention

 

ANNUAL EVALUATION OF COMMUNITY PROGRAMS

SECTION 16.1.  Section 18.1 of S.L. 2009‑451 reads as rewritten:

"SECTION 18.1. The Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention shall conduct an evaluation of the Eckerd and Camp Woodson wilderness camp programs and of multipurpose group homes.

In conducting the evaluation of each of these programs, the Department shall consider whether participation in each program results in a reduction of court involvement among juveniles. The Department also shall identify whether the programs are achieving the goals and objectives of the Juvenile Justice Reform Act, S.L. 1998‑202. The Department shall report the results of the evaluation to the Joint Legislative Corrections, Crime Control, and Juvenile Justice Oversight Committee, the chairs of the Senate and House of Representatives Appropriations Committees and the chairs of the Subcommittees on Justice and Public Safety of the Senate and House of Representatives Appropriations Committees by March 1 of each year."

 

STATE FUNDS MAY BE USED AS FEDERAL MATCHING FUNDS

SECTION 16.2.  Funds appropriated in this act to the Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year may be used as matching funds for the Juvenile Accountability Incentive Block Grants. If North Carolina receives Juvenile Accountability Incentive Block Grants or a notice of funds to be awarded, the Office of State Budget and Management and the Governor's Crime Commission shall consult with the Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention regarding the criteria for awarding federal funds. The Office of State Budget and Management, the Governor's Crime Commission, and the Department of Juvenile Justice and Delinquency Prevention shall report to the Appropriations Committees of the Senate and House of Representatives and the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations prior to allocation of the federal funds. The report shall identify the amount of funds to be received for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, the amount of funds anticipated for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, and the allocation of funds by program and purpose.

 

PART XVIII. Department of Correction

 

INMATE MEDICAL COST CONTAINMENT

SECTION 18.1.(a)  The Department of Correction shall reimburse those providers and facilities providing approved inmate medical services outside the correctional facility the lesser amount of either a rate of seventy percent (70%) of the provider's then current prevailing charge or two times the then current Medicaid rate for any given service.  The DOC shall have the right to audit any given provider to determine actual prevailing charge to ensure compliance with this provision.

The provisions above shall not apply to vendors providing services that are not billed on a fee‑for‑service basis (e.g., temporary staffing). Nothing in this section shall preclude the Department from contracting with a provider for services at rates that provide greater documentable cost avoidance for the State than do the rates contained herein or at rates that are less favorable to the State but will ensure the continued access to care.

SECTION 18.1.(b)  The Department of Correction shall make every effort to contain inmate medical costs by making use of its own hospital and health care facilities to provide health care services to inmates. To the extent that the Department of Correction must utilize other facilities and services to provide health care services to inmates, the Department shall make reasonable efforts to make use of hospitals or other providers with which it has a contract or, if none is reasonably available, hospitals with available capacity or other health care facilities in a region to accomplish that goal. The Department shall make reasonable efforts to equitably distribute inmates among all hospitals or other appropriate health care facilities. With respect to any single hospital, the Department of Correction shall continue to make its best effort to seek admission of the number of inmates representing no more than nine percent (9%) of all inmates requiring hospitalization or hospital services on an annual basis beginning in fiscal year 2011‑2012, unless the failure to do so would jeopardize the health of an inmate or unless a higher level is agreed to by contract. The Department shall also give preference to those hospitals or other health care facilities in the same county or an adjoining county to the correctional facility where an inmate requiring hospitalization is incarcerated.  The Department will continue these efforts until it has reached a number which represents no more than five percent (5%) of all inmates requiring hospitalization or hospital services on an annual basis at any single hospital by July 1, 2013, unless the failure to do so would jeopardize the health of an inmate or unless a higher level is agreed to by contract.

SECTION 18.1.(c)  The Department of Correction shall consult with the Department of Health and Human Services, Division of Medical Assistance, to determine the feasibility of applying for a Medicaid waiver to cover the inmate population.  Insomuch as a waiver is available to Department of Correction inmates, the medical care provided to those inmates covered by said waiver will be reimbursed at the rates set forth by Medicaid.

SECTION 18.1.(d)  The Department of Correction, in consultation with the Office of State Budget and Management, shall study the impact on inmate medical costs resulting from the measures set forth in subsections (a), (b), (c), and (d) of this section. The Department shall present its findings by March 1, 2012, to the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Appropriations Subcommittees on Justice and Public Safety and to the Joint Legislative Corrections, Crime Control, and Juvenile Justice Oversight Committee.

SECTION 18.1.(e)  The Department of Correction shall make every effort to explore other cost containment methods not expressly outlined in this section. These methods may include contracting with a private third party to manage and provide all inmate medical services.  The Department of Correction shall study the impact of any such methods that are implemented and present its findings by May 1, 2012, to the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Appropriations Subcommittees on Justice and Public Safety and to the Joint Legislative Corrections, Crime Control, and Juvenile Justice Oversight Committee.

SECTION 18.1.(f)  The Department of Correction shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations no later than November 1, 2011, and quarterly thereafter on the following:

(1)        The volume of services provided by community medical providers that can be scheduled in advance and, of that volume, the percentage of those services that are provided by contracted providers.

(2)        The volume of services provided by community medical providers that cannot be scheduled in advance and, of that volume, the percentage of those services that are provided by contracted providers.

 

FEDERAL GRANT MATCHING FUNDS

SECTION 18.2.  Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 143C‑6‑9, the Department of Correction may use up to the sum of one million two hundred thousand dollars ($1,200,000) during the 2011‑2012 fiscal year from funds available to the Department to provide the State match needed in order to receive federal grant funds. Prior to using funds for this purpose, the Department shall report to the Chairs of the House of Representatives and Senate Appropriations Subcommittees on Justice and Public Safety and the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on the grants to be matched using these funds.

 

PART XIX. OFFICE OF ADMINISTRATIVE HEARINGS

 

OFFICE OF ADMINISTRATIVE HEARINGS

SECTION 19.1.  G.S. 150B‑21.24 reads as rewritten:

"§ 150B‑21.24.  Access to Register and Code.

(a)        Register. – The Codifier of Rules shall make available the North Carolina Register on the Internet at no charge. Upon request the Codifier shall provide a free copy of the current volume of the Register to any person who receives a free copy of the North Carolina Administrative Code or any member of the General Assembly.

(b)        Code. – The Codifier of Rules shall make available the North Carolina Administrative Code on the Internet at no charge. The Codifier shall distribute copies of the North Carolina Administrative Code as soon after publication as practical, without charge, to the following:

(1)        One copy to the board of commissioners of each county that specifically requests a printed copy, to be placed at the county clerk of court's office or at another place selected by the board of commissioners. The Codifier of Rules is not required to provide a copy of the Administrative Code to any board of county commissioners unless a request is made.

(2)        One copy to the Commission.

(3)        One copy to the Clerk of the Supreme Court and to the Clerk of the Court of Appeals of North Carolina.

(4)        One copy to the Supreme Court Library and one copy to the library of the Court of Appeals.

(5)        One copy to the Administrative Office of the Courts.

(6)        One copy to the Governor.

(7)        One copy to the Legislative Services Commission for the use of the General Assembly.

(8)        Repealed by Session Laws 2002‑97, s. 1, effective August 29, 2002.

(9)        One copy to the Division of State Library of the Department of Cultural Resources pursuant to G.S. 125‑11.7."

 

PART XIX‑a. Office of State Budget and Management

 

TRANSFER STATE FIRE PROTECTION GRANT FUND

SECTION 19A.1.  Article 85A of Chapter 58 of the General Statutes reads as rewritten:

"Article 85A.

"State Fire Protection Grant Fund.

"§ 58‑85A‑1.  Creation of Fund; allocation to local fire districts and political subdivisions of the State.

(a)        There is created in the Office of State Budget and ManagementDepartment of Insurance the State Fire Protection Grant Fund. The purpose of the Fund is to compensate local fire districts and political subdivisions of the State for providing local fire protection to State‑owned buildings and their contents.

(b)        The Office of State Budget and ManagementDepartment of Insurance shall develop and implement an equitable and uniform statewide method for distributing any funds to the State's local fire districts and political subdivisions.

Upon the request of the Director of the Budget, the Department of Insurance shall provide the Office of State Budget and Management all information necessary to develop and implement the formula.

(c)        It is the intent of the General Assembly to appropriate annually to the State Fire Protection Grant Fund up to four million one hundred eighty thousand dollars ($4,180,000)four million sixty‑eight thousand one hundred twenty‑five dollars ($4,068,125) from the General Fund, one hundred fifty‑eight thousand dollars ($158,000) from the Highway Fund, and one million three hundred forty‑five thousand dollars ($1,345,000) from University of North Carolina receipts. Funds received from the General Fund shall be allocated only for providing local fire protection for State‑owned property supported by the General Fund; funds received from the Highway Fund shall be allocated only for providing local fire protection for State‑owned property supported by the Highway Fund; and funds received from University of North Carolina receipts shall be allocated only for providing local fire protection for State‑owned property supported by University of North Carolina receipts."

 

CONSOLIDATION AND EFFICIENCY INCENTIVE FUND

SECTION 19A.2.(a)  There is established in the Office of State Budget and Management a General Fund reserve for the purpose of providing one‑time incentive payments to local governments and State‑funded nonprofit organizations that consolidate, streamline, and make more efficient the public functions and services conducted on behalf of the State. This may include Local Education Agencies in the public school system; Local Management Entities in mental health, public health, and public safety services; and regional economic development partnerships.

SECTION 19A.2.(b)  The Director of the Budget shall allocate funds appropriated in this act to the Consolidation and Efficiency Incentive Fund to local governments and State‑funded nonprofit organizations as an incentive to encourage the voluntary reorganization, consolidation, or regionalization of public functions and services where the State, local governments, and nonprofit groups have shared responsibilities.  A one‑time payment will be made based on the savings generated by the consolidating agencies. Savings may be generated through the reduction of positions and layers of management or through reduced operating costs due to more efficient practices and use of existing office space and resources. Prior to any disbursement of funds, savings must be verified by the Office of State Budget and Management.

SECTION 19A.2.(c)  The Office of State Budget and Management can utilize up to one percent (1%) of these funds to hire contracted staff to perform the following duties:

(1)        Develop policies and procedures for implementation of the Consolidation and Efficiency Incentive Fund as set forth above.

(2)        Verify savings submitted by local governments and State‑funded nonprofit entities.

SECTION 19A.2.(d)  Funds appropriated in this act shall remain available for the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium. Funds not encumbered by June 30, 2013, shall revert to the General Fund.

 

INTERNAL AUDITING ACT

SECTION 19A.3.  Article 79 of Chapter 143 of the General Statutes reads as rewritten:

"§ 143‑745.  Definitions; intent; applicability.

(a)        For the purposes of this section:

(1)        "Agency head" means the Governor, a Council of State member, a cabinet secretary, a director, an executive director, the President of The University of North Carolina, the Chairman of the Employment Security Commission, the State Controller, the Chief Information Officer, the Executive Administrator of the State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees, and the Superintendent of Public Instruction.

(2)        "State agency" means each department or entity created pursuant to Chapter 143A or 143B of the General Statutes, The University of North Carolina, the North Carolina State Board of Elections, the State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees, the Office of Information Technology Services, the Employment Security Commission of North Carolina, the North Carolina Housing Finance Agency, the North Carolina Education Lottery, and the Department of Public Instruction.

(b)        This Article applies only to a State agency that:

(1)        Has an annual operating budget that exceeds ten million dollars ($10,000,000);

(2)        Has more than 100 full‑time equivalent employees; or

(3)        Receives and processes more than ten million dollars ($10,000,000) in cash in a fiscal year.

"§ 143‑746.  Internal auditing required.

(a)        Requirements. – A State agency shall establish a program of internal auditing that:

(1)        Implements Promotes an effective system of internal controls that safeguards public funds and assets and minimizes incidences of fraud, waste, and abuse.

(2)        Ensures Determines whether programs and business operations are administered in compliance with federal and state laws, regulations, and other requirements.

(3)        Reviews the effectiveness and efficiency of agency and program operations and service delivery.

(4)        Periodically audits the agency's major systems and controls, including:

a.         Accounting systems and controls.

b.         Administrative systems and controls.

c.         Electronic data processing Information technology systems and controls.

(b)        Internal Audit Standards. – Internal audits shall comply with current Standards for the Professional Practice of Internal Auditing issued by the Institute for Internal Auditors or, if appropriate, Government Auditing Standards issued by the Comptroller General of the United States.

(c)        Appointment and Qualifications of Internal Auditors. – Any internal auditor employed by a State agency shall at a minimum have a bachelor's degree from an accredited college or university and: Any State employee who performs the internal audit function shall meet the minimum qualifications for internal auditors established by the Office of State Personnel.

(1)        Certification or licensure as a certified public accountant, certified internal auditor, certified fraud examiner, certified information systems auditor, professional engineer, or attorney; or

(2)        A minimum of five years' experience in internal or external auditing, management consulting, program evaluation, management analysis, economic analysis, industrial engineering, or operations research.

(d)        Director of Internal Auditing. – The agency head shall appoint a Director of Internal Auditing who shall report to the agency head and shall not report to any employee subordinate to the agency head.head; deputy agency head; or the agency governing board, or subcommittee thereof, if such a governing board exists. The Director of Internal Auditing shall be organizationally situated in a manner that avoids impairments to independence as defined in the Standards referenced in G.S. 143‑746(b).

"§ 143‑747.  Council of Internal Auditing.

(a)        The Council of Internal Auditing is created, consisting of the following members:

(1)        The State Controller who shall serve as Chair.

(2)        The State Budget Officer.

(3)        The Secretary of Administration.

(4)        The Attorney General.

(5)        The Secretary of Revenue.

(6)        The State Auditor who shall serve as a nonvoting member. The State Auditor may appoint a designee.

(6)        The President of The University of North Carolina, who may appoint a designee.

(7)        The State Auditor, who shall serve as a nonvoting member. The State Auditor may appoint a designee.

(b)        The Council shall be supported by the Office of State Budget and Management.

(c)        The Council shall:

(1)        Hold its first meeting before November 1, 2007, and thereafter at the call of the Chair or upon written request to the Chair by two members of the Council.

(2)        Keep minutes of all proceedings.

(3)        Promulgate guidelines for the uniformity and quality of State agency internal audit activities.

(4)        Recommend the number of internal audit employees required by each State agency.

(5)        Develop internal audit guides, technical manuals, and suggested best internal audit practices.

(6)        Administer an independent peer review system for each State agency internal audit activity; specify the frequency of such reviews consistent with applicable national standards; and assist agencies with selection of independent peer reviewers from other State agencies.

(7)        Provide central training sessions, professional development opportunities, and recognition programs for internal auditors.

(8)        Administer a program for sharing internal auditors among State agencies needing temporary assistance and assembly of interagency teams of internal auditors to conduct internal audits beyond the capacity of a single agency.

(9)        Maintain a central database of all annual internal audit plans; topics for review proposed by internal audit plans; internal audit reports issued and individual findings and recommendations from those reports.

(10)      Require reports in writing from any State agency relative to any internal audit matter.

(11)      If determined necessary by a majority vote of the council:

a.         Conduct hearings relative to any attempts to interfere with, compromise, or intimidate an internal auditor.

b.         Inquire as to the effectiveness of any internal audit unit.

c.         Authorize the Chair to issue subpoenas for the appearance of any person or internal audit working papers, report drafts, and any other pertinent document or record regardless of physical form needed for the hearing.

(12)      Issue an annual report including, but not limited to, service efforts and accomplishments of State agency internal auditors and to propose legislation for consideration by the Governor and General Assembly."

 

PART XIX‑B. Department of cultural Resources

 

NORTH CAROLINA TRANSPORTATION MUSEUM

SECTION 19B.1.  The North Carolina Transportation Museum Fund is created as a special interest‑bearing, nonreverting enterprise fund in the Department of Cultural Resources. The Fund shall be used to pay all costs associated with the operation and maintenance of the North Carolina Transportation Museum.

Notwithstanding Chapter 146 of the General Statutes, all receipts derived from the lease, rental, or other disposition of structures or products of the land, as well as all admissions and fees, gifts, donations, grants, and bequests shall be credited to the Fund. The Fund shall be credited with interest by the State Treasurer pursuant to G.S. 147‑69.2 and G.S. 147‑69.3.

The Department of Cultural Resources shall establish, out of existing unobligated funds such as lapsed salaries and/or unobligated special funds, an emergency reserve fund in the amount of three hundred thousand dollars ($300,000). Any use of the emergency reserve will require reimbursement from museum receipts. The fund shall be subject to the oversight of the State Auditor pursuant to Article 5A of Chapter 147 of the General Statutes. The fund shall reimburse the Office of the State Auditor for the cost of any audit.

 

PART XX. Department of Transportation

 

CASH FLOW HIGHWAY FUND AND HIGHWAY TRUST FUND APPROPRIATIONS

SECTION 20.1.(a)  The General Assembly authorizes and certifies anticipated revenues of the Highway Fund as follows:

For Fiscal Year 2013‑2014                                     $1,996.5 million

For Fiscal Year 2014‑2015                                     $2,021.1 million

For Fiscal Year 2015‑2016                                     $2,040.5 million

For Fiscal Year 2016‑2017                                     $2,069.1 million

SECTION 20.1.(b)  The General Assembly authorizes and certifies anticipated revenues of the Highway Trust Fund as follows:

For Fiscal Year 2013‑2014                                     $1,041.0 million

For Fiscal Year 2014‑2015                                     $1,097.5 million

For Fiscal Year 2015‑2016                                     $1,128.7 million

For Fiscal Year 2016‑2017                                     $1,122.8 million

 

PART XXI. Salaries and Benefits

 

PUBLIC EMPLOYEE SALARIES

SECTION 21.1.(a)  The salaries of those officers and employees, whose salaries for the 2008‑2009 fiscal year were set or increased in Sections 26.1, 26.2, 26.3, 26.4, 26.5, 26.6, 26.7, 26.8, 26.9, 26.10, 26.11, 26.11A, 26.12, 26.12D, 26.13, 26.14, 26.18, and 26.19 of S.L. 2008‑107, and in effect on June 30, 2009, or the last date in pay status during the 2008‑2009 fiscal year if earlier, shall remain in effect and shall not increase for the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years, except:

(1)        As provided for by Section 29.20A of S.L. 2005‑276.

(2)        For Community College faculty as otherwise provided in Section 8.1 of S.L. 2009‑451.

(3)        For University of North Carolina faculty as otherwise provided by the Faculty Recruiting and Retention Fund, the Distinguished Professors Endowment Fund, or retention adjustments funded from available non‑State funding sources.

(3a)      For Judicial Department employees for local supplementation as authorized under G.S. 7A‑300.1

(4)        Salaries may be increased for reallocations or promotions, in‑range adjustments for job change, career progression adjustments for demonstrated competencies, or any other adjustment related to an increase in job duties or responsibilities, none of which are subject to the salary freeze otherwise provided by this subsection. All other salary increases are prohibited.

SECTION 21.1.(b)  The automatic salary step increases for assistant and deputy clerks of superior court and magistrates are suspended for the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years.

SECTION 21.1.(c)  The salary increase provisions of G.S. 20‑187.3 are suspended for the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years.

SECTION 21.1.(d)  For the 2011‑2012 and 2012‑2013 fiscal years, the salaries of members and officers of the General Assembly shall remain the amounts set under G.S. 120‑3 in 1994 by the 1993 General Assembly.

 

TEACHER SALARY SCHEDULES

SECTION 21.2.(a)  The following monthly salary schedules shall apply for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year to certified personnel of the public schools who are classified as teachers.  The schedules contain 35 steps, with each step corresponding to one year of teaching experience. Public school employees paid according to this salary schedule and receiving NBPTS certification or obtaining a master's degree shall not be prohibited from receiving the appropriate increase in salary. Provided, however, teachers employed during the 2010‑2011 school year who did not work the required number of months to acquire an additional year of experience shall not receive a decrease in salary as otherwise would be required by the salary schedule below.

 

2011‑2012 Monthly Salary Schedule

"A" Teachers

         Years of Experience                       "A" Teachers                      NBPTS Certification

                      0                                           $3,043                                       N/A

                      1                                           $3,043                                       N/A

                      2                                           $3,043                                       N/A

                      3                                           $3,043                                       N/A

                      4                                           $3,085                                     $3,455

                      5                                           $3,129                                     $3,504

                      6                                           $3,264                                     $3,656

                      7                                           $3,404                                     $3,812

                      8                                           $3,538                                     $3,963

                      9                                           $3,667                                     $4,107

                    10                                           $3,771                                     $4,224

                    11                                           $3,819                                     $4,277

                    12                                           $3,868                                     $4,332

                    13                                           $3,918                                     $4,388

                    14                                           $3,967                                     $4,443

                    15                                           $4,018                                     $4,500

                    16                                           $4,069                                     $4,557

                    17                                           $4,122                                     $4,617

                    18                                           $4,176                                     $4,677

                    19                                           $4,231                                     $4,739

                    20                                           $4,286                                     $4,800

                    21                                           $4,345                                     $4,866

                    22                                           $4,403                                     $4,931

                    23                                           $4,461                                     $4,996

                    24                                           $4,523                                     $5,066

                    25                                           $4,584                                     $5,134

                    26                                           $4,650                                     $5,208

                    27                                           $4,714                                     $5,280

                    28                                           $4,779                                     $5,352

                    29                                           $4,845                                     $5,426

                    30                                           $4,913                                     $5,503

                    31                                           $4,984                                     $5,582

                    32                                           $5,055                                     $5,662

                    33                                           $5,153                                     $5,771

                    34+                                         $5,255                                     $5,886

 

2011‑2012 Monthly Salary Schedule

"M" Teachers

         Years of Experience                      "M" Teachers                      NBPTS Certification

                      0                                           $3,347                                       N/A

                      1                                           $3,347                                       N/A

                      2                                           $3,347                                       N/A

                      3                                           $3,347                                       N/A

                      4                                           $3,394                                     $3,801

                      5                                           $3,442                                     $3,855

                      6                                           $3,590                                     $4,021

                      7                                           $3,744                                     $4,193

                      8                                           $3,892                                     $4,359

                      9                                           $4,034                                     $4,518

                    10                                           $4,148                                     $4,646

                    11                                           $4,201                                     $4,705

                    12                                           $4,255                                     $4,766

                    13                                           $4,310                                     $4,827

                    14                                           $4,364                                     $4,888

                    15                                           $4,420                                     $4,950

                    16                                           $4,476                                     $5,013

                    17                                           $4,534                                     $5,078

                    18                                           $4,594                                     $5,145

                    19                                           $4,654                                     $5,212

                    20                                           $4,715                                     $5,281

                    21                                           $4,780                                     $5,354

                    22                                           $4,843                                     $5,424

                    23                                           $4,907                                     $5,496

                    24                                           $4,975                                     $5,572

                    25                                           $5,042                                     $5,647

                    26                                           $5,115                                     $5,729

                    27                                           $5,185                                     $5,807

                    28                                           $5,257                                     $5,888

                    29                                           $5,330                                     $5,970

                    30                                           $5,404                                     $6,052

                    31                                           $5,482                                     $6,140

                    32                                           $5,561                                     $6,228

                    33                                           $5,668                                     $6,348

                    34+                                         $5,781                                     $6,475

SECTION 21.2.(b)  Annual longevity payments for teachers shall be at the rate of one and one‑half percent (1.5%) of base salary for 10 to 14 years of State service, two and twenty‑five hundredths percent (2.25%) of base salary for 15 to 19 years of State service, three and twenty‑five hundredths percent (3.25%) of base salary for 20 to 24 years of State service, and four and one‑half percent (4.5%) of base salary for 25 or more years of State service.  The longevity payment shall be paid in a lump sum once a year.

SECTION 21.2.(c)  Certified public schoolteachers with certification based on academic preparation at the six‑year degree level shall receive a salary supplement of one hundred twenty‑six dollars ($126.00) per month in addition to the compensation provided for certified personnel of the public schools who are classified as "M" teachers.  Certified public schoolteachers with certification based on academic preparation at the doctoral degree level shall receive a salary supplement of two hundred fifty‑three dollars ($253.00) per month in addition to the compensation provided for certified personnel of the public schools who are classified as "M" teachers.

SECTION 21.2.(d)  The first step of the salary schedule for school psychologists shall be equivalent to Step 6, corresponding to six years of experience, on the salary schedule established in this section for certified personnel of the public schools who are classified as "M" teachers.  Certified psychologists shall be placed on the salary schedule at an appropriate step based on their years of experience.  Certified psychologists shall receive longevity payments based on years of State service in the same manner as teachers.

Certified psychologists with certification based on academic preparation at the six‑year degree level shall receive a salary supplement of one hundred twenty‑six dollars ($126.00) per month in addition to the compensation provided for certified psychologists. Certified psychologists with certification based on academic preparation at the doctoral degree level shall receive a salary supplement of two hundred fifty‑three dollars ($253.00) per month in addition to the compensation provided for certified psychologists.

SECTION 21.2.(e)  Speech pathologists who are certified as speech pathologists at the master's degree level and audiologists who are certified as audiologists at the master's degree level and who are employed in the public schools as speech and language specialists and audiologists shall be paid on the school psychologist salary schedule.

Speech pathologists and audiologists with certification based on academic preparation at the six‑year degree level shall receive a salary supplement of one hundred twenty‑six dollars ($126.00) per month in addition to the compensation provided for speech pathologists and audiologists. Speech pathologists and audiologists with certification based on academic preparation at the doctoral degree level shall receive a salary supplement of two hundred fifty‑three dollars ($253.00) per month in addition to the compensation provided for speech pathologists and audiologists.

SECTION 21.2.(f)  Certified school nurses who are employed in the public schools as nurses shall be paid on the "M" salary schedule.

SECTION 21.2.(g)  As used in this section, the term "teacher" shall also include instructional support personnel.

 

SCHOOL‑BASED ADMINISTRATOR SALARY SCHEDULE

SECTION 21.3.(a)  The following base salary schedule for school‑based administrators shall apply only to principals and assistant principals.  This base salary schedule shall apply for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, commencing July 1, 2011. Provided, however, school‑based administrators (i) employed during the 2010‑2011 school year who did not work the required number of months to acquire an additional year of experience and (ii) employed during the 2011‑2012 school year in the same classification shall not receive a decrease in salary as otherwise would be required by the salary schedule below.

 

2011‑2012 Principal and Assistant Principal Salary Schedules

Classification

Years of Exp         Assistant               Prin I                Prin II             Prin III            Prin IV

                             Principal               (0‑10)              (11‑21)          (22‑32)           (33‑43)

          0‑7                $3,781                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑                      ‑

          8                   $3,931                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑                      ‑

          9                   $4,074                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑                      ‑

        10                   $4,189                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑                      ‑

        11                   $4,243                $4,243                       ‑                     ‑                      ‑

        12                   $4,298                $4,298                       ‑                     ‑                      ‑

        13                   $4,353                $4,353             $4,408                     ‑                      ‑

        14                   $4,408                $4,408             $4,464                     ‑                      ‑

        15                   $4,464                $4,464             $4,521            $4,579                      ‑

        16                   $4,521                $4,521             $4,579            $4,640            $4,701

        17                   $4,579                $4,579             $4,640            $4,701            $4,762

        18                   $4,640                $4,640             $4,701            $4,762            $4,828

        19                   $4,701                $4,701             $4,762            $4,828            $4,891

        20                   $4,762                $4,762             $4,828            $4,891            $4,956

        21                   $4,828                $4,828             $4,891            $4,956            $5,025

        22                   $4,891                $4,891             $4,956            $5,025            $5,092

        23                   $4,956                $4,956             $5,025            $5,092            $5,166

        24                   $5,025                $5,025             $5,092            $5,166            $5,237

        25                   $5,092                $5,092             $5,166            $5,237            $5,310

        26                   $5,166                $5,166             $5,237            $5,310            $5,383

        27                   $5,237                $5,237             $5,310            $5,383            $5,458

        28                   $5,310                $5,310             $5,383            $5,458            $5,537

        29                   $5,383                $5,383             $5,458            $5,537            $5,617

        30                   $5,458                $5,458             $5,537            $5,617            $5,725

        31                   $5,537                $5,537             $5,617            $5,725            $5,839

        32                   $5,617                $5,617             $5,725            $5,839            $5,956

        33                   $5,725                $5,725             $5,839            $5,956            $6,075

        34                   $5,839                $5,839             $5,956            $6,075            $6,197

        35                             ‑                $5,956             $6,075            $6,197            $6,321

        36                             ‑                          ‑             $6,197            $6,321            $6,447

        37                             ‑                          ‑             $6,321            $6,447            $6,576

        38                             ‑                          ‑                       ‑            $6,576            $6,708

        39                             ‑                          ‑                       ‑            $6,708            $6,842

        40                             ‑                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑            $6,979

 

2011‑2012 Principal and Assistant Principal Salary Schedules

Classification

Years of Exp         Prin V                   Prin VI             Prin VII          Prin VIII

                             (44‑54)                (55‑65)            (66‑100)        (101+)

          0‑17              $4,828                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑

        18                   $4,891                          ‑                       ‑                     ‑

        19                   $4,956                $5,025                       ‑                     ‑

        20                   $5,025                $5,092             $5,237                     ‑

        21                   $5,092                $5,166             $5,310            $5,383

        22                   $5,166                $5,237             $5,383            $5,458

        23                   $5,237                $5,310             $5,458            $5,537

        24                   $5,310                $5,383             $5,537            $5,617

        25                   $5,383                $5,458             $5,617            $5,725

        26                   $5,458                $5,537             $5,725            $5,839

        27                   $5,537                $5,617             $5,839            $5,956

        28                   $5,617                $5,725             $5,956            $6,075

        29                   $5,725                $5,839             $6,075            $6,197

        30                   $5,839                $5,956             $6,197            $6,321

        31                   $5,956                $6,075             $6,321            $6,447

        32                   $6,075                $6,197             $6,447            $6,576

        33                   $6,197                $6,321             $6,576            $6,708

        34                   $6,321                $6,447             $6,708            $6,842

        35                   $6,447                $6,576             $6,842            $6,979

        36                   $6,576                $6,708             $6,979            $7,119

        37                   $6,708                $6,842             $7,119            $7,261

        38                   $6,842                $6,979             $7,261            $7,406

        39                   $6,979                $7,119             $7,406            $7,554

        40                   $7,119                $7,261             $7,554            $7,705

        41                   $7,261                $7,406             $7,705            $7,859

        42                             ‑                $7,554             $7,859            $8,016

        43                             ‑                $7,705             $8,016            $8,176

        44                             ‑                          ‑             $8,176            $8,340

 

SECTION 21.3.(b)  The appropriate classification for placement of principals and assistant principals on the salary schedule, except for principals in alternative schools and in cooperative innovative high schools, shall be determined in accordance with the following schedule:

Number of Teachers

Classification                                              Supervised

 

Assistant Principal

Principal I                                             Fewer than 11 Teachers

Principal II                                            11‑21 Teachers

Principal III                                          22‑32 Teachers

Principal IV                                          33‑43 Teachers

Principal V                                           44‑54 Teachers

Principal VI                                          55‑65 Teachers

Principal VII                                         66‑100 Teachers

Principal VIII                                        More than 100 Teachers

 

The number of teachers supervised includes teachers and assistant principals paid from State funds only; it does not include teachers or assistant principals paid from non‑State funds or the principal or teacher assistants.

The beginning classification for principals in alternative schools and in cooperative innovative high school programs shall be the Principal III level. Principals in alternative schools who supervise 33 or more teachers shall be classified according to the number of teachers supervised.

SECTION 21.3.(c)  A principal shall be placed on the step on the salary schedule that reflects total number of years of experience as a certificated employee of the public schools and an additional step for every three years of experience as a principal. Provided, however, a principal who acquires an additional step for the 2011‑2012 or 2012‑2013 fiscal years shall not receive a corresponding increase in salary during the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium. A principal or assistant principal shall also continue to receive any additional State‑funded percentage increases earned for the 1997‑1998, 1998‑1999, and 1999‑2000 school years for improvement in student performance or maintaining a safe and orderly school.

SECTION 21.3.(d)  Principals and assistant principals with certification based on academic preparation at the six‑year degree level shall be paid a salary supplement of one hundred twenty‑six dollars ($126.00) per month and at the doctoral degree level shall be paid a salary supplement of two hundred fifty‑three dollars ($253.00) per month.

SECTION 21.3.(e)  Longevity pay for principals and assistant principals shall be as provided for State employees under the State Personnel Act.

SECTION 21.3.(f)  If a principal is reassigned to a higher job classification because the principal is transferred to a school within a local school administrative unit with a larger number of State‑allotted teachers, the principal shall be placed on the salary schedule as if the principal had served the principal's entire career as a principal at the higher job classification.

If a principal is reassigned to a lower job classification because the principal is transferred to a school within a local school administrative unit with a smaller number of State‑allotted teachers, the principal shall be placed on the salary schedule as if the principal had served the principal's entire career as a principal at the lower job classification.

This subsection applies to all transfers on or after the effective date of this section, except transfers in school systems that have been created, or will be created, by merging two or more school systems. Transfers in these merged systems are exempt from the provisions of this subsection for one calendar year following the date of the merger.

SECTION 21.3.(g)  Participants in an approved full‑time master's in school administration program shall receive up to a 10‑month stipend at the beginning salary of an assistant principal during the internship period of the master's program.  For the 2006‑2007 fiscal year and subsequent fiscal years, the stipend shall not exceed the difference between the beginning salary of an assistant principal plus the cost of tuition, fees, and books and any fellowship funds received by the intern as a full‑time student, including awards of the Principal Fellows Program. The Principal Fellows Program or the school of education where the intern participates in a full‑time master's in school administration program shall supply the Department of Public Instruction with certification of eligible full‑time interns.

SECTION 21.3.(h)  During the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, the placement on the salary schedule of an administrator with a one‑year provisional assistant principal's certificate shall be at the entry‑level salary for an assistant principal or the appropriate step on the teacher salary schedule, whichever is higher.

 

MONITOR COMPLIANCE WITH FREEZE ON MOST SALARY INCREASES

SECTION 21.4.(a)  The Office of State Budget and Management and the Office of State Personnel shall monitor jointly the compliance of the following units of government with the provisions of Section 26.1A of S.L. 2009‑451, and shall continue to submit quarterly reports of their monitoring activities to the President Pro Tempore of the Senate, the Speaker of the House of Representatives, and the Fiscal Research Division: (i) State agencies, departments, and institutions, including authorities, boards, and commissions; (ii) the judicial branch; and (iii) The University of North Carolina and its constituent institutions.

The quarterly reports required by this section shall include the following information:

(1)        For agencies reporting through the BEACON HR/Payroll system, (i) a breakdown by action type (including promotion, reallocation, career progression, salary adjustment, and any similar actions increasing employee pay) of the number and annual amount of those increases and (ii) a breakdown by action reason (including in‑range higher level, acting pay, trainee adjustment, and other similar action reasons) of the number and annual amount of those action types coded as salary adjustment.

(2)        For The University of North Carolina and its constituent institutions, a breakdown of the number and annual amount of those increases categorized by the University as promotions, changes in job duties or responsibilities, Distinguished Professorships, retention pay, career progression, and any similar actions increasing employee pay.

(3)        A summary of actions taken by the Office of State Budget and Management and the Office of State Personnel with respect to unauthorized salary increases.

SECTION 21.4.(b)  Beginning September 1, 2010, and quarterly thereafter, the Legislative Services Officer shall report to the President Pro Tempore of the Senate and the Speaker of the House of Representatives on compliance with Section 26.1A of S.L. 2009‑451.

 

SALARY‑RELATED CONTRIBUTIONS/EMPLOYER

SECTION 21.5.(a)  Effective July 1, 2011, the State's employer contribution rates budgeted for retirement and related benefits as percentage of covered salaries for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year are:  (i) eleven and sixty‑two hundredths percent (11.62%) – Teachers and State Employees; (ii) sixteen and sixty‑two hundredths percent (16.62%) – State Law Enforcement Officers; (iii) twelve and twenty‑six hundredths percent (12.26%) – University Employees' Optional Retirement System; (iv) twelve and twenty‑six hundredths percent (12.26%) – Community College Optional Retirement Program; (v) twenty and one hundredths percent (20.01%) – Consolidated Judicial Retirement System; and (vi) four and ninety hundredths percent (4.90%) – Legislative Retirement System. Each of the foregoing contribution rates includes four and ninety hundredths percent (4.90%) for hospital and medical benefits. The rate for Teachers and State Employees, State Law Enforcement Officers, Community College Optional Retirement Program, and for the University Employees' Optional Retirement Program includes fifty‑two hundredths percent (0.52%) for the Disability Income Plan. The rates for Teachers and State Employees and State Law Enforcement Officers include sixteen hundredths percent (0.16%) for the Death Benefits Plan. The rate for State Law Enforcement Officers includes five percent (5%) for Supplemental Retirement Income."

SECTION 21.5.(b)  Effective July 1, 2012, the State's employer contribution rates budgeted for retirement and related benefits as percentage of covered salaries for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year are:  (i) twelve and seventy‑three hundredths percent (12.73%) – Teachers and State Employees; (ii) seventeen and seventy‑three hundredths percent (17.73%) – State Law Enforcement Officers; (iii) twelve and twenty‑six hundredths percent (12.26%) – University Employees' Optional Retirement System; (iv) twelve and twenty‑six hundredths percent (12.26%) – Community College Optional Retirement Program; (v) twenty and one hundredths percent (20.01%)  – Consolidated Judicial Retirement System; and (vi) four and ninety hundredths percent (4.90%) – Legislative Retirement System. Each of the foregoing contribution rates includes four and ninety hundredths percent (4.90%) for hospital and medical benefits. The rate for Teachers and State Employees, State Law Enforcement Officers, Community College Optional Retirement Program, and for the University Employees' Optional Retirement Program includes fifty‑two hundredths percent (0.52%) for the Disability Income Plan. The rates for Teachers and State Employees and State Law Enforcement Officers include sixteen hundredths percent (0.16%) for the Death Benefits Plan. The rate for State Law Enforcement Officers includes five percent (5%) for Supplemental Retirement Income.

SECTION 21.5.(c)  Effective July 1, 2011, the maximum annual employer contributions, payable monthly, by the State for each covered employee or retiree for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year to the State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees are:  (i) Medicare‑eligible employees and retirees – three thousand twenty‑nine dollars ($3,929) and (ii) non‑Medicare‑eligible employees and retirees –  five thousand one hundred sixty‑one dollars ($5,161).

SECTION 21.5.(d)  Effective July 1, 2012, the maximum annual employer contributions, payable monthly, by the State for each covered employee or retiree for the 2012‑2013 fiscal year to the State Health Plan for Teachers and State Employees are: (i) Medicare‑eligible employees and retirees – four thousand one hundred fourteen dollars ($4,114) and (ii) non‑Medicare‑eligible employees and retirees – five thousand four hundred four dollars ($5,404).

SECTION 21.5.(e)  Effective July 1, 2012, monthly payments made to the State Health Plan in accordance with subsections 6(d) and 6(e) shall be reduced by the amount of monthly premiums charged in subsection 1(a) of this section for employee and retiree‑only tiers in the PPO Standard 80/20 Plan.

 

HEALTH BENEFIT CHANGES

SECTION 21.6.  Effective July 1, 2011, (i) non‑Medicare‑eligible employees and retirees who remain in the PPO Standard 80/20 Plan shall pay a monthly premium of twenty‑one dollars and fifty cents ($21.50) for individual coverage and (ii) Medicare‑eligible employees and retirees who remain in the PPO Standard Plan shall pay a monthly premium of sixteen dollars ($16.00) for individual coverage.

 

EMPLOYEE RETIREMENT INCENTIVE PROGRAM

SECTION 21.7.(a)  Except as provided by subsections (g), (h), and (i) of this section, any person (i) who is a full‑time permanent employee of the State, UNC System, community college institution, or a local board of education between July 1, 2011, and January 1, 2012;  (ii) who is a member of the Teachers' and State Employees' Retirement System, Consolidated Judicial Retirement System, or Optional Retirement Program (ORP); and (iii) who no later than September 1, 2011, submits an application to the Office of State Treasurer, Retirement Systems Division, and notifies his or her employing entity of his or her intent to retire by no later than an effective date of January 1, 2012, may be eligible to receive a onetime incentive as described in subsections (b) through (i) of this section.

SECTION 21.7.(b)  Those employees who are eligible to retire with unreduced benefits as defined by the statutes administered by the Retirement Systems Division (RSD) between July 1, 2011, and January 1, 2012, may receive a onetime ten thousand dollar ($10,000) incentive.

SECTION 21.7.(c)  Those employees who are eligible to retire with reduced benefits as defined by statutes administered by the RSD between July 1, 2011, and January 1, 2012, may receive a onetime twenty thousand dollar ($20,000) incentive.

SECTION 21.7.(d)  The onetime incentive shall not be included in the calculation of an employee's average final contribution for retirement purposes.

SECTION 21.7.(e)  Retirees who participate in this program may not be reemployed by any unit participating in the Teachers' and State Employees' Retirement System, Consolidated Judicial Retirement System, or ORP within two years of retiring under the provisions of this program.

SECTION 21.7.(f)  Savings reserves achieved by State agencies and institutions through this program (i) shall be used to meet salary and associated benefit reduction allocations, with priority placed on eliminating the estimated number of positions vacated through this program and (ii) must be fully met by June 30, 2012.

SECTION 21.7.(g)  Incentive benefits for employees shall be paid from the same funding source as the source of the employees' salary, to the extent allowed by such funding source. If an employee's salary is paid in part from the General Fund or Highway Fund and in part from department, office, institution, or agency receipts, the incentive benefit may be paid from the General Fund or Highway Fund only to the extent of the proportionate part paid from the General Fund or Highway Fund in support of the salary of the employee, and the remainder of the incentive benefit shall be paid from the source that supplies the remainder of the employee's salary.

SECTION 21.7.(h)  Participation in the program is subject to funding availability:

(1)        Agencies and institutions may limit participation in the program by demonstrating that the agency has achieved the necessary salary and position reduction targets identified by the Office of State Budget and Management.

(2)        Incentive benefits shall be paid from personal service line items unless the agency or institution has requested an exception from the Office of State Budget and Management.

SECTION 21.7.(i)  The following persons are not eligible for the Employee Retirement Incentive Program authorized by this section:

(1)        Any employee or officer who is not currently a member of the Teachers' and State Employees' Retirement System, Consolidated Judicial Retirement System, or ORP.

(2)        Any employee whose effective retirement date is after January 1, 2012.

(3)        Any employee whose effective retirement or other separation date is on or before July 1, 2011.

(4)        Any employee whose position will no longer be funded on or after July 1, 2011.

(5)        Any employee who will receive salary continuation payments under a Reduction in Force (RIF) or who receives a Discontinued Service Retirement or other severance agreement between July 1, 2011, and January 1, 2012.

(6)        Individuals who have already retired from an employing entity participating in the Teachers' and State Employees' Retirement System, Consolidated Judicial Retirement System, or ORP.

SECTION 21.7.(j)  Notwithstanding any other provision of law, The University of North Carolina may use funds from any available source in the 2011‑2012 fiscal year and the 2012‑2013 fiscal year to implement a voluntary faculty separation incentive program. All savings realized by this program shall be retained by The University of North Carolina.

 

PART XXII. Capital Appropriations

 

GENERAL FUND CAPITAL APPROPRIATIONS/INTRODUCTION

SECTION 22.1.  The appropriations made by the 2011 General Assembly for capital improvements are for constructing, repairing, or renovating State buildings, utilities, and other capital facilities, for acquiring sites for them where necessary, and acquiring buildings and land for State government purposes.

 

CAPITAL APPROPRIATIONS/GENERAL FUND

SECTION 22.2.  There is appropriated from the General Fund for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year the following amount for capital improvements:

 

Capital Improvements – General Fund                                                                      2011‑2012

 

Department of Environment and Natural Resources

      Water Resources Development Projects                                                                   $ 4,535,000

 

TOTAL CAPITAL IMPROVEMENTS – GENERAL FUND                                 $ 4,535,000

 

WATER RESOURCES DEVELOPMENT PROJECT FUNDS

SECTION 22.3.(a)  The Department of Environment and Natural Resources shall allocate the funds appropriated in this act for water resources development projects in accordance with the schedule that follows. These funds will provide a State match for an estimated twenty‑three million four hundred forty‑nine thousand dollars ($23,449,000) in federal funds.

 

                  Name of Project                                                                                                    2011‑2012

 

      (1)        B. Everett Jordan Lake Water Supply Storage                                              $    200,000

      (2)        Wilmington Harbor Maintenance                                                                                    0

      (3)        Morehead City Harbor Maintenance                                                                     50,000

      (4)        Water Resources Planning in support of S.L. 2010‑143                                                 0

      (5)        John H. Kerr Dam and Reservoir Sec. 216                                                           50,000

      (6)        Planning Assistance to Communities                                                                      50,000

      (7)        Aquatic Plant Control, Statewide, and Lake Gaston                                            100,000

      (8)        Wilmington Harbor Improvements Feasibility                                                       250,000

      (9)        Belhaven Harbor – CAP‑Sec. 1135                                                                              0

      (10)      Concord Streams, NC, Sec. 206                                                                                   0

      (11)      Manteo Old House Channel – CAP – Sec. 204                                               1,225,000

      (12)      Wilmington Harbor Deepening                                                                            300,000

      (13)      Bogue Banks Coastal Storm Damage Reduction Study                                          50,000

      (14)      West Onslow Beach (Topsail Beach) – PED                                                                  0

      (15)      Surf City/NTB Coastal Storm Damage Reduction Study – PED                            85,000

      (16)      Neuse River Basin Restoration Feasibility Study                                                  300,000

      (17)      Currituck Sound Environmental Restoration Study                                               275,000

      (18)      Princeville Flood Damage Reduction                                                                   100,000

      (19)      State – Local projects                                                                                      1,500,000

                  TOTALS                                                                                                      $4,535,000

 

SECTION 22.3.(b)  Where the actual costs are different from the estimated costs under subsection (a) of this section, the Department may adjust the allocations among projects as needed. If any projects funded under subsection (a) of this section are delayed and the budgeted State funds cannot be used during the 2011‑2012 fiscal year, or if the projects funded under subsection (a) of this section are accomplished at a lower cost, the Department may use the resulting fund availability to fund any of the following:

(1)        U.S. Army Corps of Engineers project feasibility studies.

(2)        U.S. Army Corps of Engineers projects, the schedules for which have advanced and require State‑matching funds in fiscal year 2011‑2012.

(3)        State‑local water resources development projects.

However, fund availability shall not be used to fund the North Carolina International Terminal. Funds not expended or encumbered for these purposes shall revert to the General Fund at the end of the 2012‑2013 fiscal year.

SECTION 22.3.(c)  The Department shall make semiannual reports on the use of these funds to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations, the Fiscal Research Division, and the Office of State Budget and Management. Each report shall include all of the following:

(1)        All projects listed in this section.

(2)        The estimated cost of each project.

(3)        The date that work on each project began or is expected to begin.

(4)        The date that work on each project was completed or is expected to be completed.

(5)        The actual cost of each project.

The semiannual reports shall also show those projects advanced in schedule, those projects delayed in schedule, and an estimate of the amount of funds expected to revert to the General Fund.

 

PROCEDURES FOR DISBURSEMENT OF CAPITAL FUNDS

SECTION 22.4.  The appropriations made by the 2011 General Assembly for capital improvements shall be disbursed for the purposes provided by this act. Expenditure of funds shall not be made by any State department, institution, or agency until an allotment has been approved by the Governor as Director of the Budget. The allotment shall be approved only after full compliance with the State Budget Act, Chapter 143C of the General Statutes. Prior to the award of construction contracts for projects to be financed in whole or in part with self‑liquidating appropriations, the Director of the Budget shall approve the elements of the method of financing of those projects, including the source of funds, interest rate, and liquidation period. Provided, however, that if the Director of the Budget approves the method of financing a project, the Director shall report that action to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations at its next meeting.

Where direct capital improvement appropriations include the purpose of furnishing fixed and movable equipment for any project, those funds for equipment shall not be subject to transfer into construction accounts except as authorized by the Director of the Budget. The expenditure of funds for fixed and movable equipment and furnishings shall be reviewed and approved by the Director of the Budget prior to commitment of funds.

Capital improvement projects authorized by the 2011 General Assembly shall be completed, including fixed and movable equipment and furnishings, within the limits of the amounts of the direct or self‑liquidating appropriations provided, except as otherwise provided in this act.

 

NON‑GENERAL FUND CAPITAL IMPROVEMENT AUTHORIZATIONS

SECTION 22.7.  The General Assembly authorizes the following capital projects to be funded with receipts or from other non‑General Fund sources available to the appropriate department:

 

Name of Project                                                                            Amount of Non‑General Fund

                                                                                                             Funding Authorized for

                                                                                                             Fiscal Year 2011‑2012

Department of Correction

      OSDT and DCC Search Trailer                                                                                $      45,400

      Statewide Emergency Fund for Small Storage Buildings                                                     85,000

      Statewide Emergency Fund for Visitors Registration Buildings                                          500,000

 

Department of Crime Control and Public Safety

      High Point Readiness Center – Addition/Alteration                                                       1,551,000

      Greensboro Readiness Center – Addition/Alteration                                                        306,000

      Murphy Firefighting Team Support Facility                                                                   2,946,000

      Morrisville Flight Facility Fixed Wing Hangar                                                                8,815,000

      Statewide Master Planning Support Services – Ph III                                                      125,000

      Statewide Master Planning Support Services – Ph IV                                                      100,000

      Statewide Master Planning Support Services – Ph V                                                       100,000

      Camp Butner Operations Readiness Training Center – Ph I                                          1,612,000

 

Department of Cultural Resources

      USS North Carolina Battleship Major Hull Repairs                                                      1,914,000

 

Department of Environment and Natural Resources

      Zoo – New Restrooms at Elephant/Rhino Exhibit                                                            300,000

      Aquarium – Roanoke Island Turtle Rehabilitation Center                                                 500,000

 

Wildlife Resources Commission

      Agency Land Purchases                                                                                               7,500,000

      Watha Hatchery Replacement of 3 Residences                                                                150,000

      Fishing Access Areas – New Construction                                                                      240,000

      Boating Access Areas – New Construction                                                                     800,000

      Repair & Renovations                                                                                                  1,105,000

 

TOTAL AMOUNT OF NON‑GENERAL FUND CAPITAL

PROJECTS AUTHORIZED                                                                                     $ 28,694,400

 

AGRICULTURE PLANT CONSERVATION

SECTION 22.8.  From funds deposited with the State Treasurer in a capital improvement account to the credit of the Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services pursuant to G.S. 146‑30, the sum of thirty thousand dollars ($30,000) for the 2011‑2012 fiscal year shall be transferred to the Department of Agriculture and Consumer Services to be used, notwithstanding G.S. 146‑30, by the Department for its plant conservation program under Article 19B of Chapter 106 of the General Statutes for costs incidental to the acquisition of land, such as land appraisals, land surveys, title searches, environmental studies, and for the management of the plant conservation program preserves owned by the Department.

 

CHANGE IN joint legislative commission on government operations CONSULTATION

SECTION 22.10.  G.S. 120‑76.1 reads as rewritten:

"§ 120‑76.1.  Prior consultation with the Commission.

(a)        Notwithstanding the provisions of G.S. 120‑76(8) or any other provision of law requiring prior consultation by the Governor with the Commission, whenever an expenditure is required because of an emergency that poses an imminent threat to public health or public safety, and is either the result of a natural event, such as a hurricane or a flood, or an accident, such as an explosion or a wreck, the Governor may take action without consulting the Commission if the action is determined by the Governor to be related to the emergency. The Governor shall report to the Commission on any expenditures made under this subsection no later than 30 days after making the expenditure and shall identify in the report the emergency, the type of action taken, and how it was related to the emergency.

(b)        Any agency, board, commission, or other entity required under G.S. 120‑76(8) or any other provision of law to consult with the Commission prior to taking an action shall submit a detailed report of the action under consideration to the Chairs of the Commission, the Commission Assistant, and the Fiscal Research Division of the General Assembly. If the Commission does not hold a meeting to hear the consultation within 90 days of receiving the submission of the detailed report, the consultation requirement is satisfied. With regard to capital improvement projects of The University of North Carolina, projects, if the Commission does not hold a meeting to hear the consultation within 30 days of receiving the submission of the detailed report, the consultation requirement of G.S. 120‑76(8)e. is satisfied.

(c)        Consultations regarding the establishment of new fees and charges and the increase of existing fees and charges are governed by G.S. 12‑3.1, and this section does not apply to those consultations."

 

REPAIRS AND RENOVATION RESERVE ALLOCATION

SECTION 22.11.  Of the funds in the Reserve for Repairs and Renovations for the 2011‑2012  fiscal year, fifty percent (50%) shall be allocated to the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina for repairs and renovations pursuant to G.S. 143C‑4‑3, in accordance with guidelines developed in The University of North Carolina Funding Allocation Model for Reserve for Repairs and Renovations, as approved by the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina, and fifty percent (50%) shall be allocated to the Office of State Budget and Management for repairs and renovations pursuant to G.S. 143C‑4‑3. Notwithstanding G.S. 143C‑4‑3, the Board of Governors may allocate funds for the repair and renovation of facilities not supported from the General Fund if the Board determines that sufficient funds are not available from other sources and that conditions warrant General Fund assistance. Any such finding shall be included in the Board's submission to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on the proposed allocation of funds. The Board of Governors and the Office of State Budget and Management shall report to the Joint Legislative Commission on Governmental Operations on the allocation or reallocation of these funds.

 

INFORMAL LETTING OF CONTRACTS

SECTION 22.12.  Chapter 143 of the General Statutes is amended by adding a new section to read as follows:

"§ 143‑131.1.  Informal letting of repair and renovation projects.

(a)        Notwithstanding any other provisions of law, for projects estimated to cost two million dollars ($2,000,000) or less providing for repairs or renovations to State facilities and related infrastructure that are supported from the General Fund, and where the majority of the funding for such project is to be furnished out of the Repairs and Renovations Reserve Account as otherwise provided by statute, contracts shall be let informally pursuant to procedures adopted by the North Carolina Office of State Construction after consultation with the State Building Commission.

(b)        The procedures adopted by the Office of State Construction shall include, but are not limited to, the following minimum requirements:

(1)        That the awarding authority for such contracts, including the Board of Governors of The University of North Carolina and their designees, shall solicit written quotes from at least three contractors that possess such experience, expertise, and reputation in the contracting community as the awarding authority deems sufficient in order to successfully complete the project, and such solicitations shall be directed to at least two contractors that also meet the qualifications for Resident Small Contractors set forth below.

(2)        That the awarding authority shall first negotiate with the contractor furnishing the lowest written quote, provided, however, that for purposes of selecting the contractor with which to first negotiate, any quote provided by a Resident Small Contractor that is within five percent (5%) of the lowest quote received shall be deemed to have submitted a quote equal to that low quote, and the awarding authority shall first negotiate with any such Resident Small Contractor that, in the opinion of the awarding authority, presents the best qualifications to complete the project.

(3)        That if a contract cannot be negotiated with the contractor first selected, the awarding authority shall next negotiate with any other Resident Small Contractor whose quote has been deemed equal to the lowest quote received and thereafter with any other contractor furnishing quotes, lowest first.

(4)        An illustrative description of circumstances in which the North Carolina Office of State Construction may, in its discretion, waive the use of the procedures provided in this section for other competitive procedures provided elsewhere in the General Statutes.

(5)        Provide for a waiver, in whole or in part, of Article 3 of Chapter 44A of the General Statutes regarding performance and payment of surety bonds, including such alternative provisions as may seem practicable to the North Carolina Office of State Construction aimed at providing performance and payment security to the State and to the suppliers and subcontractors on the project similar to the protections furnished pursuant to Article 3 of Chapter 44A of the General Statutes regarding sureties and bonds.

(6)        Such other and further provisions as the North Carolina Office of State Construction deems necessary.

(c)        As used in this section, the term "Resident Small Contractor" shall mean a contractor that meets all of the following requirements:

(1)        Is a properly licensed contractor that has been in business in North Carolina since its establishment and for at least 36 consecutive months.

(2)        Had gross revenues from operations less than ten million dollars ($10,000,000) during its most recent accounting year.

(3)        Has at least fifty‑one percent (51%) of the ownership of the enterprise owned by one or more natural persons, some or all of whom participate in the enterprise as follows:

a.         Exercise operational authority over daily affairs of the enterprise.

b.         Retain the power to direct policies and management.

c.         Receive a beneficial interest from the enterprise, including, without limitation, a share of the profit or loss of the enterprise.

The procedures adopted by the North Carolina Office of State Construction after consultation with the State Building Commission described above shall set forth the proofs necessary to establish qualification as a Resident Small Contractor, and decisions on such qualification shall be in the sole discretion of the State Construction Director or the Director's designee.

(d)        The adoption of procedures provided for in this section shall not be subject to the rule‑making provisions of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes, and any claims by contractors shall be presented pursuant to the provisions of G.S. 143‑135.3, except such claims shall be finally and conclusively resolved by the State Construction Director without recourse to the General Court of Justice or the contested case provisions of Chapter 150B of the General Statutes."

 

PART XXIII. REVENUE LAW CHANGES

 

REDUCE CORPORATE INCOME TAX

SECTION 23.1.(a)  G.S. 105‑130.3 reads as rewritten:

"§ 105‑130.3.  Corporations.

A tax is imposed on the State net income of every C Corporation doing business in this State. An S Corporation is not subject to the tax levied in this section. The tax is a percentage four and nine‑tenths percent (4.9%) of the taxpayer's State net income computed as follows:income.

Income Years Beginning                 Tax

In 1997                                           7.5%

In 1998                                           7.25%

In 1999                                           7%

After 1999                                      6.9%."

SECTION 23.1.(b)  This section is effective for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

 

ELIMINATE PUBLIC SCHOOL BUILDING CAPITAL FUND TRANSFER PERMANENTLY

SECTION 23.2.(a)  G.S. 115C‑546.1(b) is repealed.

SECTION 23.2.(b)  This section is effective for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

 

RAISE CAP ON QUALIFIED BUSINESS VENTURE CREDIT

SECTION 23.3.(a)  G.S. 105‑163.012(b) reads as rewritten:

"(b)      The total amount of all tax credits allowed to taxpayers under G.S. 105‑163.011 for investments made in a calendar year may not exceed seven million five hundred thousand dollars ($7,500,000).nine million five hundred thousand dollars ($9,500,000). The Secretary of Revenue shall calculate the total amount of tax credits claimed from the applications filed pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.011(c). If the total amount of tax credits claimed for investments made in a calendar year exceeds this maximum amount, the Secretary shall allow a portion of the credits claimed by allocating the maximum amount in tax credits in proportion to the size of the credit claimed by each taxpayer."

SECTION 23.3.(b)  This section is effective for investments made on or after January 1, 2011.

 

SMALL BUSINESS TAX RELIEF

SECTION 23.4.(a)  G.S. 105‑129.16J reads as rewritten:

"§ 105‑129.16J.  Temporary unemployment insurance refundable tax credit.

(a)        Credit. – A small business that makes contributions during the taxable year to the State Unemployment Insurance Fund with respect to wages paid for employment in this State is allowed a credit equal to twenty‑five percent (25%)fifty percent (50%) of the contributions. A small business is a business whose cumulative gross receipts from business activity for the taxable year do not exceed one million dollars ($1,000,000).two million five hundred thousand dollars ($2,500,000).

(b)        Refundable. – Notwithstanding G.S. 105‑129.17, the credit allowed by this section is subject to the following:

(1)        The credit may only be claimed against the income taxes imposed by Article 4 of this Chapter.

(2)        If the credit exceeds the amount of tax imposed by Article 4 of this Chapter for the taxable year reduced by the sum of all credits allowable, the excess is refundable. The refundable excess is governed by the provisions governing a refund of an overpayment by the taxpayer of the tax imposed in that Article. In computing the amount of tax against which multiple credits are allowed, nonrefundable credits are subtracted before refundable credits.

(c)        Applicability. – This section applies only to taxable years 2010 and 2011.year 2011."

SECTION 23.4.(b)  This section is effective for taxes imposed for taxable years beginning on or after January 2, 2011.

 

reduce SALES TAX to 5.5%

SECTION 23.5.(a)  G.S. 105‑164.4(a) reads as rewritten:

"(a)       A privilege tax is imposed on a retailer at the following percentage rates of the retailer's net taxable sales or gross receipts, as appropriate. The general rate of tax is four and three‑quarters percent (4.75%).five and one‑half percent (5.5%)."

SECTION 23.5.(b)  G.S. 105‑164.4(a), as rewritten by Section 23.5(a) of this act, reads as rewritten:

"(a)       A privilege tax is imposed on a retailer at the following percentage rates of the retailer's net taxable sales or gross receipts, as appropriate. The general rate of tax is five and one‑half percent (5.5%).four and seventy‑five hundredths percent (4.75%)."

SECTION 23.5.(c)  Subsection (a) of this section becomes effective July 1, 2011, and applies to sales made on or after that date.  Subsection (b) of this section becomes effective July 1, 2013, and applies to sales made on or after that date.  The remainder of this section is effective when it becomes law.

 

SMALL BUSINESS START‑UP TAX RELIEF

SECTION 23.6.(a)  G.S. 105‑130.5(b) is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:

"(b)      The following deductions from federal taxable income shall be made in determining State net income:

(26)      The amount of any exclusion of gain for qualified businesses allowed under Part 5 of this Article, to the extent included in federal taxable income, less the amount of the credits recaptured pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.021; provided, however, that a taxpayer is not required to claim this exclusion."

SECTION 23.6.(b)  G.S. 105‑134.6(b) is amended by adding a new subdivision to read:

"(b)      Deductions. – The following deductions from taxable income shall be made in calculating North Carolina taxable income, to the extent each item is included in taxable income:

(21)      The amount of the exclusion of gain for qualified businesses allowed under Part 5 of this Article, less the amount of the credits recaptured pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.021; provided, however, that a taxpayer is not required to claim this exclusion."

SECTION 23.6.(c)  Part 5 of Article 4 of Chapter 105 of the General Statutes is amended by adding the following new sections to read:

"§ 105‑163.020.  Exclusion of gain allowed.

(a)        Election. – A taxpayer may elect to exclude from the taxpayer's income taxable under this Article any gain or other taxable income recognized for federal income tax purposes from the sale or exchange of qualified securities.

(b)        Pass‑Through Entity. – Except as provided in subsection (c) of this section, a taxpayer that is an owner of a pass‑through entity may exclude from the taxpayer's income taxable under this Article an amount equal to the taxpayer's allocated share of the exclusion for which the pass‑through entity is eligible under subsection (a) of this section.

(c)        Qualified Grantee Pass‑Through Entity. – If a taxpayer is an owner of a pass‑through entity that was a qualified grantee business at the time of the taxpayer's investment in the pass‑through entity, the taxpayer may exclude from the taxpayer's income taxable under this Article an amount equal to the gain or other taxable income recognized as a result of the taxpayer's ownership in the pass‑through entity, multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the total amount invested by the pass‑through entity in qualified businesses and the denominator of which is the total amount invested by the pass‑through entity. For purposes of this subsection, the amounts invested by a pass‑through entity shall be the amounts invested immediately before the pass‑through entity's sale or exchange producing the gain or taxable income excluded under this subsection.

"§ 105‑163.021.  Recapture of credit.

If a taxpayer claims an exclusion of gain from income pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.020, the income tax of the taxpayer for the tax year for which the exclusion is claimed shall be increased by the amount of all credits previously claimed by the taxpayer pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.011 with respect to qualified securities that (i) have been sold or exchanged and (ii) the gain from which has been excluded pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.020.

"§ 105‑163.022.  Qualified securities.

(a)        Qualified Security. – Except as otherwise provided in this section, any equity security or subordinated debt instrument issued by a qualified business is a qualified security if it satisfies all of the following conditions:

(1)        It is originally issued by the business on or after January 1, 2012.

(2)        As of the date of issuance, the issuing business is a qualified business.

(3)        The security or instrument is acquired by the taxpayer at its original issue in exchange for any tangible or intangible property or benefit to the business, including cash, promissory notes, services performed, contracts for services to be performed, or other equity securities of the business.

(4)        It is held by the taxpayer for a continuous period of more than one year.

(5)        No broker's fee or commission or other similar remuneration is paid or given directly or indirectly for soliciting the purchase.

(6)        If the security or instrument was purchased by a pass‑through entity, the entity met the requirements of G.S. 105‑163.011(b1) at the time of purchase.

(b)        Registration. – Securities of a qualified business acquired before the effective date of its registration are not qualified securities. Revocation of the registration of a qualified business pursuant to G.S. 105‑163.010A does not affect the exclusion of gain from qualified securities acquired while the registration was in effect if all conditions for registration are satisfied.

(c)        Effect of Redemptions and Other Distributions. – An equity security or subordinated debt instrument is not a qualified security to the extent the taxpayer purchased it with the proceeds of a redemption, dividend, or distribution made by the business that issued the security or instrument. For the purpose of this subsection, when a business makes a redemption, dividend, or distribution during the four‑year period beginning two years before the issuance of securities or instruments to a taxpayer, the taxpayer is considered to have used the proceeds of the redemption, dividend, or distribution toward the purchase of the securities or instruments. A redemption, dividend, or distribution occurs when the business issuing the security or instrument does either of the following:

(1)        Purchases, directly or indirectly, any of its outstanding equity securities or subordinated debt, other than qualified securities, from the taxpayer or a related person.

(2)        Declares a dividend or makes a distribution with respect to any of its outstanding equity securities or subordinated debt, other than qualified securities, to the taxpayer or a related person. This subdivision does not apply, however, to a distribution in connection with one of the following:

a.         The reimbursement to the taxpayer of the reasonable costs of forming, syndicating, managing, and operating the business.

b.         An increase in the taxpayer's taxes, penalties, or interest to the extent the increase is caused by the allocation to the taxpayer of income of the business.

The repayment of principal on subordinated debt is a purchase of the debt except to the extent the repayment is repayment of principal due on the subordinated debt at its maturity pursuant to the terms of the subordinated debt instrument. If a transaction is treated under section 304(a) of the Code as a distribution in redemption of the equity securities of a business, that business has, for the purpose of this subsection, purchased an amount of its equity securities equal to the amount treated as such a distribution under section 304(a) of the Code.

(d)        Exception for Certain Transactions. – The following transactions are not treated as a redemption or distribution for the purposes of subsection (c) of this section:

(1)        Any deemed liquidation of a business pursuant to section 708(b)(1)(A) of the Code by reason of the business becoming a disregarded entity for federal tax purposes, to the extent there is not actual distribution of money or other property to the taxpayer or a related person.

(2)        Any deemed distribution or redemption by reason of a technical termination of a business pursuant to section 708(b)(1)(B) of the Code to the extent there is no actual distribution of money or other property to the taxpayer or a related person.

(e)        Conversion of Other Securities. – Any equity security or subordinated debt instrument issued by a business and acquired by the taxpayer solely through the conversion of another equity security or subordinated debt instrument that was issued by the business and was a qualified security in the hands of the taxpayer is considered, for the purpose of this section, a qualified security in the hands of the taxpayer and acquired by the taxpayer on the date the taxpayer acquired the converted qualified security.

(f)         Transfers. – In the case of a transfer by gift, by death, or from a pass‑through entity to one of its owners, the transferee is considered, for the purpose of this section, to have acquired the qualified security in the same manner as the transferor and to have held it during any continuous period immediately preceding the transfer during which it was held or treated as held by the transferor.

In the case of a transaction described in section 351 or 721 of the Code or a reorganization described in section 368 of the Code, if qualified securities are exchanged for other securities, the other securities are considered, for the purpose of this section, qualified securities acquired on the date the exchanged qualified securities were acquired. In the case of a transaction described in section 351 or 721 of the Code, the newly acquired securities are considered qualified securities, however, only if, immediately after the transaction, the business issuing the securities owns, directly or indirectly, securities representing control, within the meaning of section 368(c) of the Code, of the business whose securities were exchanged.

"§ 105‑163.023.  Limitations.

(a)        Contributions and Exchanges of Property. – In the case of a transaction described in section 351 or 721 of the Code or a reorganization described in section 368 of the Code, if a taxpayer contributes property to or exchanges property with a qualified business, the following rules apply:

(1)        Qualified securities exchanged for property. – Except as otherwise provided in subdivision (3) of this subsection, a taxpayer who transfers property to a business in exchange for qualified securities in the business must, for purposes of determining North Carolina taxable income, recognize gain equal to the amount by which the fair market value of the property exceeded the taxpayer's basis in the property on the date the property was exchanged for the qualified securities. This gain must be recognized for the years for which the taxpayer claims an exclusion of gain under this Part with respect to the disposition of qualified securities received in exchange for the property.

(2)        Contributions to capital. – Except as otherwise provided in subdivision (3) of this subsection, if the adjusted basis of a qualified security is adjusted due to a contribution to capital after the date the qualified security was issued originally, for purposes of determining North Carolina taxable income, the taxpayer must recognize gain equal to the amount by which the fair market value of the contributed property exceeded the taxpayer's basis in the property on the date the property was contributed. This gain must be recognized for the years for which the taxpayer claims an exclusion of gain under this Part with respect to the disposition of the qualified securities.

(3)        Disposition of contributed property. – If a qualified business disposes of property contributed to it, the disposition occurs before the taxpayer who contributed the property claims an exclusion of gain pursuant to this Part with respect to qualified securities affected by the contribution, and the taxpayer recognizes gain from the disposition, then for purposes of subdivisions (1) and (2) of this subsection, the taxpayer's basis in the contributed property is increased by any gain the taxpayer recognized from the disposition.

(b)        Transactions That Substantially Reduce the Risk of Loss. – If a taxpayer has entered into any transaction that substantially reduces the risk of loss from holding the qualified securities, there is no exclusion of gain under this Part from the sale or exchange of the qualified securities unless the taxpayer entered into the transaction on or after January 1, 2012, and elects to recognize gain as if the qualified securities were sold at fair market value on the date the taxpayer first entered into that transaction. The following are examples of a transaction that substantially reduces the risk of loss from holding the qualified securities:

(1)        The taxpayer or a related person has made a short sale of substantially identical property.

(2)        The taxpayer or a related person has acquired an option to sell substantially identical property at a fixed price."

SECTION 23.6.(d)  This section is effective for taxable years beginning on or after January 1, 2011.

 

PART XXIV. Miscellaneous Provisions

 

STATE BUDGET ACT APPLIES

SECTION 24.1The provisions of the State Budget Act, Chapter 143C of the General Statutes, are reenacted and shall remain in full force and effect and are incorporated in this act by reference.

 

MOST TEXT APPLIES ONLY TO THE 2011‑2013 FISCAL BIENNIUM

SECTION 24.2Except for statutory changes or other provisions that clearly indicate an intention to have effects beyond the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium, the textual provisions of this act apply only to funds appropriated for, and activities occurring during, the 2011‑2013 fiscal biennium.

 

EFFECT OF HEADINGS

SECTION 24.3The headings to the Parts and sections of this act are a convenience to the reader and are for reference only.  The headings do not expand, limit, or define the text of this act, except for effective dates referring to a Part.

 

SEVERABILITY CLAUSE

SECTION 24.4If any section or provision of this act is declared unconstitutional or invalid by the courts, it does not affect the validity of this act as a whole or any part other than the part so declared to be unconstitutional or invalid.

 

EFFECTIVE DATE

SECTION 24.5.  Except as otherwise provided, this act becomes effective July 1, 2011.

feedback